Documenti di Didattica
Documenti di Professioni
Documenti di Cultura
Catalog September
File 9007 / XC
07
CONTENTS Selection Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390 Applications by Market Segment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398 Osiswitch XC Product Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400 Osiswitch Miniature Snap Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410 Osiswitch Miniature Limit Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 418 Osiswitch Compact Limit Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440 Osiswitch Classic Limit Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 468 Class 9007 Industrial Snap Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536 Class 9007 Miniature Limit Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 539 Class 9007AW Heavy Duty Industrial Limit Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545 Class 9007C Heavy Duty Industrial Limit Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 546 Class 9007T and FT Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Limit Switches . . . . 598 R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches . 610
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch Universal
Design
Miniature
Compact
Catalog number Enclosure Features Modularity CENELEC conformity Body dimensions (w x h x d), mm (in.) Head 2 snap action contacts with positive opening operation 3 snap action contacts with positive opening operation Contact blocks 4 snap action contacts with positive opening operation 2 slow break contacts with positive opening operation 2 slow break contacts 3 slow break contacts with positive opening operation Insulation voltage (Ui) / thermal current (Ithe)
XCMD
Metal
XCKD
XCKP
Plastic, double insulated
XCKT
Mounting by the body or by the head Head, body and connection modularity 30 x 50 x 16 (1.18 x 1.97 x 0.63) EN 50047 31 x 65 x 30 (1.22 x 2.56 x 1.18) Head and body modularity EN 50047 compatible 58 x 51 x 30 (2.28 x 2.01 x 1.18)
Linear movement (plunger) Rotary movement (lever) Rotary movement, multi-directional Same heads for ranges XCMD, XCKD, XCKP and XCKT N/C + N/O; N/C + N/C N/C + N/C + N/O N/C + N/C + N/O + N/O N/C + N/O break before make N/C + N/C + N/O break before make Pre-cabled 2 contacts: 400 V/6 A 3 contacts: 400 V/4 A 4 contacts: 400 V/3 A Integral M12, 4-pin: 250 V/3 A N/C + N/C + N/O; N/C + N/O + N/O N/C + N/O break before make; N/O + N/C make before break; N/C + N/C simultaneous N/O + N/O simultaneous N/C + N/C + N/O break before make; N/C + N/O + N/O break before make Screw terminal 2 contacts: 500 V/10 A 3 contacts: 400 V/6 A Screw terminal 2 contacts: 500 V/10 A N/C + N/O
Limit Switches
Connector
Degree of protection
NEMA Types 1, 2, 4X, 6, 12 IP 66, IP 67, IP 68, IK 06 Integral: No Remote: Yes Integral or remote M12 or remote 7/8" 16UN 430
NEMA Types 1, 2, 4, 6, 12, 13 IP 66, IP 67, IK 04 2 entries for ISO M16 or PG 11 conduit thread or 1/2" NPT (using adapter
1 entry for ISO M16 or M20, PG 11, PG 13 conduit thread or 1/2" NPT, PF 1/2 Integral M12 442 and 446 448 and 452
454
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch Optimum and Application
Design Miniature Optimum Compact Application: with manual reset
Catalog number Enclosure Features Modularity CENELEC conformity Body dimensions (w x h x d), mm (in.) Head 2 snap action contacts with positive opening operation 3 snap action contacts with positive opening operation Contact blocks 4 snap action contacts with positive opening operation 2 slow break contacts with positive opening operation 2 slow break contacts 3 slow break contacts with positive opening operation
XCMN
Plastic, double insulated Mounting by the body or by the head 30 x 50 x 16 (1.18 x 1.97 x 0.63) Linear movement (plunger) Rotary movement (lever) Rotary movement, multidirectional N/C + N/O Screw terminal
XCDR
Metal Mounting by the body
XCPR
Plastic, double insulated
XCTR
31 x 65 x 30 (1.22 x 2.56 x 1.18) Linear movement (plunger) Rotary movement (lever) Same heads for ranges XCDR, XCPR and XCTR
400 V/6 A
Connector
Degree of protection
IP 66, IP 67, IK 04 1 entry for ISO M20 or PG 13 conduit thread or 1/2" NPT 2 entries for ISO M16 or PG 11 conduit thread or 1/2" NPT (using adapter)
438
462
464
466
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch Classic
Design Classic
Catalog number Enclosure Features Modularity CENELEC or DIN conformity Body dimensions (w x h x d), mm (in.) Head 2 snap action contacts with positive opening operation 3 snap action contacts with positive opening operation C/O snap action contacts Contact blocks C/O slow break contacts 2 slow break contacts with positive opening operation 2 slow break contacts 3 slow break contacts with positive opening operation
XCKM
Metal 3 conduit entries Head + Body + Operator 63 x 64 x 30 (2.48 x 2.52 x 1.18) Linear movement (plunger) Rotary movement (lever) Rotary movement, multi-directional N/C + N/O; N/C + N/C N/C + N/C + N/O; N/C + N/O + N/O N/C + N/O break before make N/O + N/C make before break N/C + N/C simultaneous N/O + N/O simultaneous
XCKL
XCKJ
Fixed or plug-in body, -40 C (-40 F) or +120 C (+248 F) versions
EN 50041 52 x 72 x 30 (2.05 x 2.83 x 1.18) 40 x 77 x 44 (1.57 x 3.03 x 1.73) 42.5 x 84 x 36 (1.67 x 3.31 x 1.42)
N/C + N/O
2 C/O
N/C + N/C + N/O break before make; N/C + N/O + N/O break before make Screw terminal 2 contacts: 500 V/10 A 3 contacts: 400 V/6 A NEMA Types 1, 2, 4, 6, 6P, 12, 13 IP 66, IK 06 3 entries for ISO M20 or PG 11 conduit thread or 1/2" NPT 468 1 entry incorporating cable entry or tapped 1/2" NPT 468 Connector Integral M12, 5-pin: 60 V/4 A Integral 7/8" 16UN: 250 V/6 A NEMA Types 1, 2, 4, 12 IP 66 IK 07 1 entry for ISO M20 or PG 13 conduit thread or 1/2" NPT Integral M12 or 7/8" 16UN 484
Limit Switches
Connection
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch Classic, Application, and Miniature Snap Switches
Sub-miniature, Application: for lifting miniature: applications Application: for and materials handling requiring high installations requiring equipment or very precision and a low electrical redundancy severe applications operating force
Design
Classic
Catalog number Enclosure Features Modularity CENELEC or DIN conformity Body dimensions (w x h x d), mm (in.) Head 2 snap action contacts with positive opening operation 3 snap action contacts with positive opening operation C/O snap action contacts Contact blocks C/O slow break contacts 2 slow break contacts with positive opening operation 2 slow break contacts 3 slow break contacts with positive opening operation
XCKS Plastic, double insulated Head + Body + Operator EN 50041 40 x 72.5 x 36 (1.57 x 2.85 x 1.42) Linear movement (plunger) Rotary movement (lever) Rotary movement, multi-directional N/C + N/O; N/C + N/C N/C + N/C + N/O; N/C + N/O + N/O 2 C/O N/C + N/O break before make N/O + N/C make before break N/C + N/C simultaneous N/O + N/O simultaneous N/C + N/C + N/O break before make N/C + N/O + N/O break before make Screw terminal 2 contacts: 500 V/10 A IP 65 IK 03
XEP, XCO Plastic Depending on type Depending on type, fixed composition or contact and operator
72 x 81 x 36 (2.83 x 3.19 x 1.42) Linear movement (plunger) Rotary movement (lever) 2 x N/C + N/O contact blocks Depending on type Depending on type 2 x N/C + N/O break before make contact blocks Screw terminal 2 contacts: 500 V/10 A Depending on type 1 single-pole contact Depending on type Depending on type DIN 41635, depending on type Linear movement (plunger)
Depending on type
Degree of protection
NEMA Types: 1, 2, 4, 6, 6P, 12, 13 IP 66 IK 06 3 entries for ISO M20 or PG 13 conduit thread; or PG 13 to 1/2 NPT with adapter
Depending on type: IP 66, IK 05; IP 65, IK 05; or IP 54, IK 05 Depending on type: 1 or 3 entries for ISO M20 or PG 13 conduit thread
Depending on type
Connection
Page
468
412
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Class 9007 Industrial Snap Switches and Miniature Industrial Switches
Design Industrial Snap Switch Miniature Switch Miniature Enclosed Reed Heavy Duty Industrial, Precision Oiltight
9007A 9007C
Industrial snap switches with or without operators Plastic None 29.0 x 63.5 x 21.0 (1.14 x 2.5 x 0.83) Linear
9007MS 9007ML
Miniature enclosed switches, potted and pre-wired with cable. Unique rotary head. 9007 ML has double break contacts. Metal bodies, metal head NEMA: Types 1, 2, 4, 6, 6P, 12, 13 IEC: IP67 40.1 x 44.4 x 15.8 (1.58 x 1.75 x 0.62) Linear or Rotary
9007XA
Miniature enclosed switches, potted and pre-wired with cable. Reed contacts for superior lowenergy switching. Metal bodies, metal head NEMA: Types 1, 2, 4, 6, 6P, 12, 13 40.1 x 44.2 x 16.0 1.58 x 1.74 x 0.63) Linear or Rotary
9007AW
Precision oil tight enclosed switches with unique features, micrometer adjustable and low temperature operation. Metal bodies, metal heads NEMA: Types 1, 2, 4, 6, 6P, 12, 13 36.6 x 98.5 x 63.5 (1.44 x 3.88 x 2.5) Linear or Rotary
Description Enclosure Material Enclosure Rating Approximate Body Dimensions, mm (in.) Heads Contact Blocks N.C. + N.O. snap action N.C. + N.O. break before make, slow break N.O. + N.C. make before break, slow break N.C. + N.C. simultaneous, slow break N.O. + N.O. simultaneous, slow break C/O snap action
N.O. or N.C.
Limit Switches
C/O slow break N.C. + N.C. 2-step, slow break N.O. + N.O. 2-step, slow break N.C. + N.C. snap action N.O. + N.C. slow make, slow break Cabling Temperature Range
-65 to +221 F (-54 to +105 C) Pre-wired cable, M12 Connector option available. -40 to +221 F (-40 to +105 C) Bottom or side cable entry. Full range of operating heads, page 540. Pre-wired cable. -20 to + 140 F (-29 to +60 C) Bottom cable entry. Three common operating heads, page 544. 0 to +185 F (-17.8 to 85 C) Lever operated: -65 to +185 F (-54 to 85 C) Most common operating heads. Micrometer adjustable push rod plunger. Uses 9007C levers, page 574.
Additional Features
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Class 9007 Type C Heavy Duty Industrial
Applications Material handlingmechanical conveying, automotive, machine tool, packaging Standard body reed contacts Compact body type 9007C52 Hazardous application locations: gases (explosion), dust environment. Hazardous location body type 9007CR
Design
Catalog number Enclosure Features Factory modifications (Forms) Modularity Conforming to standards Product certifications Body dimensions (w x h x d), mm (in.) with rotary head Head
9007C54 9007C62 9007C68 9007C66 Metal, diecast, zinc alloy Plug-in body See pages 560 to 564 Head + body + lever NEMA 250, EN 60947-1, EN 60947-5-1, IEC 60947, UL 508, C22-2-14-95, e conformity documentation UL, CSA, e 39 x 102 x 45 (1.54 x 4.02 x 1.77)
9007C84 9007C86
9007C52
Non-plug-in body
NEMA 250, EN 60947-1, EN 60947-5-1, IEC 60947, UL 508, C22-2-14-95, e conformity documentation
Linear movement (plunger) Rotary movement (lever) Multi-directional movement (wobble stick, cat whisker) 9007C54 9007C62 1 N.O. + 1 N.C. 2 N.O. + 2 N.C. 2 N.O. + 2 N.C. neutral position 2 N.O. + 2 N.C. two stage Plunger and lever heads only 9007C Y1561 Single pole only 600 V 600 V Except: 9007CR63, 9007CR65, 9007CR67 (Ui = 250 V) 10 A NEMA Types 2, 4, 6P, 7, 9, 13 Cable entry or connector Depending on model: 1/2"-14 NPT, M20 X 1,5 ISO cable entry, 3/4 14 NPT available. 582 Reed contacts 1 N.O. or 1 N.C. 1 N.O. + 1 N.C. 9007CR53 9007CR61 9007CR65 9007CR67 1 N.O. + 1 N.C. 2 N.O. + 2 N.C. 2 N.O. + 2 N.C. neutral position 2 N.O. + 2 N.C. two stage
Contact blocks
9007C68 9007C66
Direct opening (positive opening) Rated insulation voltage Insulation voltage (Ui) top half of body Thermal current (Ithe) top half of body Degree of protection
600 V Except: 9007CO62, 9007CO66, 9007CO68 (Ui = 250 V) and 9007C84, 9007C86 (Ui = 125 V) 10 A Excepted: 9007CO84, 9007CO86 (2.5 A) IP 67 conforming to IEC 60529, NEMA Types 2, 4, 6, 6P, 12, 13 Cable entry or connector Depending on model: 1/2"-14 NPT, M20 x 1.5 ISO cable entry, 5-pin mini connector. 548
10 A IP 67 conforming to IEC 60529 NEMA Types 2, 4, 6, 6P, 12, 13, Cable entry or connector Depending on model: 1/2"-14 NPT, M20 X 1.5 ISO cable entry, 5 pin mini connector. 556
A wide range of connectors are available. Contact your local field office.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Applications Design Mill 9007T Convertible sequence Mill L100 Fixed sequence Mill L14 Single Cable Pulls Fixed sequence Mill L525 Belt Conveyor Fixed sequence
Catalog number Enclosure Features Factory modifications (Forms) Conforming to standards Product certifications Body dimensions (w x h x d), mm (in.) surface mounting Head Contact blocks Snap action contacts (1) Sequences
9007T Metal Extra heavy duty contact ratings Page 605 NEMA A600 UL508 UL Listed, CSA Certified 58.7 x 114.3 x 64.5 (2.31 x 4.5 x 2.54) Rotary movement (lever) 1 N.C. + 1 N.O. Convertible 600 V 20 A ac/dc NEMA Types 1, 2, 4, 12, 13 IP65, 66, 67 Cable entry or connector 1/2" NPT (metric available) Page 600 Page 623
L100 Metal Extra heavy duty contact ratings Page 621 NEMA A600 UL508 UL Listed, CSA Certified 58.7 x 126 x 53.3 (2.31 x 4.95 x 2.10) Rotary movement (lever) 1 N.C. + 1 N.O. Fixed 600 V 20 A ac, 5 A dc NEMA Types 1, 4, 13 IP65, 66 Cable entry or connector 1/2" NPT (metric available) Page 612 Page 623
L14 Metal Extra heavy duty contact ratings Page 621 NEMA A600 UL508 UL Listed, CSA Certified 58.7 x 126 x 53.3 (2.31 x 4.95 x 2.10) Rotary movement (lever) (3) 1 N.C. + 1 N.O. Fixed 600 V 20 A ac, 5 A dc NEMA Types 1, 4, 13 IP65, 66 Cable entry or connector 1/2" NPT (metric available) Page 616 Page 623
L525 Metal Extra heavy duty contact ratings Page 621 NEMA A600 UL508 UL Listed, CSA Certified 58.7 x 126 x 53.3 (2.31 x 4.95 x 2.10) Rotary movement (lever) (3) 1 N.C. + 1 N.O. Fixed 600 V 20 A ac, 5 A dc NEMA Types 1, 4, 13 IP65, 66 Cable entry or connector 1/2" NPT (metric available) Page 617 Page 623
Limit Switches
Rated insulation voltage Thermal current (Ithe) Degree of protection Connection (2) Presentation, Applications and Characteristics Interpretation of Catalog Numbers
1. 2. 3.
For other contact options see page 600. A wide range of connectors are available. Contact your local field office. Lever arms are optional and must be ordered separately.
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Applications Design Foundry 9007FT Convertible sequence Foundry L300 Fixed sequence Mill and Foundry L2153 Dual Pull Stop Fixed sequence
Catalog number Enclosure Features Factory modifications (Forms) Conforming to standards Product certifications Body dimensions (w x h x d), mm (in.) surface mounting Head Contact blocks Snap action contacts f Sequences
9007FT Metal
L300 Metal
L2153 Metal Extra heavy duty contact ratings Page 621 NEMA A600 UL508 UL Listed, CSA Certified 58.7 x 126 x 53.3 (2.31 x 4.95 x 2.10) Rotary movement (lever) (2) 1 N.C. + 1 N.O.
Designed specifically for rough foundry Designed specifically for applications rough foundry applications Page 605 NEMA A600 UL508 UL Listed, CSA Certified 58.7 x 114.3 x 86.6 (2.31 x 4.5 x 3.41) Rotary movement (lever) 1 N.C. + 1 N.O. Convertible 600 V 20 A ac/dc NEMA Types 1, 2, 4, 12, 13 IP65, 66, 67 Cable entry or connector 1/2" NPT (metric available) Page 602 Page 623 Page 621 NEMA A600 UL508 UL Listed, CSA Certified 58.7 x 126 x 53.3 (2.31 x 4.95 x 2.10) Rotary movement (lever) 1 N.C. + 1 N.O. Fixed 600 V 20 A ac, 5 A dc NEMA Types 1, 4, 13 IP65, 66 Cable entry or connector 1/2" NPT (metric available) Page 614 Page 623
Rated insulation voltage Thermal current (Ithe) Degree of protection Connection (1) Presentation, Applications and Characteristics Interpretation of Catalog Numbers
1. 2.
600 V 20 A ac, 5 A dc NEMA Types 1, 4, 13 IP65, 66 Cable entry or connector 1/2" NPT (metric available) Page 616 Page 623
A wide range of connectors are available. Contact your local field office. Lever arms are optional and must be ordered separately.
Limit Switches
Fixed
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Applications by Market Segment
Crane and Hoist Overhead Cranes Transport Systems NOTE: Special electrical options available for: Low current switching for programmable controllers Hazardous locations
Process Machinery Machine Tools Plastic, Rubber, Molding Printing Textile Pulp, Paper, Wood
Packaging Machinery Packaging Machines Shrink Wrap Food and Beverage Machinery Bottling Canning
Limit Switches
Simple Machines Transportation Wash Light Handling Assembly Stations General Purpose
XCKS
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Applications by Market Segment
9007AW
XCKJ 9007C
L100/L300 9007T/FT
XCR 9007CLS
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch XC Product Overview
Introduction
Electromechanical detection Limit switches are used in all automated installations and also in a wide variety of applications, due to the numerous advantages inherent to their technology. They transmit data to the logic processing system regarding: presence/absence passing positioning end of travel Simplicity of installation, advantages From an electrical viewpoint galvanic separation of circuits, models suitable for low power switching, combined with good electrical durability, very good short-circuit withstand in coordination with appropriate fuses, total immunity to electromagnetic interference, high rated operational voltage. From a mechanical viewpoint N/C contacts with positive opening operation, high resistance to the different ambient conditions encountered in industry (standard tests and specific tests under laboratory conditions), high repeat accuracy, up to 0.01 mm on the tripping points. Detection movements Linear movement (plunger) Rotary movement (lever) Multi-directional movement
Limit Switches
Unactuated
Tripped
Unactuated
Tripped
Unactuated
Tripped
Terminology
This replaces the term nominal value. It is the fixed value for a specific function. AC-15 replaces AC-11: control of an electromagnet on a.c., test 10 le/le. AC-12: control of a resistive load on a.c. or static load isolated by opto-coupler. DC-13 replaces DC-11: control of an electromagnet on d.c., test le/le.
Utilization categories
Switching capacity
Ithe is no longer a rated value but a conventional current used for heating tests. Example: for category A300 the corresponding operational current, le maximum, is 6 A-120 V or 3 A-240 V, the equivalent Ithe being 10 A. Minimum travel from the initial movement of contact actuator to the position required to accomplish positive opening operation. The force required on the contact actuator to accomplish positive opening operation. A limit switch complies with this specification when all the closed contact elements of the switch can be changed, with certainty, to the open position (no flexible link between the moving contacts and the operator of the switch, to which an actuating force is applied). All limit switches incorporating either a slow break contact block or a snap action N/C + N/O (form Zb), N/C + N/O + N/O, N/C + N/C + N/O, N/C + N/C + N/O + N/O contact block are positive opening operation, in complete conformity with standard IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix K.
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch XC Product Overview
Contact blocks
Snap action contacts Snap action contacts are characterized by different tripping and reset points (differential travel). The displacement speed of the moving contacts is not related to the speed of the operator. This feature ensures satisfactory electrical performance in applications involving low speed actuators.
13
14
13
14
13
14
13
14
21
22
21
22
21
22
21
22
Approach travel
Positive opening
Slow break contacts are characterized by identical tripping and resetting points. The displacement speed of the moving contacts is equal, or proportional, to the speed of the operatorwhich must not be less than 0.1 m/s, or 6 m/minute (0.33 ft/s, or 19.68 ft/minute). The opening distance also depends on the distance traveled by the operator.
21
22
21
22
13
14
13
14
Normally, for inductive loads, the current value is less than 0.1 A (sealed), i.e., values of 3 to 40 VA sealed and 30 to 1000 VA inrush, depending on the voltage. For this type of application the electrical durability exceeds 10 million operating cycles. Application example: XCKJ161 + LC1D12 (7 VA sealed, 70 VA inrush). Electrical durability = 10 million operating cycles. Switching capacity
3. Normal industrial PLC input type 1 4. Normal industrial PLC input type 2 5. Switching capacity conforming to IEC 60947-5-5, utilization category AC-15, DC-13
A300 Q300 Heating limit (Ithe) 240 V 250 V 3A 0.27 A B300 R300 240 V 250 V 1.5 A 0.13 A
(1)
Inductive zone
1 2
Electrical durability for small loads The use of limit switches with programmable controllers is becoming more common. With small loads, limit switches offer the following levels of reliability: failure rate of less than 1 for 100 million operating cycles using snap action contacts (contacts XE2SP). failure rate of less than 1 for 20 million operating cycles using slow break contacts (contacts XENP and XE3SP). failure rate of less than 1 for 5 million operating cycles using contacts XCMD.
2 A 3A
6A 10 A
Occasional service
Infrequent switching, y 1 operating cycle/day and/or corrosive atmosphere (1) 1. Usable up to 48 V/10 mA.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch XC Product Overview
Principle
Innovation through modularity
The Miniature design XCMD and Compact design XCKD, XCKP and XCKT product range family benefits from the Osiconcept principle: Offering simplicity through innovation. A first in worldwide detection for improving productivity. A complete offer for resolving the most commonly encountered detection problems: product selection simplified, product availability simplified, installation and setup simplified, maintenance simplified.
Heads
A single metal operating head type for the Miniature design XCMD and Compact design XCKD, XCKP and XCKT ranges.
Limit Switches
Interchanging of heads achieved by simple operation of forked metal latch. Adjustable in 3 planes:
15 15 15
All the heads can be adjusted in 15 steps throughout 360, in relation to the body. All the levers can be adjusted in 15 steps throughout 360, in relation to the horizontal axis of the head.
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch XC Product Overview
Principle (continued)
Cable entries
The cable entries for Compact design XCKD and XCKP switches enable:
simple cabling due to unrestricted access to contacts simple adaptation to the various worldwide markets
ISO M16 x 1.5 PG 11 ISO M20 x 1.5 PG 13 1/2" NPT PF 1/2 (G 1/2)
Each model is available in metal or plastic, suited for compact design XCKD or XCKP, respectively. A connector version is also available.
Connection components
The miniature XCMD range allows interchangeability of these pre-cabled connection components: 1/4 turn is all that is required to remove the connection component on XCMD bodies with 2 and 3 contacts, 6 alternative cable lengths are available. The miniature XCMD range also includes an integral or remote connector solution.
1/4 turn
2 and 3 snap action and slow break contact blocks, with positive opening operation, are interchangeable between the Compact design XCKD and XCKP and Classic XCKJ, XCKS, XCKM and XCKL ranges. For the Miniature design XCMD range, the contacts are an integral part of the body: 2 and 3 snap action and slow break contacts, with positive opening operation, and interchangeable connection component, 4 snap action contacts, with positive opening operation, with monolithic body and connection components.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch XC Product Overview
Contact blocks (continued)
A B 21 - 22 13 - 14 21 - 22 13 - 14 0 C D P
Functional diagrams of snap action contacts Example: N/C + N/O AMaximum travel of the operator in mm or degrees. BTripping travel of contact. CResetting travel of contact. DDifferential travel = BC. PPoint from which positive opening is assured. Linear movement (plunger)
Tripping Resetting
0 1 2 P
max.
D C
1Resetting point of contact. 2Tripping point of contact. AMaximum travel of the operator in mm. BTripping travel of contact. CResetting travel of contact. DDifferential travel = BC. PPoint from which positive opening is assured. Rotary movement (lever)
B C 1 D 2 A
1Resetting point of contact. 2Tripping point of contact. AMaximum travel of the operator in degrees. BTripping travel of contact. CResetting travel of contact. DDifferential travel = BC. PPoint from which positive opening is assured.
Example: N/C + N/O break before make AMaximum travel of the operator in mm or degrees. BTripping and resetting travel of contact 21-22. CTripping and resetting travel of contact 13-14. PPoint from which positive opening is assured.
max.
Limit Switches
21 - 22 13 - 14 0
0 1 2 P
Linear movement (plunger) 1Tripping and resetting points of contact 21-22. 2Tripping and resetting points of contact 13-14. AMaximum travel of the operator in mm. BTripping and resetting travel of contact 21-22. CTripping and resetting travel of contact 13-14. PPositive opening point. Rotary movement (lever)
C A B 1 2
1Tripping and resetting points of contact 21-22. 2Tripping and resetting points of contact 13-14. AMaximum travel of the operator in degrees. BTripping and resetting travel of contact 21-22. CTripping and resetting travel of contact 13-14. PPositive opening point.
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch XC Product Overview
Contact blocks (continued)
XE2P screw clamp terminal connections Contact connections
Tightening torque: minimum tightening torque ensuring the nominal characteristics of the contact: 0.8 Nm (7.08 lb-in) maximum tightening torque without damage to the terminals: 1.2 Nm (10.62 lb-in) for XE2P, 1 Nm (8.85 lb-in) for XE3P Connecting cable: cable preparation lengths: L for XE2 P, L = 22 mm (0.87 in.) for XE2P3, L = 45 mm (1.77 in.) for XE3P: L = 14 mm (0.55 in.) L1 = 11 mm (0.43 in.)
L1
Mounting
1. Recommended 2. To be avoided
1. Recommended 2. To be avoided
Type of cam
1. Recommended 2. To be avoided
1
30 30
1. Recommended 2. Forbidden
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch XC Product Overview
Setup
Tightening torque The minimum torque is that required to ensure correct operation of the switch. The maximum torque is the value which, if exceeded, will damage the switch. Item
Cover Mounting screw for lever on rotary head Mounting screw for lever on rotary head Cover Mounting nut for lever on rotary head Cover Mounting nut for lever on rotary head Cover Mounting nut for lever on rotary head
Range Compact design XCKD, XCKP, XCKT Miniature design XCMD, XCMN Classic design XCKJ Classic design XCKS Classic design XCKM, XCKML, XCKL Types XCKD, XCKP, XCKT, XCMD Adjustable in 3 planes:
Max.
1.2 (10.62) 1.5 (13.28) 1.5 (13.28) 1.5 (13.28) 1.5 (13.28) 1.2 (10.62) 1.5 (13.28) 1.2 (10.62) 1.5 (13.28)
15
15
15
All the heads can be adjusted in 15 steps All the levers can be adjusted in 15 steps throughout 360, in throughout 360, in relation to the body. relation to the horizontal axis of the head. Type XCKJ Adjustable through 360 in 5 steps, or 1. Reversed = 5 in 45 steps by reversing the lever or its 2. Forward = 45 mounting.
Limit Switches
406
1 2
09/2007
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch XC Product Overview
Setup (continued)
Direction of actuation programming
XCKJ
Head ZCKE05
XCKS
Head ZCKD05
Head ZCE05
B A
A = length of lever + 11 mm (0.43 in.) ZCKE09: h = 1318 mm (0.510.71 in.) and B = 12 mm (0.47 in.) max. ZCKJE09: h = 1424 mm (0.550.94 in.) and B = 6 mm (0.24 in.) max.
ZCKG00 Head Programming The ZCKG00 head is field convertible to CW, CCW or CW/CCW. The diagram below shows the conversion process.
Limit Switches
1. 2.
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch XC Product Overview
Compliance with standards
The majority of Telemecanique brand products comply to national standards (such as French NF C standards, German DIN standards), European standards (such as CENELEC), or international standards (such as IEC). These standards rigidly stipulate the characteristic requirements of the designated products (for example IEC 60947 relating to low voltage switchgear and controlgear). These products, when correctly used, enable the production of control equipment assemblies, machine control equipment or installations conforming to their own specific standards (for example IEC 60204 for the electrical equipment of industrial machines). IEC 60947-5-1 Insulation coordination (and dielectric strength) Terminal connections Switching capacity Positive opening operation (IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix K)
The standard IEC 60664 defines 4 categories of prospective transient overvoltages. It is important for the user to select control circuit components which are able to withstand these overvoltages. To these ends, the manufacturer states the rated impulse withstand voltage (U imp) applicable to the product. The cabling capacity, mechanical robustness and durability of the terminals, as well as the ability to resist loosening, are verified by standardized tests. Terminal reference marking conforms to standard EN 50013. With maximum electrical load. A single designation (A300 for example) enables indication of the contact block characteristics related to its utilization category. For contacts used in safety applications (end of travel, emergency stop device, etc.) the assurance of positive opening is required (see IEC 60204, EN 60204) after each test, the opening of the contact being verified by testing with an impulse voltage (2500 V).
Form Za, the 2 contacts are the same polarity. Simplified version
Form Zb,
the 2 contacts are electrically separate.
Complete symbol
CENELEC EN 50047 The European standards organization CENELEC, which has 14 member countries, has defined in this standard the first type of limit switch. This standard defines 4 variants of devices (forms A, B, C, E). Limit switches XCKP, XCKD and XCKT conform to standard EN 50047. Form A, with roller lever Form B, with end plunger (rounded)
20 (1)
50 (2)
H P
12,5
P H
55
15 (1)
10 (1)
31 (2)
55 (2)
21 (1)
5 (1) 40
20 (1)
25
35
20 (1)
31 (1)
25 (1)
28
30 (2)
40
Limit Switches
10 (1)
10 (1)
12,5
P
2,5 (1) 5 (1)
10
Limit Switches
Selection Guide
Osiswitch XC Product Overview
Compliance with standards (continued)
CENELEC EN 50041 The European standards organization CENELEC, which has 14 member countries, has defined in this standard the second type of limit switch. It defines 6 variants of devices (forms A, B, C, D, F, G). Limit switches XCKJ and XCKS conform to standard EN 50041. Form A, with roller lever Form B, with end plunger (rounded)
70 (2) 20 (1)
H P H
5,3
10 (1) 7,3
67
5 (1)
70 (2)
A B
80 (2)
15 (1) 30 46 (2)
Form C, with end roller plunger Form D, with rod lever
A: B: H: P:
31(1)
40 (1)
42,5 (2)
Za
10 (1)
40
40
58
100 (1)
20 (1)
200
3 (1)
20 (2)
20 (2)
Sa
P H
20 (1)
58
20 (1)
41
30
30 (1)
3 20
72
20
55
3 (1)
59 (1) 67 (1)
41 (1) 50 (1)
20
Limit Switches
44 (1)
53 (1)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature Snap Switches
XEP and XC0
Introduction
Electromechanical detection
XEP4E1Wp XEP3
Osiswitch miniature snap switches, featuring electromechanical technology, assure the following functions: detection of presence or absence detection of position. Actuation of the operator (plunger or lever) on the miniature snap switch causes the electrical contact to change state. This information can then be processed by a PLC controlling the installation. Osiswitch miniature snap switches can be used both for industrial applications and the building sector.
Features
XEP4E1FDp
XC0 XEP5
Osiswitch miniature snap switches incorporate a C/O snap-action, single-break contact. They are characterized by: high electrical ratings for their very small size high repeat accuracy on the tripping points short tripping travel long service life low tripping force
Forces
Terminology
Maximum tripping force: maximum force which must be applied to the operator to move it from the rest (unactuated) position to the trip position (tripping point). Minimum release force: value to which the force on the operator must be reduced to allow the snap action mechanism to return to its rest (unactuated) position. Maximum permissible end of travel force: maximum force that can be applied to the operator at the end of its travel without damaging the switch.
Position / Travel
1. Tripping point: position of the operator in relation to the switch mountings (mounting hole center line) at the instant the switch contact changes state. A. Differential travel: distance between the tripping point and the position at which the snap action mechanism returns to its initial state on release of the operator. 2. Overtravel limit: position of the operator when an extreme force has moved it to the effective end of its available travel. B. Overtravel: distance between the tripping point and the overtravel limit. The reference point for the figures given for forces and travel is a point F, which is situated on the plunger in the case of a basic switch or at 3 mm (0.12 in.) from the end of the plain lever in the case of a lever operated switch.
Limit Switches
Mechanical characteristics
NC
Changeover time
NO T
T1: bounce time T: changeover time
T1
This is the time taken by the moving contact when moving from one fixed contact to another until it becomes fully stable (contact bounce included). This time is related to the inter-contact distance, the mechanical characteristics of the snap action mechanism, and the mass of the moving element. However, due to the snap action mechanisms used, the time is largely independent of the speed of operation. It is normally less than 20 ms (including bounce times of less than 5 ms).
Operating speed and maximum usable operating rate
Our miniature snap switches are suitable for a wide range of operating speeds: generally, from 1 mm/mn to 1 m/s (0.04 in/mn to 3.28 ft/s). The maximum usable operating rate on a light electrical load may be as high as 10 operations/second.
Mounting and operation
Mounting
A BC
To conform to the leakage paths and air gaps in standards EEC 24 - EN/IEC 61058 and EN/IEC 60947: an insulation pad must be inserted between the snap switch and the mounting surface if the latter is metal, manual operation of a metal actuator must only be carried out with the aid of an intermediate actuator made of an insulating material. The installer must ensure adequate protection against direct contact with the output terminals.
Actuation method
A BC
Direct operation: The plunger should preferably be actuated along its axis. However, the majority of our miniature snap switches will accept skewed operation provided the angle of actuation is not more than 45. The travel of the actuator must not be limited to only reaching the tripping point. The actuator must always be operated in such a manner that the plunger reaches a point at least 0.5 times the stated overtravel value of the switch. Also, it should not reach its end of travel nor exceed the maximum permissible end-of-travel force. 09/2007
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature Snap Switches
XEP and XC0
Mounting (continued)
Actuation method (continued)
Lever operators: when actuation is by a roller lever, force should preferably be applied in the direction shown in the diagrams opposite, where the movements involved are fast, the ramp should be so designed as to ensure that the operator is not subjected to any violent impact or abrupt release.
30 30
MountingTightening torque
The tightening torque of the fixing screws must conform to the following values:
of mounting screw 2 Maximum Minimum
25 (2.21) 15 (1.33)
2.5
35 (3.10) 25 (2.21)
3
60 (5.31) 40 (3.54)
3.5
100 (8.85) 60 (5.31)
4
150 (13.28) 100 (8.85)
A BC
A BC
Resistance to shock and vibration depends on the mass of the moving parts and on the forces holding the contacts together. In general, for a miniature snap switch without accessory: vibration > 10 gn, 10 to 500 Hz shock > 50 gn 11 ms 1/2 sine wave
Electrical characteristics
Number of cycles
Operating curves
These indicate the electrical life of the miniature snap switches under standard conditions [20C (68 F), 1 cycle/2 seconds], by showing the number of switching operations which can be performed with given types of load. For sealed snap switches, the operating rate is 1 cycle/6 s.
Dielectric strength
1500 V
The dielectric strength of our miniature snap switches is generally superior to: 1500 V between live parts and earth 1000 V between contacts 600 V between contacts for switches with an inter-contact distance less than 0.3 mm
1000 V
Limit Switches
The insulation resistance of the miniature snap switches is generally greater than 50,000 M, measured at 500 Vdc
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature Snap Switches
Subminiature (DIN 41635 B format, sealed) and Sub-subminiature (DIN 41635 D format)
Catalog numbers
Subminiature design, DIN 41635 B format, sealed
Pre-cabled connections
Weight, g (oz)
Plunger
Dimensions
XEP4E1W7 XEP4E1W7A326 XEP4E1W7A454
= 7,5 7,5 =
39
2,5
4x0,3
1,55
2,25
8,4
2,2
B(4)
2,2
0,5
2,8
r=2
r=
24 F
r=
20
4,8
2,2
r=
F 2
2,2
1,9 2,1
10,3
0,8
1,5
9,1
8,9
2,3
1,4
4,7 4,7
9,6
8,4
Limit Switches
6,4 0,5 1,5
1. 2.
1,2
XEP4E1FD
XEP4E1FDA454
A(4)
B(4)
24
r=
20
19,9
3 19,9 3
,9 19 F
XEP5P1W2Z55B
19,9
XEP5P1W2
13 0,5
Z(4)
r=
0,4x2,9
3,8
4,75
5,1 6,7
4,7
3. 4. Switches sold in lots of 5. A, B, Z: lever fixing positions.
To avoid damage to the mounting spigots, removal of the lever from complete products is not recommended. Levers only for mounting on basic (plunger) snap switches (XEP4E1W7 and XEP4E1FD).
3 5 4,8 3
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature Snap Switches
Subminiature (DIN 41635 B format, sealed) and Sub-subminiature (DIN 41635 D format)
Switch type XEP4E1, XEP5P1W2 Plunger
On end
Environmental characteristics
Lever fixing position (1) Switch actuation Product certifications Degree of protection Operating temperature Enclosure Lever Contact Tags
Lever fixing position (1) e, IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1, c UR us, UL 1054, EN 61058 IP 67 XEP4E1FD, case IP 67 and tags IP 00 XEP4E1W7, case IP 40 and tags IP 00 XEP5P1W2 - 40...+ 105 C XEP4E1FD, -40...+125 C XEP4E1W and XEP5P1 Polyester XEP4, diallyl-phtalate XEP5 AgCdO XEP4E1, Ag XEP5 Tinned brass XEP4E1W, gold plated brass XEP5P1 Stainless steel Stainless steel, glass reinforced polyamide roller
Materials
Mechanical characteristics
Maximum tripping force, N (oz) Minimum release force, N (oz) Maximum permissible end of travel force, N (lb)
A B A B A B A B A B A B
2.5 N (8.99 oz) 2.5 N (8.99 oz) 2 N (7.19 oz) 0.80 N (2.88 oz) 0.80 N (2.88 oz) 0.40 N (1.44 oz) 10 N (2.25 lb) 10 N (2.25 lb) 10 N (2.25 lb) 8.40 +/- 0.3 mm 8.40 +/- 0.3 mm 8.40 mm 0.13 mm 0.13 mm 0.06 mm 0.60 mm 0.60 mm 0.10 mm 0.4 mm 0.3 mm 2 million operating cycles 0.1 million operating cycles
0.63 N (2.27 oz) 1.25 N (4.50 oz) 0.80 N (2.88 oz) 0.20 N (0.72 oz) 0.40 N (1.44 oz) 0.15 N (0.54 oz) 2.5 N (0.56 lb) 5 N (1.12 lb) 10.7 +/- 1.7 mm 9.6 +/- 1.0 mm 9.20 mm 0.52 mm 0.26 mm 0.25 mm 2.40 mm 1.20 mm
0.83 N (2.99 oz) 1.67 N (6.01 oz) 0.27 N (0.97 oz) 0.53 N (1.91 oz) 3.33 N (0.75 lb) 6.67 N (1.50 lb) 15.5 +/- 1.4 mm 14.5 +/- 0.9 mm 0.39 mm 0.20 mm 1.80 mm 0.90 mm
XEP4 XEP5
Minimum overtravel
Electrical characteristics
Operational characteristics XEP4 XEP5 XEP4 XEP5 XEP4 XEP5
AC-15: B300 (Ue: 240 V, Ie: 1.5 A) DC-13: R300 (Ue: 250 V, Ie: 0.1 A) conforming to IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1 Appendix A 125-250 Vac 6.0 A conforming to UL 1054 6 (1) A 250 Vac 10,000 cycles conforming to EN 61058 AC-15: D300 (Ue: 240 V, Ie: 0.3 A) conforming to IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1 Appendix A 7.5 A on 250 V (50/60 Hz) 8.5 A on 250 V (50/60 Hz) XEP4E1W7: 2.8 mm (0.11 in.) cable clip tags XEP4E1FD: Pre-cabled (horizontally in-line), 3 x 0.5 mm2, length 0.5 m (1.6 ft) Solder tags
Operating curves
XEP4E1
Number of cycles
XEP5P1
2
Number of cycles
2x10
6 6
10
10
5 2 10
4
1 2
250 Va
10
5 2 10
3
10 0,05
1. 2.
0,1 0,2
0,5
10 A Current
0,1 0,2
0,5
10 16 A Current
Miniature snap switches fitted with a lever are supplied with the lever fixed in position A (see page 412). For basic (plunger) snap switches, it is possible to fix a lever in position A or B, depending on the required tripping conditions (see page 412). Position of the operator in relation to the switch mountings (mounting hole center line), at the instant the contact changes state.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature Snap Switches
Miniature (DIN 41635 A format)
Catalog numbers
Type of operator
Solder tags
Plunger (2) XEP3S1W2 XEP3S1W6 XEP3S1W3 XEP3S2W2 XEP3S2W6 XEP3S2W3 ZEP3L524 Weight, g (oz) 0.7 (0.02) Roller lever (3) ZEP3L529 Weight, g (oz) 1 (0.04) 4.8 mm (0.19 in.) cable clip tags 6.35 mm (0.25 in.) cable clip tags Solder tags 4.8 mm (0.19 in.) cable clip tags 6.35 mm (0.25 in.) cable clip tags
Flat lever (1) (2) XEP3S1W2B524 XEP3S1W6B524 XEP3S1W3B524 6.3 (0.22) XEP3S2W2B524 XEP3S2W6B524 XEP3S2W3B524 6.3 (0.22)
Roller lever (1) (2) XEP3S1W2B529 XEP3S1W6B529 XEP3S1W3B529 6.6 (0.23) XEP3S2W2B529 XEP3S2W6B529 XEP3S2W3B529 6.6 (0.23)
Standard contacts
Weight, g (oz) 5.6 (0.20) Very low operating force contacts Flat lever (3)
Separate components
Dimensions
XEP3SW2 XEP3SW6 XEP3SW3
2,8
22,2 20,2 3
3,9x0,8
2,8
22,2 20,2 3
2,8
22,2 20,2 3
2,8
= 10,3 = 3
= 10,3 = 3
= 10,3 = 3
2,8
3,2
3,4
3,4
4 1,4 10,3
3,4
9,8 6,2
10,3 3,9
10,3 3,9
3,9
4,8x0,5
3 27,8
ZEP3L529 ZEP3L524
3 27,8 7,1
3,1
3 27,8
4,3
r=2
5,4
0,3
2,4
1. 2. 3.
To avoid damage to the mounting spigots, removal of the lever from complete products is not recommended. Switches sold in lots of 10. Levers only for mounting on basic (plunger) snap switches (XEP3SW2, XEP3SW3 and XEP3SW6), in mounting positions A, B or C.
6,3x0,8
17,4
A BC 47
6,3 15,8
A BC 47
A BC 47
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature Snap Switches
Miniature (DIN 41635 A format)
Switch type Type of operator XEP3SW2 Plunger
On end Case IP 40 and tags IP 00 - 25...+ 125 C
Environmental characteristics
Lever fixing position (1) Switch actuation Product certifications Degree of protection Operating temperature Materials Enclosure Lever Contact Lever fixing position (1) Standard Maximum tripping force, N (oz) Very low force
A B C A B C A B C A B C A B C A B C A B C A B C A B C 0.80 N (2.88 oz) 0.80 N (2.88 oz) 0.80 N (2.88 oz) 0.25 N (0.90 oz) 0.25 N (0.90 oz) 0.25 N (0.90 oz) 0.20 N (0.72 oz) 0.20 N (0.72 oz) 0.20 N (0.72 oz) 0.05 N (0.18 oz) 0.05 N (0.18 oz) 0.05 N (0.18 oz) 20 N (4.50 lb) 20 N (4.50 lb) 20 N (4.50 lb) 14.70+/- 0.4 mm 14.70+/- 0.4 mm 14.70+/- 0.4 mm 0.35 mm 0.35 mm 0.35 mm 1.20 mm 1.20 mm 1.20 mm 1.10 mm 1.10 mm 1.10 mm 0.40 mm 20 million operating cycles 50 million operating cycles 0.20 N (0.72 oz) 0.40 N (1.44 oz) 0.53 N (1.91 oz) 0.06 N (0.22 oz) 0.13 N (0.47 oz) 0.17 N (0.61 oz) 0.05 N (0.18 oz) 0.10 N (0.36 oz) 0.13 N (0.47 oz) 0.01 N (0.04 oz) 0.03 N (0.11 oz) 0.03 N (0.11 oz) 5 N (1.12 lb) 10 N (2.25 lb) 13 N (2.92 lb) 15.20+/- 2.5 mm 15.20+/- 1.0 mm 15.20+/- 0.8 mm 1.40 mm 0.70 mm 0.53 mm 4.80 mm 2.40 mm 1.80 mm 4.40 mm 2.20 mm 1.65 mm
Polyester AgNi Stainless steel Stainless steel, glass reinforced polyamide roller
Mechanical characteristics
Standard Minimum release force, N (oz) Very low force Maximum permissible end of travel force, N (lb) Tripping point (TP) (2) Standard, very low force Standard, very low force Standard, very low force Standard Minimum overtravel Very low force Inter-contact distance Mechanical durability for 2/3 overtravel Standard Very low force
Electrical characteristics
Standard Operational characteristics Very low force Thermal current Connection Standard Very low force
AC-15: B300 (Ue: 240 V, Ie: 1.5 A) DC-13: R300 (Ue: 250 V, Ie: 0.1 A) conforming to IEC/EN 60947-5-1 Appendix A 125-250 Vac 10.1 A1/2 HP conforming to UL 1054 12 (3) A 250 Vac 10,000 cycles conforming to EN 61058-1 AC-15: D300 (Ue: 240 V, Ie: 0.3 A) conforming to IEC/EN 60947-5-1 Appendix A 125-250 Vac 4 A1/10 HP conforming to UL 1054 4 (1) A 250 Vac 50,000 cycles conforming to EN 61058-1 15 A on 250 V (50/60 Hz) 5 A on 250 V (50/60 Hz) XEP3 SW2: solder tags, XEP3 SW6: 4.8 mm (0.19 in.) cable clip tags XEP3 SW3: 6.35 mm (0.25 in.) cable clip tags.
Operating curves
Number of cycles
250 V
Number of cycles
XEP3S1
XEP3S2
250 V
Resistive circuit Inductive circuit Cos 0.8
1 2
Current 4 A
1. 2.
Miniature snap switches fitted with a lever are supplied with the lever fixed in position B (see page 414). For basic (plunger) snap switches, it is possible to fix a lever in position A, B or C, depending on the required tripping conditions (see page 414). Position of the operator in relation to the switch mountings (mounting hole center line), at the instant the contact changes state.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature Snap Switches
Sealed Design Pre-Cabled
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
Single-pole C/O snap action
1 2 4
XC010L2
XC011L2
Weight, kg (lb)
0.145 (0.320)
0.150 (0.331)
Dimensions
XC010L2
12 12,3 PA 10,3 1
2000
32
26
20 6
16 49 71
XC011L2
r6 18,3 PA
10,3
2000
32
26
20 6
16 49 71
24
24
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature Snap Switches
Sealed Design Pre-Cabled
Switch type XC010 XC011
Environmental characteristics
Switch actuation Product certifications Degree of protection Operating temperature Internal housing Casing Materials Mounting support Contact
Steel, zinc passivated Ag On end, flat plunger (1) e, IEC 60947-5-1 IP 66 0...85 C (32185 F) Metal Nitrile On end, domed plunger (1)
Mechanical characteristics
Maximum tripping force Minimum release force Maximum permissible end of travel force Tripping point (TP) (2) Maximum differential travel Minimum overtravel Inter-contact distance Mechanical durability
5.3 N (1.19 lb) 1.5 N (0.34 lb) 30 N (6.74 lb) 11.4 0.4 mm 0.2 mm 0.2 mm 0.5 mm 2 million operating cycles 17.4 0.5 mm
Electrical characteristics
Operational current Thermal current/insulation voltage Connection Electrical durability
1 A on 24 V (50/60 Hz) 12 A/60 V A05 VVF cable, 3 x 0.75 mm2, length 2 m (6.6 ft), overall diameter 7.6 mm (0.30 in.) AC-15: 0.5 million operating cycles
Operating curve
1. 2. Manual actuation must be made by an intermediate insulated part, in order to meet basic safety requirements. One of the two mounting holes must also be used as an earth protection terminal. Distance between the base of the switch and the top of the plunger at the instant the contact changes state (see dimensions, page 416).
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD
b XCMD pre-cabled
v With head for linear movement (plunger). Mounting by the body.
520341
561279
Page 420 v With head for linear movement (plunger). Mounting by the head.
520344 561280
Page 420 v With head for rotary movement (lever) or multi-directional. Mounting by the body.
520346
Page 421
520347
Page 424 v With head for rotary movement (lever) or multi-directional. Mounting by the body.
561284
Page 425
561285
561283
520343
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD
Environmental characteristics
Conforming to standards Product certifications Protective treatment Ambient air temperature Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Materials Repeat accuracy Products Machine assemblies
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1, UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 IEC 60204-1, EN 60204-1 UL, CSA (except products with special cables), CCC Standard version: TC Operation: -25+70 C (-13+158 F). Storage: -40+70 C (-40+158 F) XCMD snap action: 5 gn. XCMD slow break: 25 gn (10500 Hz) conforming to IEC 60068-2-6 25 gn (18 ms) conforming to IEC 60068-2-27 Class I conforming to IEC 61-140 and NF C 20-030 NEMA Types 1, 2, 4, 12, 13 IP 66, IP 67 and IP 68 (1) conforming to IEC 60529 IK 06 conforming to EN 50102 Bodies and heads: Zamak zinc alloy 0.05 mm on the tripping points, with 1 million operating cycles for head with end plunger
Protection against prolonged immersion: the test conditions are subject to agreement between the manufacturer and the user.
Switches with 3 and 4 contacts c DC-13; R300 (Ue = 250 V, Ie = 0.1 A), conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix A, Rated operational characteristics Pre-cabled switches Switches with 4-pin M12 connector Switches with 5-pin M12 connector Switches with 5-pin 7/8" 16UN connector
Ithe = 6 A for 2 contacts, 4 A for 3 contacts, 3 A for 4 contacts Ui = 250 V, Ie = 3 A maximum, Ithe = 3 A Ui = 60 V, Ie = 4 A maximum, Ithe = 4 A Ui = 250 V, Ie = 6 A maximum, Ithe = 6 A Ui = 400 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 U imp = 4 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 N/C contacts with positive opening operation conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix K, EN 60947-5-1 25 m conforming to IEC 60255-7 category 3 6 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl) Snap action contact: 0.01 m/minute (0.03 ft/minute) Slow break contact: 6 m/minute (19.68 ft/minute) Conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix C Utilization categories AC-15 and DC-13 Maximum operating rate: 3600 operating cycles/hour Load factor: 0.5
Rated insulation voltage Rated impulse withstand voltage Positive operation (depending on model) Resistance across terminals Electric shock protection Minimum actuation speed Electrical durability
XCMD snap action (N/C + N/O, N/C + N/C, N/C + N/C + N/O, N/C + N/C + N/O + N/O contacts)
Millions of operating cycles
5 4 3 2 1 0,5
Ithe 48 V 110 V
230 V
0,1 0,5 1 2
12/24 V
0,1
4 56 10 Current in A
0,5
4 56
10
Current in A
d.c. supply c
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD, Pre-Cabled
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Plunger (mounting by the head)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
2-pole N/C + N/O snap action XCMD2110L1
BK BU
GN-YE
1,8 4,2(P) 5mm 0,8
XCMD2111L1
1,8 4,2(P) 5mm 0,8
XCMD2102L1
3,1(A) 7(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH BN-BU
XCMD2124L1
11,2(A) 25(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH BN-BU
XCMD21F0L1
1,8 4,2(P) 5mm 0,8
XCMD21G1L1
1,8 4,2(P) 5mm 0,8
XCMD21F2L1
3,1(A) 7(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH BN-BU
BK-WH
BN
0 1,4
mm
4,9 mm
0 1,4
mm
XCMD2510L1
XCMD2511L1
XCMD2502L1
XCMD2524L1
XCMD25F0L1
XCMD25G1L1
XCMD25F2L1
1,8 3,1(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH BN-BU
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU
11,2(A) 19,5(P) 0 16 mm
1,8 3,1(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH BN-BU
BK-WH
BN
2,6 5 mm
4,6 mm
2,6 5 mm
BK
RD
ZCMD29L1 + ZCE11
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH
ZCMD29L1 + ZCE02
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH
ZCMD29L1 + ZCE24
11,2(A) 25(P)
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH
ZCMD29L1 + ZCEF0
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH
ZCMD29L1 + ZCEG1
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH
ZCMD29L1 + ZCEF2
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH
RD-WH
BK-WH
4,9 mm
ZCMD39L1 + ZCE10
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH BN-BU
ZCMD39L1 + ZCE11
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH BN-BU
ZCMD39L1 + ZCE02
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU
ZCMD39L1 + ZCE24
11,2(A) 25(P)
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BU-BN BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BU-BN
ZCMD39L1 + ZCEF0
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH BN-BU
ZCMD39L1 + ZCEG1
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH BN-BU
ZCMD39L1 + ZCEF2
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU
1,8 4,2(P)
1,8 4,2(P)
3,1(A) 7(P)
1,8 4,2(P)
1,8 4,2(P)
3,1(A) 7(P)
RD-WH
BK-WH
BN
0 0,8
5 mm
0 0,8
5 mm
0 1,4
mm
4,9 mm
0 0,8
5 mm
0 0,8
5 mm
0 1,4
mm
RD-WH
BK-WH
RD
BU
BK
VT
RD-WH
BK-WH
VT-WH
BN
Limit Switches
RD
BU
BK
3-pole N/C + N/C + N/O break ZCMD37L1 + before make, slow break ZCE10
1,8 3,1(P)
ZCMD37L1 + ZCE11
1,8 3,1(P)
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU
ZCMD37L1 + ZCE02
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU
ZCMD37L1 + ZCE24
11,2(A) 19,5(P)
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BU-BN
ZCMD37L1 + ZCEF0
1,8 3,1(P)
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU
ZCMD37L1 + ZCEG1
1,8 3,1(P)
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU
ZCMD37L1 + ZCEF2
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU
GN-YE
BN
2,6
5 mm
2,6
5 mm
4,6 mm
16 mm
2,6
5 mm
2,6
5 mm
4,6 mm
0.180 (0.397)
0.180 (0.397)
0.185 (0.408)
0.200 (0.441)
0.195 (0.430)
0.220 (0.485)
0.205 (0.452)
ZCMD41L1 + ZCE10
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH
ZCMD41L1 + ZCE11
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH
ZCMD41L1 + ZCE02
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH BK-BK RD-RD-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH
ZCMD41L1 + ZCE24
11,2(A) 25(P)
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BU-BN VT-VT-WH BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BU-BN VT-VT-WH
ZCMD41L1 + ZCEF0
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH
ZCMD41L1 + ZCEG1
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH
ZCMD41L1 + ZCEF2
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH BK-BK RD-RD-WH BN-BU VT-VT-WH
1,8 4,2(P)
1,8 4,2(P)
3,1(A) 7(P)
1,8 4,2(P)
1,8 4,2(P)
3,1(A) 7(P)
0 0,8
5 mm
0 0,8
5 mm
0 1,4
mm
4,9 mm
0 0,8
5 mm
0 0,8
5 mm
0 1,4
mm
0.165 (0.364)
0.180 (0.397)
0.175 (0.386)
0.200 (0.441)
0.185 (0.408)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed For tripping Minimum force or For positive torque opening Cabling
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 8.5 N (1.91 lb) 42.5 N (9.55 lb)
2
On end
By 30 cam
On end
By 30 cam
0.1 m/s (0.33 ft/s) 7 N (1.57 lb) 35 N (7.87 lb) 2.5 N (0.56 lb) 12.5 N (2.81 lb)
2
PvR cable, 1 m (3.3 ft) long: 5 x 0.75 mm for 2-pole contact versions; 7 x 0.5 mm for 3-pole contact versions; 9 x 0.34 mm for 4-pole contact versions. For other cable lengths, see page 430.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD, Pre-Cabled
Type of head Rotary (mounting by the body) Multi-directional
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
2-pole N/C + N/O snap action
BU BK
XCMD2115L1
25 70(P) 90 12
XCMD2116L1
25 70(P) 90 12
XCMD2117L1
25 70(P) 90 12
XCMD2145L1
25 70(P) 90 12
XCMD2106L1
20
BK-BK-WH BU-BN BK-BK-WH BU-BN
GN-YE
BK-WH
BN
10
GN-YE
BK-WH
BN
BU
BK
XCMD2515L1
25 45(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU
XCMD2516L1
25 45(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU
XCMD2517L1
25 45(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU
XCMD2545L1
25 45(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU
XCMD2506L1
20
BK-BK-WH BN-BU
36 90
36 90
36 90
36 90
40
GN-YE
BK
RD
ZCMD29L1 + ZCE06
20
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH
RD-WH
BK-WH
25 70(P) 90 12
25 70(P) 90 12
25 70(P) 90 12
25 70(P) 90 12
10
GN-YE
RD
BU
BK
ZCMD39L1 + ZCE06
20
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BU-BN BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BU-BN
RD-WH
BK-WH
BN
25 70(P)
25 70(P)
25 70(P)
25 70(P)
0 12
90
0 12
90
0 12
90
0 12
90
10
GN-YE
RD-WH
BK-WH
BN
ZCMD37L1 + ZCE06
20
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BN-BU
45(P) 36 90
45(P) 36 90
45(P) 36 90
45(P) 36 90
40
0.220 (0.485)
0.225 (0.496)
0.220 (0.485)
0.230 (0.507)
0.180 (0.397)
ZCMD41L1 + ZCE06
20
BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BU-BN VT-VT-WH BK-BK-WH RD-RD-WH BU-BN VT-VT-WH
GN-YE
25 70(P)
25 70(P)
25 70(P)
25 70(P)
RD-WH
BK-WH
VT-WH
BN
0 12
90
0 12
90
0 12
90
0 12
90
10
0.205 (0.452)
0.200 (0.441)
0.210 (0.463) 0.160 (0.353) N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mountings. By 30 cam By any moving part
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum force or torque Cabling NOTE: For more information, consult pages 426428. For tripping For positive opening
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.5 Nm (4.43 lb-in) PvR cable, 1 m (3.3 ft) long: 5 x 0.75 mm2 for 2-pole contact versions; 7 x 0.5 mm2 for 3-pole contact versions, 9 x 0.34 mm2 for 4-pole contact versions. For other cable lengths, see page 430. 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s)
Limit Switches
RD
BU
BK
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD, Pre-CabledDimensions
XCMD210L1 XCMD211L1 XCMD202L1
(1)
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(2)
XCMD224L1
XCMD2F0L1
XCMD2G1L1
19 12
e f
(3)
24
(3)
45
(1)
85
76
52
88
(2)
(2)
50
(2)
88
52
(2)
1. 2. 3. e: f: 2 mounting holes 4.2 mm (0.17 in.), counterbored 8 mm (0.31 in.) by 4 mm (0.16 in.) deep. Overall diameter of cable 7.5 mm (0.30 in.). Mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.). 8 mm (0.31 in.) max, panel cut-out 12.5 mm (0.49 in.). 8 mm (0.31 in.) max, panel cut-out 16.5 mm (0.65 in.).
Limit Switches
XCMD2F2L1
36
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD, Pre-CabledDimensions
XCMD215L1
XCMD216L1
XCMD217L1
31
31
31
(1)
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(2)
XCMD245L1
XCMD206L1
33 5,5 16
33,583,5
53103
93143
(1)
(1)
16
20 30
(2)
(2)
15 15
1. 2. e: f: 2 mounting holes 4.2 mm (0.17 in.), counterbored 8 mm (0.31 in.) by 4 mm (0.16 in.) deep. Overall diameter of cable 7.5 mm (0.30 in.). 8 mm (0.31 in.) max, panel cut-out 12.5 mm (0.49 in.). 8 mm (0.31 in.) max, panel cut-out 16.5 mm (0.65 in.).
Limit Switches
40
40
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD, Integral or Remote Connector
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Plunger (mounting by the head)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
Single-pole C/O snap action + integral M12 4-pin connector 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action + integral M12 5-pin connector 2-pole N/C + N/C snap action + integral M12 5-pin connector Weight, kg (lb) 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action + M12 5-pin connector on 0.8 m (2.6 ft) flying lead 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action + 7/8" 16UN 5-pin connector on 0.8 m (2.6 ft) flying lead Weight, kg (lb) Contact operation XCMD2110M12
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
XCMD2111M12
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
XCMD2102M12
3,1(A) 7(P)
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
XCMD2124M12
11,2(A) 25(P)
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
XCMD21F0M12
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
XCMD21G1M12
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
XCMD21F2M12
3,1(A) 7(P)
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
mm 1,4
4,9 mm
mm 1,4
XCMD2110C12
1,8 4,2(P) 0
XCMD2111C12
1,8 4,2(P)
XCMD2102C12
3,1(A) 7(P)
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
XCMD2124C12
11,2(A) 25(P)
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
XCMD21F0C12
1,8 4,2(P) 0
XCMD21G1C12
1,8 4,2(P) 0
XCMD21F2C12
3,1(A) 7(P) mm 1,4 ZCMD29C12 + ZCEF2 3,1(A) 7(P)
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
0 5mm 5mm 0 mm 0,8 0,8 1,4 ZCMD29C12 + ZCMD29C12 + ZCMD29C12 + ZCE10 ZCE11 ZCE02 1,8 4,2(P)
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
4,9 mm
ZCMD29C12 + ZCE24
11,2(A) 25(P)
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
3,1(A) 7(P)
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
0 0,8
0.085 (0.187)
5mm
5mm
1,4 mm
4,9 mm
0 0,8
0.100 (0.220)
5mm
0 0,8
0.125 (0.276)
5mm
1,4 mm
0.090 (0.198)
0.105 (0.231)
0.110 (0.243)
Limit Switches
ZCMD21L08R12 + ZCE24
11,2(A) 25(P)
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
ZCMD21L08R12 + ZCEF0
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
ZCMD21L08R12 + ZCEG1
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
ZCMD21L08R12 + ZCEF2
3,1(A) 7(P)
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
1,8 4,2(P) 0
0 0 0 5mm 5mm 5mm 5mm 0 0 mm mm 0 4,9 mm 0,8 0,8 0,8 0,8 1,4 1,4 ZCMD21L08U78 ZCMD21L08U78 ZCMD21L08U78 ZCMD21L08U78 ZCMD21L08U78 ZCMD21L08U78 ZCMD21L08U78 + ZCE10 + ZCE11 + ZCE02 + ZCE24 + ZCEF0 + ZCEG1 + ZCEF2 1,8 4,2(P) 0 0,8
0.150 (0.331) contact open
4-5 1-2 4-5 1-2
1,8 4,2(P)
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
3,1(A) 7(P)
1,8 4,2(P)
1,8 4,2(P)
11,2(A) 25(P)
4-5 1-2 4-5 1-2
5mm
mm
4,9 mm
mm
0.150 (0.331)
0.170 (0.375)
0.165 (0.364)
0.190 (0.419)
contact closed
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation
On end By 30 cam On end By 30 cam
Type of actuation
Maximum actuation speed Minimum For tripping force or For positive torque opening Positive operation
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 8.5 N (1.91 lb) 42.5 N (9.55 lb) 7 N (1.57 lb) 35 N (7.87 lb) 2.5 N (0.56 lb) 12.5 N (2.81 lb) 8.5 N (1.91 lb) 42.5 N (9.55 lb)
Although their design is identical to the pre-cabled switches, the switches incorporating an M12 4-pin connector cannot be marked with the because they are single-pole C/O.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD, Integral or Remote Connector
Type of head Rotary (mounting by the body) Multi-directional
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
XCMD2115M12 Single-pole C/O snap action With integral M12 4-pin connector
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
XCMD2116M12
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
XCMD2117M12
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
XCMD2145M12
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
25
70(P) 90 0
25
70(P) 90
25
70(P) 90 0
25
70(P) 90
XCMD2106M12 20
1-2 1-4 1-2 1-4
0 12
0 12
10
12
12
XCMD2115C12 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action With integral M12 5-pin connector
25 70(P) 90 12
XCMD2116C12
25 70(P) 90 12
XCMD2117C12
25 70(P) 90 12
XCMD2145C12
25 70(P) 90 12
XCMD2106C12
20 10
2-pole N/C + N/C snap action With integral M12 5-pin connector
ZCMD29C12 + ZCE06
20 10
0.085 (0.187)
70(P) 90 0
70(P) 90 0
70(P) 90 0
70(P) 90
0 12
12
0.130 (0.287)
12
0.125 (0.276)
12
0.135 (0.298)
Weight, kg (lb) 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action With M12 5-pin connector on 0.8 m (2.6 ft) flying lead
0.125 (0.276)
25
70(P) 90
25
70(P) 90
0 12
0 12
25
70(P) 90
25
70(P) 90
0 12
0 12
20 10
2-pole N/C + N/O snap action With 7/8" 16UN 5-pin connector on 0.8 m (2.6 ft) flying lead
25
70(P) 90
25
70(P) 90
0 12
0 12
25
70(P) 90
25
70(P) 90
0 12
0 12
20 10
0.205 (0.452)
0.200 (0.441)
0.210 (0.463)
0.160 (0.353)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mounting.
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum force or torque Positive operation For tripping For positive opening
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.5 Nm (4.43 lb-in) Although their design is identical to the pre-cabled switches, the switches incorporating an M12 4-pin connector cannot be marked with the symbol because they are single-pole C/O. 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s) By 30 cam By any moving part
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMDModular
ZCE 63
ZCE F2
Spring rod
ZCE 08
Cats whisker
ZCE 06
Limit Switches
1.
ZCE 10
ZCE 13
Body with 2-pole N/C + N/O break before make, slow break contact
ZCM D25
Body with 3-pole N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break contact
ZCM D37
ZCM D21
ZCM D29
ZCM D39
(1)
(1)
(1)
(1)
(1)
Pre-cabled connection components: replace the in the catalog number with the required cable length in meters, either: 1, 2, 3, 5, 7 or 10. Example: ZCMC21L becomes ZCMC21L7 for a 7 m (23.0 ft) cable. Note: only cable lengths of 1, 2 and 5 m (3.3, 6.6, and 16.4 ft) are available for pre-cabled connection components ZCMC37L and ZCMC39L.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMDModular
Dimensions: mm (in.)
ZCY 22
ZCY 91
ZCY 45
ZCY 46
ZCY 18
ZCY 19
ZCY 12
ZCY 15
ZCY 16
ZCY 26
Pre-cabled bodies with 4-pole N/C + N/C + N/O + N/O snap action contact
ZCM D41L1 ZCM D41L2 ZCM D41L5
Bodies with integral connector, with 2-pole snap action contact: N/C + N/O, M12 5-pin connector
ZCM D21C12
Body with 7/8" 16UN 5-pin connector on 0.8 m (2.6 ft) flying lead, with 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action contact
ZCM D21L08U78
Body with M12 5-pin connector on 0.8 m (2.6 ft) flying lead, with 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action contact
ZCM D21L08R12
1.
Cannot be used on bodies ZCMD21, ZCMD29, ZCMD39, ZCMD41, ZCMD21C12, ZCMD21M12, ZCMD29C12, ZCMD21L08.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMDModular
Special Features and Catalog Number Explanation Interpretation of the Catalog Number
XCM
21
02 q
L1
Contact Description 211 N.O. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Silver 251 N.O. + 1 N.C. Slow Make/Break Silver 291 N.C. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Silver 371 N.O. + 2 N.C. Slow Make/Break Silver 391 N.O. + 2 N.C. Snap Action Silver 412 N.O. + 2 N.C. Snap Action Silver 611 N.O. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Gold 651 N.O. + 1 N.C. Slow Make/Break Gold 691 N.C. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Gold 771 N.O. + 2 N.C. Slow Make/Break Gold 791 N.O. + 2 N.C. Snap Action Gold 812 N.O. + 2 N.C. Snap Action Gold
Cable Length L11 m (3.3 ft) L22 m (6.6 ft) L33 m (9.8 ft) L55 m (16.4 ft) L77 m (23.0 ft) L1010 m (32.8 ft)
Head Assembly k 01Rotary Head without Lever Arm 02Steel Roller Plunger 05Rotary Head without lever arm / Programmable f 06Cat Whisker 07Spring Rod with Plastic End c
Body (or base) DMetal Modular NPlastic (not modular) CPlug-in Base (with ZCM only)
08Spring Rod c 09Maint. Rotary without Arm c 10Top Push Rod Plunger 11Booted Top Push Rod Pl. 13Top Ball Bearing Plunger c 14Adjustable Top Plunger c
Limit Switches
Important Note: Use this chart for interpretation only. Some possibilities are not shown and some combinations of components are not available. Some switches are not modular. Refer to the additional information in this catalog. For interpretation of catalog numbers for heads and levers, see page 426.
c q k f Consult your local field sales office for availability. Last two digits of lever catalog number occupy this position when rotary heads with levers are required. See page 426 for levers. See page 431 for available levers, specifically allowed for the ZCE05 programmable head.
21One-way Horiz. Plastic Roller 24Retractable Steel Roller, 9 mm (0.35 in.) 27One-way Vert. Plastic Roller 28One-way Horiz. or Vert. Roller 29Booted Top Roller Plunger c 62Adjust. Side Push Rod Pl. c 63Side Push Rod Plunger c 64Horiz. Side Roller Plunger c 65Vertical Side Roller Plunger c 66Side Ball Bearing Plunger c 67Horizontal Cat Whisker c F0M12 Threaded Plunger Head c F2M12 Threaded Roller Pl. Hd. c G1M16 Threaded Booted Pl. Hd. c H0M18 Threaded Plunger Head c H2M18 Threaded Roller Pl. Hd. c
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMDModular
Components
Plug-in base with PVR cable f Contact type ZCMC2kLk 2-pole
2-pole N.C. + N.O. snap action
BU BK
Diagram
Catalog number c
Weight lb (kg)
GN-YE
BK-WH
BK-WH
BK-WH
BK
BK-WH
BK
BK-WH
BK
BK-WH
BK-WH
BN
BU
BK
BN
BU
BN
BU
BN
BU
BN
BU
BK
BN
BU
BK
BN
1 (3.3)
ZCMC21L1
0.22 (0.100)
GN-YE
2 (6.6)
ZCMC21L2
0.42 (0.190)
GN-YE
3 (9.8)
ZCMC21L3
0.62 (0.280)
GN-YE
5 (16.4)
ZCMC21L5
1.00 (0.440)
GN-YE
7 (23.0)
ZCMC21L7
1.50 (0.700)
GN-YE
10 (32.8)
ZCMC21L10
2.10 (0.970)
GN-YE
1 (3.3)
ZCMC25L1
0.22 (0.100)
BK-WH
BK-WH
BK-WH
BK
BK-WH
BK-WH
f
c
The plug-in base receptacle must match the contact pin outs in the body. Only the length of cord is variable. See page 426 for 3-pole plug-in bases with cord. The 4-pole units and connector versions do not have component modular bases. See pages 420 and 421 for 4 contact bodies, and pages 424 and 425 for M12 connector bodies. Available cable lengths: ZCMC29L: 1, 2, 3, 5, 7, and 10 m (3.3, 6.6, 9.8, 16.4, 23.0, and 32.8 ft) ZCMC37L: 1, 2, and 5 m (3.3, 6.6, and 16.4 ft) ZCMC39L: 1, 2, and 5 m (3.3, 6.6, and 16.4 ft)
BN
BU
BK
BN
BU
BN
BU
BK
BN
BU
BK
BN
GN-YE
2 (6.6)
ZCMC25L2
0.42 (0.190)
GN-YE
3 (9.8)
ZCMC25L3
0.62 (0.280)
GN-YE
5 (16.4)
ZCMC25L5
1.00 (0.440)
GN-YE
7 (23.0)
ZCMC25L7
1.50 (0.700)
GN-YE
10 (32.8)
ZCMC25L10
2.10 (0.970)
Limit Switches
BU
BK
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMDModular
Components Pre-cabled connection components (CEI cable) (1)
Type of contact
520719
Wiring diagram
Catalog Number
Weight kg (lb)
2-pole
1 (3.28) 2 (6.56)
BU BK
0.100 (0.220) 0.190 (0.419) 0.280 (0.617) 0.440 (0.970) 0.700 (1.543) 0.970 (2.138)
ZCMC21E
BK-WH
BN
3 (9.84)
GN-YE
Wiring diagram
Weight kg (lb)
BK-WH
BU
GN-YE
BK
BK
BK-WH
N/C + N/O break before make, slow break ZCMD6 ZCMD7 3-pole
BU
RD-WH
BK-WH
RD
BN
ZCMD61
0.055 (0.121)
GN-YE
ZCMD69
0.055 (0.121)
GN-YE
BN
ZCMD65
0.055 (0.121)
RD
BU
BK
RD-WH
BK-WH
4-pole
1 (3.28)
RD BU BK
BN
RD-WH
BK-WH
VT-WH
VT
BN
Limit Switches
RD
RD-WH
BK-WH
BU
GN-YE
BK
BN
ZCMD79
0.055 (0.121)
GN-YE
ZCMD77
0.055 (0.121)
GN-YE
2 (6.56) 5 (16.40)
1. 2.
Cable not UL, CSA certified. bodies with contacts assuring positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
ZCMD81L
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD
562245
Wiring diagram
Connector
Catalog Number
Weight kg (lb)
M12 5-pin
ZCMD69C12
0.065 (0.143)
M12 4-pin
ZCMD61M12
0.065 (0.143)
Accessories
Description Rotary head, without lever, spring return, for actuation from left AND right or from left OR right (2)
566638
Catalog Number
Weight kg (lb)
0.045 (0.099)
ZCE05
566637
ZCY12, ZCY15, ZCY16, ZCY17, ZCY18, ZCY19, ZCY22, ZCY23, ZCY25, ZCE05 ZCY26, ZCY39, ZCY53, ZCY54, ZCY55, ZCY81 XCMZ06
Spacer for mounting multi-track XCMD Spacer for angular positioning of heads with adjustable levers, for values other than -90, 0 and 90 XCMZ07
XCMZ07
XCMZ06
562246
Bodies with contacts, with rotary head (without operating lever), pre-cabled
Type of contact 2-pole
BK
Wiring diagram
Catalog Number
Weight kg (lb)
GN-YE
BK-WH
BK-WH
BU
BK
BN
1 (3.28)
XCMD2101L1
GN-YE
Bodies with contacts, with rotary head (without operating lever), integral connector
Type of contact 2-pole XCMD201L1
562247
Wiring diagram
BN
1 (3.28)
XCMD2501L1
0.180 (0.397)
Connector
Catalog Number
Weight kg (lb)
M12 5-pin
XCMD2101C12
0.110 (0.243)
M12 4-pin
XCMD2101M12
0.110 (0.243)
bodies with contacts or head assuring positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator. For programming see page 400.
XCMD210112
Limit Switches
BU
0.180 (0.397)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMDConnector Cabling Accessories
Catalog Numbers of suitable pre-wired female connectors
Type of connector L = 2 m (6.56 ft) With cable L = 5 m (16.40 ft) L = 10 m (32.81 ft) Weight, kg (lb) M12 straight, 4-pin 4 A, 250 V
XZCP1169L2 XZCP1169L5 XZCP1169L10 0.105 (0.231)
Connections
XCMD with connector 4-pin, M12 5-pin, M12
3 A250 V 1 = common 2 = N/C 13=t 4 = N/O 4 A60 V
5-pin, 7/8" 16 UN
2 3 4
2 3 4
XCMD21 or ZCMD21 12 = N/C 1 34 = N/O 5=t XCMD29 or ZCMD29 12 = N/C 34 = N/C 5=t
3 4 5
5-pin, 7/8" 16 UN
2 1 4 3
2 1 4
3 2 1
Dimensions
XZCP116L XZCP1264L XZCP1771L
Limit Switches
26
42
32 40
L: cable length 2, 5, or 10 m (6.6, 16.4, or 32.8 ft)
L 55 L
Distances required for plug-in connectors M12 straight connector M12 elbowed connector Connector on flying lead
20
d d
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD, Integral or Remote Connector
XCMD210M12 XCMD211M12 XCMD202M12
(1)
(1)
50 70,4 92,4
(1)
50
60
82
50
M12
XCMD224M12
XCMD2F0M12
70 92
XCMD2G1M12
12
21,4 M12x1 45 e 24
f M16X1 7
(1)
50 85 107
98
52
88
110
M12 16
30 30 52
XCMD2F2M12
3,5 10,6 e
XCMD245M12
50
38
53103
93143
M12x1 110 88
52
(1)
(1)
116 94
M12 16
30 52
32,4
XCMD206M12
1,2
1. e: f: 2 mounting holes 4.2 mm (0.17 in.), counterbored 8 mm (0.31 in.) by 4 mm (0.16 in.) deep. 8 mm (0.31 in.) max., panel cut-out 12.5 mm (0.49 in.), mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.). 8 mm (0.31 in.) max., panel cut-out 16.5 mm (0.65 in.), mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.).
182
204
Limit Switches
36
34,5
115165
54
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD, Integral or Remote Connector
ZCMD21L08 + ZCE10 ZCMD21L08 + ZCE11 ZCMD21L08 + ZCE02
(1)
60
70
30
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(2)
ZCMD21L08 + ZCE24
ZCMD21L08 + ZCEF0
ZCMD21L08 + ZCEG1
12 9
(1)
19
45
85
24
76
52
88
1. 2. e: f:
2 mounting holes 4.2 mm (0.17 in.), counterbored 8 mm (0.31 in.) by 4 mm (0.16 in.) deep. Overall diameter 7.5 mm (0.30 in.). 8 mm (0.31 in.) max., panel cut-out 12.5 mm (0.49 in.), mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.). 8 mm (0.31 in.) max., panel cut-out 16.5 mm (0.65 in.), mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.).
50
38
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Metal
Universal, XCMD, Integral or Remote Connector
ZCMD21L08 + ZCEF2 ZCMD21L08 + ZCE01 + ZCY15/16/17 ZCMD21L08 + ZCE01 + ZCY45
31
33 5,5 16 33,583,5 20 30 15 15
53103
36
88
(1)
52 94
(1)
16
32,4
ZCMD21L08 + ZCE06
(1)
40
93143
54
(2)
1. 2. e: f:
2 mounting holes 4.2 mm (0.17 in.), counterbored 8 mm (0.31 in.) by 4 mm (0.16 in.) deep. Overall diameter 7.5 mm (0.30 in.). 8 mm (0.31 in.) max., panel cut-out 12.5 mm (0.49 in.), mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.). 8 mm (0.31 in.) max., panel cut-out 16.5 mm (0.65 in.), mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.).
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Plastic
XCMN
b XCMN
pre-cabled
v With head for linear movement (plunger). Mounting by the body.
Page 438 v With head for linear movement (plunger). Mounting by the head.
530751
530753
Page 439
520371
530752
530750
520366
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Plastic
XCMN
Environmental characteristics
Products Conforming to standards Machine assemblies Product certifications Protective treatment Standard version Operation Ambient air temperature Storage Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Materials Bodies Heads Conforming to IEC 60068-2-6
- 40+70 C (-40+158 F) 5 gn (10500 Hz) IEC 60204-1, EN 60204-1 UL, CSA, CCC TC - 25+70 C (-13+158 F) IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1, UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14
Ui = 400 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-1 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 U imp = 4 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 6 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Plastic
XCMN, Pre-Cabled
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Plunger (mounting by the head)
Type of operator
Thermoplastic roller M12 with metal end lever plunger, plunger 1 direction of actuation
M12 with steel roller M12 with steel roller plunger for lateral plunger for traverse cam approach cam approach
Catalog Numbers
2-pole N/C + N/O snap action
BU BK
XCMN2110L1
1,8 4,2(P) 5mm 0,8
XCMN2102L1
3,1(A) 7(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH BN-BU
XCMN2103L1
3,1(A) 7(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH BN-BU
XCMN2121L1
6,5(A) 14 (P) mm 2,8
XCMN21F0L1
1,8 4,2(P) 5mm 0,8
XCMN21F2L1
3,1(A) 7(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH BN-BU
XCMN21F3L1
3,1(A) 7(P)
BK-BK-WH BN-BU BK-BK-WH BN-BU
BK-WH
BN
0 1,4
mm
0 1,4
mm
0 1,4
mm
0 1,4
mm
0.080 (0.176)
0.080 (0.176)
0.090 (0.198)
0.065 (0.143)
0.095 (0.209)
0.095 (0.209)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum For tripping force or For positive torque opening Cabling
On end By 30 cam On end By 30 cam
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 8.5 N (1.91 lb) 42.5 N (9.55 lb)
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 2.5 N (0.56 lb) 12.5 N (2.81 lb) 8.5 N (1.91 lb) 42.5 N (9.55 lb)
Dimensions
XCMN2110L1 XCMN2102L1, XCMN2103L1 XCMN21F2L1, XCMN21F3L1
3,5
11,6 30,4
(1)
3,5
24
39
76
52
50
40
Limit Switches
10,6 M12x1 36
(1)
20
50 70,4
50
60
40
40
88
16
20 30
(2)
16
20 30
(2)
16 30
52
(2)
XCMN2121L1
XCMN21F0L1
16
M12x1
1.
(1)
2. e:
16 16 20 30
(2)
30
(2)
2 mounting holes 4.2 mm (0.17 in.), counterbored 8 mm (0.31 in.) by 4 mm (0.16 in.) deep. Overall diameter 7.5 mm (0.30 in.). 8 mm (0.31 in.) max, panel cut-out 12.5 mm (0.49 in.), mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.).
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Miniature, Plastic
XCMN, Pre-Cabled
Type of head Rotary (mounting by the body) Multi-directional
Type of operator
Variable length Round thermoplastic thermoplastic roller rod lever 6 mm lever (0.24 in.) (1)
Catalog Numbers
2-pole N/C + N/O snap action
BK BU
XCMN2115L1
25 70(P) 90 12
XCMN2145L1
25 70(P) 90 12
XCMN2159L1
25 90 12
XCMN2107L1
20
BK-BK-WH BU-BN BK-BK-WH BU-BN
XCMN2106L1
20
BK-BK-WH BU-BN BK-BK-WH BU-BN
BK-WH
BN
10
10
0.105 (0.231)
0.080 (0.176)
0.085 (0.187)
0.080 (0.176)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mountings.
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum force or torque Cabling For tripping For positive opening
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.5 Nm (4.43 lb-in) PvR cable, 4 x 0.75 mm2, length 1 m (3.28 ft) 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s) 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s), any direction By 30 cam By any moving part
Dimensions
XCMN2115L1 XCMN2159L1 XCMN2107L1
168
(1)
54 232
6,4
(1)
94
(1)
40
40
16 16 32,4 20 30
(2)
40,5
20 30
(2)
16 20 30
40
(2)
XCMN2145L1
XCMN2106L1
53103
182
(1)
(1)
93143
1.
2.
2 mounting holes 4.2 mm (0.17 in.), counterbored 8 mm (0.31 in.) by 4 mm (0.16 in.) deep. Overall diameter 7.5 mm (0.30 in.).
16 16 20 30
(2)
20 30
40
(2)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact
Universal, XCKP and XCKT Plastic / XCKD Metal
b XCKP, XCKD
with 1 cable entry
Conforming to CENELEC EN 50047 v With head for linear movement (plunger). Mounting by the head or by the body. XCKD XCKP
520354 520353 520355 520356 520360
Pages 442 and 446 Pages 448 and 452 v With head for rotary movement (lever) or multi-directional. Mounting by the body. XCKD XCKP
520357
520358
b XCKT
with 2 cable entries
Tripping/resetting points and mounting centers conform to CENELEC EN 50047
v With head for linear movement (plunger). Mounting by the head or by the body. XCKT
520361 520362 520363
Page 454 v With head for rotary movement (lever) or multi-directional. Mounting by the body. XCKT
520364
Page 454
Environmental characteristics
Conforming to standards Product certifications Protective treatment Ambient air temperature Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Repeat accuracy Cable entry or integral connector Materials Products Machine assemblies Standard version Operation Storage Conforming to IEC 60068-2-6 Conforming to IEC 60068-2-27
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1, UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 IEC 60204-1, EN 60204-1 UL, CSA, CCC TC - 25+70 C (-13+158 F) - 40+70 C (-40+158 F) 25 gn (10500 Hz) except switch with head ZCE24: 20 gn 50 gn (11 ms) except heads ZCE08: 15 gn (11 ms) and ZCE24: 30 gn (18 ms) Class II conforming to IEC 61140 and NF C 20-030 for XCKP and XCKT Class I conforming to IEC 61140 and NF C 20-030 for XCKD IP 66 and IP 67 conforming to IEC 60529; IK 04 conforming to EN 50102 for XCKP and XCKT, IK 06 conforming to EN 50102 for XCKD 0.1 mm on the tripping points, with 1 million operating cycles for head with end plunger Either: tapped entry for PG 11 or PG 13 conduit thread, tapped ISO M16 x 1.5 or ISO M20 x 1.5, tapped 1/2" NPT, tapped PF 1/2 (G1/2) or integral M12 connector XCKD: Zamak bodies and heads, XCKP and XCKT: plastic bodies, Zamak heads
Depending on model
520365
520359
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact
Universal, XCKP and XCKT Plastic / XCKD Metal
Contact block characteristics
Rated operational characteristics XE2P XE3P XE2P Rated insulation voltage XE3P XE2P XE3P Positive operation (depending on model) Resistance across terminals XE2P Short-circuit protection XE3P XE2SP151 and XE2SP2141 Cabling XE2NP211 and XE2NP311 (screw clamp terminals) XE3NP and XE3SP Minimum actuation speed (for head with end plunger) Rated impulse withstand voltage
a AC-15; A300 (Ue = 240 V, Ie = 3 A); Ithe = 10 A c DC-13; Q300 (Ue = 250 V, Ie = 0.27 A), conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix A, EN 60947-5-1 a AC-15; B300 (Ue = 240 V, Ie = 1.5 A); Ithe = 6 A c DC-13; R300 (Ue = 250 V, Ie = 0.1 A), conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix A, EN 60947-5-1 Ui = 500 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-1 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 Ui = 400 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-1 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 U imp = 6 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 U imp = 4 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 N/C contacts with positive opening operation conforming to IEC 60 947-5-1 Appendix K, EN 60947-5-1 y 25 m conforming to IEC 60255-7 category 3 10 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl) 6 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl) Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.34 mm2, max: 2 x 1.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.5 mm2, max: 2 x 2.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.34 mm2, max: 1 x 1 mm2 or 2 x 0.75 mm2 XE2SP151, XE2SP2141 and XE3SP: 0.01 m/minute (0.03 ft/minute) XE2NP211, XE2NP311 and XE3NP: 6 m/minute (19.68 ft/minute) Conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix C Utilization categories AC-15 and DC-13 Maximum operating rate: 3600 operating cycles/hour Load factor: 0.5
Electrical durability
XE2SP151, XE2SP2141
Millions of operating cycles
XE2NP211, XE2NP311
Millions of operating cycles
Ithe
5 4 3 2 1 0,5
1 0,5
110 V 230/400 V
24 V 48 V
Voltage V 24 48 120 Voltage V 24 48 120 o W 10 7 4 o W 13 9 7 For XE2SP151 on a or c, N/C and N/O contacts simultaneously loaded to the values shown with reverse polarity.
XE3NP
Millions of operating cycles
XE3SP
Ithe
Millions of operating cycles
5 4 3 2
Ithe
230 V
1 0,5
12/24/48 V 110 V
24 V 48 V
3 4 5 10 Current in A
d.c. supply c
Limit Switches
0,1 0,5
10 3 4 5 Current in A
3 4 5 10 Current in A
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal
Universal, XCKDComplete Units with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Form B (1) Form C (1) Form E (1)
Type of operator
XCKD2102N12
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKD2121N12
6,5(A) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKD2127N12
6,5(B) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKD2128N12
9,8(A) 22,5(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
13
21
14
22
5mm 0,9
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
0 4,9
mm
14
22
XCKD2510N12
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKD2511N12
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKD2502N12
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKD2521N12
6,5(A) 11,3(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKD2527N12
6,5(B) 11,3(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKD2528N12
9,8(A) 17,2(P)
21-22 13-14
13
21
5mm
5mm
0 5,2
mm
10,5 mm
10,5 mm
16,1 mm
11
21
12
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
0 4,9
mm
11 12
22
21
5mm
5mm
5mm
5mm
5mm
5mm
31
21
13
31
21
13
32
22
14
Limit Switches
32
22
14
0 0,9
5mm
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
0 4,9
mm
3-pole N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141)
3 5mm
3 5mm
5,2 mm
10,5 mm
10,5 mm
16,1 mm
0.180 (0.397)
0.185 (0.408)
0.195 (0.430)
0.190 (0.419)
0.195 (0.430)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation
On end By 30 cam
Type of actuation
Maximum actuation speed For tripping Minimum force or torque For positive opening Cable entry (3)
1. 2. 3.
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
1 entry tapped M16 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry, clamping capacity 4 to 8 mm (0.16 to 0.31 in.)
Form conforming to EN 50047. See page 408. Switches with gold contacts or ring type connections: please consult your local sales office. For an entry tapped for a PG 11 conduit thread, replace N12 in the catalog number with G11. Examples: XCKD2110N12 becomes XCKD2110G11, ZCDEN12 becomes ZCDEG11.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal
Universal, XCKDComplete Units with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the head) Rotary (mounting by the body) Form A (1) Multi-directional
Type of operator
M18 with metal end M18 with steel plunger roller plunger
Variable length thermoplastic roller lever, Cats whisker (3) 50 mm (1.97 in.) XCKD2149N12 XCKD2106N12
14
22
13
21
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
70 0
70 0
2-pole N/C + N/O XCKD25H0N12 break before make, slow 1,8 3,2(P) 21-22 break 13-14 0 3 5mm (XE2NP2151)
ZCD29 + ZCDEN12 + ZCEH0
1,8 4,6(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
13
21
XCKD25H2N12
XCKD2518N12
XCKD2545N12
XCKD2539N12
XCKD2549N12
XCKD2506N12
14
22
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
21-22 13-14
46 0
21-22 13-14
46
21-22 13-14
46
21-22 13-14
46 0
0 5,2
mm
21-22 13-14
0
ZCD29 + ZCDEN12 + ZCE06
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
11
21
12
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
11 12
22
21
5mm
5mm
0
ZCD39 + ZCDEN12 + ZCE06
20
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 12
90
0 12
90
0 12
90
0 12
90
0 15
3-pole N/C + ZCD37+ ZCDEN12 + N/C + N/O break before ZCEH0 make, slow 1,8 3,2(P) 21-22 break 31-32 (XE3NP2141) 13-140 3 5mm
31
21
32
22
14
13
25 46(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
25 46(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
25 46(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
5,2 mm
0.220 (0.485) 0.220 (0.485) contact closed contact open On end By 30 cam
0 42 90 0.235 (0.518)
45
0.175 (0.386)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum For tripping force or For positive opening torque Cable entry (4)
1. 2. 3. 4. 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s), any direction 0.13 Nm (1.15 lb-in) By any moving part
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 10 N (2.25 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in)
1 entry tapped M16 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry, clamping capacity 4 to 8 mm (0.16 to 0.31 in.) Form conforming to EN 50047. See page 408. Switches with gold contacts or ring type connections: please consult your local sales office. Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mountings. For an entry tapped for a PG 11 conduit thread, replace N12 in the catalog number with G11. Examples: XCKD21H0N12 becomes XCKD21H0G11, ZCDEN12 becomes ZCDEG11.
Limit Switches
31
21 22
32
14
13
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal
Universal, XCKDComplete Units with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
ZCD2 + ZCDEN12 / ZCD3 + ZCDEN12
10
ZCE10
ZCE11
12,5
(2)
51 19
12,5 30
ZCE27
(3) (1)
ZCE02
ZCE21
20
12,5
5,5
12,5 16 5,5 2,5 29 = 36,2 22 = 12,5 2,5 7 12,5 M18x1(4) M18x1(4) 48 26 38 3,5
13
1. 2. 3. 4.
Tapped entry for ISO M16 x 1.5 or PG 11 conduit thread. 2 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22 mm (0.87 in.) centers, 2 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20 mm (0.79 in.) centers. 2 x 3 holes for support studs, depth 4 mm (0.16 in.). Mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.).
30,5
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal
Universal, XCKDComplete Units with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
ZCE01 + ZCY18 ZCE01 + ZCY45 ZCE01 + ZCY39
12,5
ZCE01 + ZCY49
52,5
ZCE06
40 10
142
77,5
12,5 12,5 16
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal
Universal, XCKDIntegral M12 Connector
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Form B (1) Form C (1) Form E (1)
Type of operator
Catalog Numbers
XCKD2110M12 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151)
13 21
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKD2111M12
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKD2102M12
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKD2121M12
6,5(A) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKD2127M12
6,5(B) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKD2128M12
9,8(A) 22,5(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
14
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
0 4,9
mm
ZCD29M12 + ZCE10
1,8 4,6(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCD29M12 + ZCE11
1,8 4,6(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCD29M12 + ZCE02
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCD29M12 + ZCE21
6,5(A) 15,7(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCD29M12 + ZCE27
6,5(B) 15,7(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCD29M12 + ZCE28
9,8(A) 22,5(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
12
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
0 4,9
mm
0.190 (0.419)
0.195 (0.430)
0.205 (0.452)
0.200 (0.441)
0.205 (0.452)
Characteristics
Switch actuation
On end By 30 cam
Type of actuation
10
20
65
51
30
(2)
M12 30 20/22 31
ZCE27 ZCE28 ZCEH0
5,5
14 6
12,5 16 2,5 29
36,2 22 = =
1. 2. 3.
2 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22 mm (0.87 in.) centers, 2 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20 mm (0.79 in.) centers. 2 x 3 holes for support studs, depth 4 mm (0.16 in.). Mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.).
22 41
12 13
39
19
30,5
20,2
77
Limit Switches
Maximum actuation speed For tripping Minimum force or torque For positive opening Connection
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
Connections
Integral M12 connector
4 5 1 2 3
XE2SP2151
1-2: N/C 3-4: N/O 5: t
XE2SP2141
1-2: N/C 3-4: N/C 5: t
Dimensions
ZCD2M12 ZCE10 ZCE11 ZCE02 ZCE21
12,5
12,5 3,5
16 12,5 14
(1)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal
Universal, XCKDIntegral M12 Connector
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the head) Rotary (mounting by the body) Form A (1) Multi-directional
Type of operator
M18 with metal end M18 with steel plunger roller plunger
Catalog Numbers
2-pole N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151)
13 21
XCKD2145M12
XCKD2139M12
XCKD2149M12
XCKD2106M12
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
70
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
0 0,9
5mm
70
0
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
70
0
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
70
0
14
22
0 1,5
mm
ZCD29M12 + ZCEH0
1,8 4,6(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCD29M12 + ZCEH2
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCD29M12 + ZCE06
70
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
70
0
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
70
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
70
0
12
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0.235 (0.518)
0.235 (0.518)
0.220 (0.485)
0.220 (0.485)
0.220 (0.485)
0.220 (0.485)
0.185 (0.408)
contact closed
contact open Form conforming to EN 50047. See page 408. Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mounting.
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum For tripping force or For positive opening torque Connection
1 m/s (3.28 ft/s), any direction 0.13 Nm (1.15 lb-in) On end By 30 cam By any moving part
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 10 N (2.25 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in)
Dimensions
ZCE01 + ZCY18 ZCE01 + ZCY45 ZCE01 + ZCY39 ZCE01 + ZCY49 ZCE06
40 5,5 24 19
42 10
40 10 50
1,2
54100,5 73,5120
33 52,5
58 77,5
12,5
ZCEH2
12,5 12,5
16
12,5
16
38
3.
142
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Plastic
Universal, XCKPComplete Units with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Form B (1) Form C (1) Form E (1)
Type of operator
Metal end plunger Metal end plunger with elastomer boot Steel roller plunger
XCKP2111N12
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKP2102N12
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKP2121N12
6,5(A) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKP2127N12
6,5(B) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKP2128N12
9,8(A) 22,5(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
13
21
14
22
5mm 0,9
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
0 4,9
mm
14
22
XCKP2510N12
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKP2511N12
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKP2502N12
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKP2521N12
6,5(A) 11,3(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKP2527N12
6,5(B) 11,3(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKP2528N12
9,8(A) 17,2(P)
21-22 13-14
13
21
5mm
5mm
0 5,2
mm
10,5 mm
10,5 mm
16,1 mm
11
21
12
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
0 4,9
mm
11 12
22
21
5mm
5mm
mm
mm
mm
mm
31
21
13
32
22
14
Limit Switches
31
21
13
32
22
14
0 09
5mm
0 09
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
0 4,9
mm
3-pole N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141)
3 5mm
3 5mm
5,2 mm
10,5 mm
10,5 mm
16,1 mm
0.090 (0.198)
0.095 (0.209)
0.105 (0.231)
0.100 (0.220)
0.105 (0.231)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation
On end By 30 cam
Type of actuation
Maximum actuation speed Minimum force or For tripping torque For positive opening Cable entry (3)
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
1 entry tapped M16 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry, clamping capacity 4 to 8 mm (0.16 to 0.31 in.)
1. Form conforming to EN 50047. See page 408. 2. Switches with gold contacts or ring type connections: please consult your local sales office. 3. For an entry tapped for a PG 11 conduit thread, replace N12 in the catalog number with G11. Examples: XCKP2110N12 becomes XCKP2110G11, ZCPEN12 becomes ZCPEG11. Note: For more information, consult pages 63, 456457.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Plastic
Universal, XCKPComplete Units with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the head) Rotary (mounting by the body) Form A (1) Multi-directional
Type of operator
M18 with metal end M18 with steel plunger roller plunger
Variable length thermoplastic roller Cats whisker (4) lever, 50 mm (1.97 in.) XCKP2149N12
70
0
XCKP2118N12
70
0
XCKP2106N12
14
22
13
21
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0
XCKP2506N12
XCKP25H2N12 2-pole N/C + N/O XCKP25H0N12 break before make, slow 3,1(A) 5,6(P) 1,8 3,2(P) 21-22 21-22 break 13-14 13-14 mm 0 5,2 0 3 5mm (XE2NP2151) ZCP29 + ZCPEN12 + ZCEH0
1,8 4,6(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
13
21
XCKP2518N12
XCKP2545N12
XCKP2539N12
XCKP2549N12
14
22
46
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
46
21-22 13-14
46
0 ZCP29 + ZCPEN12 + ZCE01 + ZCY39
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
46
21-22 13-14
21-22 13-14
11
21
0
ZCP29 + ZCPEN12 + ZCE01 + ZCY49
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
0
ZCP29 + ZCPEN12 + ZCE06
70
0
70
0
70
0
70
0
12
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
ZCP27 +
2-pole N/C + N/C ZCPEN12 + ZCEH0 simultaneous, slow break 1,8 3,2(P) (XE2NP2141) 11-12
21-22
11
12
22
21
11-12 21-22
5mm
mm
31
21
13
32
22
14
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
25 70(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
25 70(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
25 70(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
25 70(P)
0 09
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 12
90
0 12
90
0 12
90
0 12
90
0 15
3-pole N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141) Weight, kg (lb)
31 21 13 32 22 14
3 5mm
5,2 mm
42 90
42 90
42 90
42 90
45
Contact operation
0.130 (0.287) 0.130 (0.287) contact closed contact open On end By 30 cam
0.135 (0.298) 0.145 (0.320) (A) = cam displacement (P) = positive opening point
0.145 (0.320)
0.155 (0.342)
0.085 (0.187)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum For tripping force or For positive torque opening Cable entry (3)
1 m/s (3.28 ft/s), any direction 0.13 Nm (1.15 lb-in) By any moving part
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 10 N (2.25 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in)
1 entry tapped M16 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry, clamping capacity 4 to 8 mm (0.16 to 0.31 in.) 1. Form conforming to EN 50047. See page 408. 2. Switches with gold contacts or ring type connections: please consult your local sales office. 3. For an entry tapped for a PG 11 conduit thread, replace N12 in the catalog number with G11. Examples: XCKP21H0N12 becomes XCKP21H0G11, ZCPEN12 becomes ZCPEG11. 4. Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mountings. Note: For more information, consult pages 63, 456457.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Plastic
Universal, XCKPComplete Units with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
ZCP2 + ZCPEN12 / ZCP3 + ZCPEN12
10
ZCE10
ZCE28
12,5 2
65
51
(2)
19
2,5 29
ZCE11
30
20/22
(3)
12,5
(1)
31 30 13 7
15 12,5 15
ZCE21 ZCE27
ZCE02
16 12,5 14 20,2
5,5
39
12
ZCE06 ZCEH0 ZCE01 + ZCY18
12,5 7 M18x1(4)
40 5,5 24 33 12,5
ZCE01 + ZCY45
142
26
22 41
48
ZCEH2
12,5 3,5
12,5
ZCE01 + ZCY49
40 10
ZCE01 + ZCY39
38
M18x1 (4)
12,5
1. 2.
16
Tapped entry for ISO M16 x 1.5 or PG 11 conduit thread. 2 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22 mm (0.87 in.) centers, 2 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20 mm (0.79 in.) centers.
58
52,5
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal and Plastic
Universal, XCKD, XCKP, and XCKT
Catalog Number Interpretation
For Interpretation of the Catalog Number Only
XCK
21
10
N12
XCKAssembled unit ZCPPlastic body components ZCDMetal body components ZCTWide body components ZCPEPlastic conduit components ZCDEMetal conduit components
Contact Description 211 N.O. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Silver 251 N.O. + 1 N.C. Slow Make/Break Silver 261 N.O. + 1 N.C. Overlapping Cont. Gold 271 N.C. + 1 N.C. Slow Make/Break Silver 281 N.O. + 1 N.O. Slow Make/Break Silver 291 N.C. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Silver 312 N.O. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Silver 352 N.O. + 1 N.C. Slow Make/Break Silver c 371 N.O. + 2 N.C. Slow Make/Break Silver c 391 N.O. + 2 N.C. Snap Action Silver 412 N.O. + 2 N.C. Snap Action Silver c 611 N.O. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Gold 651 N.O. + 1 N.C. Slow Make/Break Gold c Head Assembly
Conduit Threads F12PF 1/2 G11PG 11 G13PG 13.5 c4- or 5-Pin Connector N121/2 NPT P16ISO M16 P20M20
01Rotary Head without Lever Arm 02Steel Top Roller Plunger 05Rotary Head Programmable 06Cat Whisker 07Spring Rod with Plastic End c 08Spring Rod c 09Maint. Rotary without Arm c 10Top Push Rod Plunger 11Booted Top Push Rod Pl. 13Top Ball Bearing Plunger c 14Adjustable Top Plunger c 21One-way Horiz. Plastic Roller 24Retractable Steel Roller, 9 mm (0.35 in.)
661 N.O. + 1 N.C. Overlapping Cont. Gold c 671 N.C. + 1 N.C. Slow Make/Break Gold c 681 N.O. + 1 N.O. Slow Make/Break Gold 691 N.C. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Gold 712 N.O. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Gold c 752 N.O. + 1 N.C. Slow Make/Break Gold c 771 N.O. + 2 N.C. Slow Make/Break Gold c 791 N.O. + 2 N.C. Snap Action Gold c 812 N.O. + 2 N.C. Snap Action Gold c C11 N.O. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Quick Connect c C91 N.C. + 1 N.C. Snap Action Quick Connect c
28One-way Horiz. or Vert. Roller 29Booted Top Roller Plunger c 62Adjust. Side Push Rod Pl. c 63Side Push Rod Plunger c 64Horiz. Side Roller Plunger c 65Vertical Side Roller Plunger c 66Side Ball Bearing Plunger c 67Horizontal Cat Whisker c F0M12 Threaded Plunger Head c
Important Note: Use for interpretation only. Some possibilities are not shown and some combinations of components are not available. Not all switches are modular. See additional information in this catalog. For interpretation of heads and levers, see page 456457.
F2M12 Threaded Roller Plunger Head c G1M16 Threaded Booted Plunger Head c H0M18 Threaded Plunger Head c H2M18 Threaded Roller Plunger Head c
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Plastic
Universal, XCKPIntegral M12 Connector
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Form B (1)
Form C (1)
Form E (1)
Type of operator
Catalog Numbers
2-pole N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151)
13 21
XCKP2110M12
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKP2111M12
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKP2102M12 XCKP2121M12
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKP2127M12
6,5(B) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKP2128M12
9,8(A) 22,5(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
6,5(A) 15,7(P) 0 3 mm 0
14
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
mm 3
0 4,9
mm
ZCP29M12 + ZCE10
1,8 4,6(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCP29M12 + ZCE11
1,8 4,6(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCP29M12 + ZCE02
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCP29M12 + ZCE21
6,5(A) 15,7(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCP29M12 + ZCE27
6,5(B) 15,7(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCP29M12 + ZCE28
9,8(A) 22,5(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
12
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
0 4,9
mm
0.100 (0.220)
0.100 (0.220)
0.100 (0.220)
0.110 (0.243)
0.110 (0.243)
0.110 (0.243)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation
On end By 30 cam
Type of actuation
Maximum actuation speed For tripping Minimum force or torque For positive opening Connection
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
10
20
30
65 77
30,5
51
20,2
19
(2)
ZCE27 ZCE28 ZCEH0
M12 30
20/22 31
5,5
14
12,5 16 2,5 29 6
36,2 22 = =
12,5
22 41
12 13
1. 2. 3.
2 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22 mm (0.87 in.) centers, 2 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20 mm (0.79 in.) centers. 2 x 3 mm (0.12 in.) holes for support studs, depth 4 mm (0.16 in.). Mounting nut thickness 3.5 mm (0.14 in.).
48
39
Limit Switches
Connections
Integral M12 connector
4 3
XE2SP2151
1-2: N/C 3-4: N/O
XE2SP2141
1-2: N/C 3-4: N/C
Dimensions
ZCP2M12 ZCE10 ZCE11 ZCE02 ZCE21
(1)
12,5
12,5 3,5
16 12,5 14
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Plastic
Universal, XCKPIntegral M12 Connector
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the head) Rotary (mounting by the body) Form A (1) Multi-directional
Type of operator
M18 with metal end M18 with steel plunger roller plunger
Variable length Thermoplastic thermoplastic roller roller lever, lever 50 mm (1.97 in.)
Catalog Numbers
2-pole N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151)
13 21
XCKP21H0M12
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKP21H2M12
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKP2118M126 XCKP2145M12
XCKP2139M12
XCKP2149M12
XCKP2106M126
14
22
0 0,9
70
0
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
70
0
70
0
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
70
0
5mm
0 1,5
mm
ZCP29M12 + ZCEH0
1,8 4,6(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCP29M12 + ZCEH2
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCP29M12 + ZCE06
70
0 0
70
70
0 0
70
12
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0.140 (0.309)
0.140 (0.309)
0.150 (0.331)
0.155 (0.342)
0.160 (0.353)
0.090 (0.198)
contact closed
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Form conforming to EN 50047. See page 408. Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mountings.
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation
1 m/s (3.28 ft/s), any direction 0.13 Nm (1.15 lb-in) On end By 30 cam By any moving part
Maximum actuation speed 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) Minimum force or torque Connection For tripping For positive opening
15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 10 N (2.25 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in)
Dimensions
ZCE01 + ZCY18 ZCE01 + ZCY45 ZCE01 + ZCY39 ZCE01 + ZCY49 ZCE06
1,2
40 5,5 24 19
42 10
40 10 50
54100,5
58 77,5
3383,5 52,5103
73,5120
12,5
12,5 12,5
ZCEH2
16
M18x1 (3)
142
3.
09/2007
38
453
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Plastic
Universal, XCKTComplete Units with Two Cable Entries and 1/2" NPT Adapter
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Form B (1) Form C (1) Form E (1) Multi-directional
Type of operator
XCKT2102N12
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKT2121N12
6,5(A) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKT2106N12
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
14
22
13
21
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
0 0,9
5mm
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
2-pole N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP3151) 2-pole N/C + N/O make before break, slow break (XE2NP3161) 2-pole N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP3141) 2-pole N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP3131)
ZCT25N12 + ZCE10
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCT25N12 + ZCE11
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCT25N12 + ZCE02
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCT25N12 + ZCE21
6,5(A) 11,3(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCT25N12 + ZCE06
21-22 13-14
13 14
22
21
5mm
5mm
0 5,2
mm
10,5 mm
ZCT26N12 + ZCE10
3 4,4(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCT26N12 + ZCE11
3 4,4(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCT26N12 + ZCE02
5,2 7,6(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCT26N12 + ZCE21
10,9(A) 16(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCT26N12 + ZCE06
21-22 13-14
21 22
14
13
0 1,8
5mm
0 1,8
5mm
0 3,1
mm
0 6,6
mm
ZCT27N12 + ZCE10
1,8 3,2(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCT27N12 + ZCE11
1,8 3,2(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCT27N12 + ZCE02
3,1 5,6(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCT27N12 + ZCE21
6,6(A) 11,6(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCT27N12 + ZCE06
11-12 21-22
11 12
22
21
5mm
5mm
ZCT28N12 + ZCE10
1,8
13-14 23-24
ZCT28N12 + ZCE11
1,8
13-14 23-24
0 mm ZCT28N12 + ZCE02
3,1(A)
13-14 23-24
mm
ZCT28N12 + ZCE21
6,6(A)
13-14 23-24
ZCT28N12 + ZCE06
13-14 23-24
13 14
24
23
5mm
5mm
mm
mm
Weight, kg (lb)
0.105 (0.231)
0.115 (0.254)
0.095 (0.209)
Contact operation
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
51
10 2
40 = 20/22 = 40/42 58
12,5 15 15 3,5
11,6 30,5
12,5
1,2
1. 2. 3.
2 tapped entries for ISO M16 x 1.5 or PG 11 conduit thread. 4 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22/42 mm (0.87/1.65 in.) centers, 4 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20/40 mm (0.79/1.57 in.) centers. 2 x 3 holes for support studs, depth 4 mm (0.16 in.).
12,5
142
39
30
37,6
(1) (3)
ZCE02 ZCE06
20
30
Limit Switches
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation
1 m/s (3.28 ft/s), any direction 0.3 Nm (2.66 lb-in) On end By 30 cam By any moving part
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb) 3. 4.
2 entries tapped M16 x 1.5 for ISO cable entry. Clamping capacity 4 to 8 mm (0.16 to 0.31 in.) (1 entry fitted with blanking plug). For cable entries tapped for a PG 11 conduit thread, replace N12 in the catalog number with G11. Example: XCKT2110N12 becomes XCKT2110G11. Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mountings.
Form conforming to EN 50047. See page 408. Switches with gold contacts or ring connections: please consult your local sales office.
Dimensions
ZCT2N12 ZCE10 ZCE11 ZCE21
12,5
(2)
12,5
16
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Plastic
Universal, XCKTComplete Units with Two Cable Entries and 1/2" NPT Adapter
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the head) Rotary (mounting by the body) Form A (1)
Type of operator
XCKT2118N12
70
0
XCKT2145N12
70
0
XCKT2139N12
70
0
14
22
13
21
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
2-pole N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP3151) 2-pole N/O + N/C make before break, slow break (XE2NP3161) 2-pole N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP3141) 2-pole N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP3131)
ZCT25N12 + ZCEH0
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCT25N12 + ZCEH2
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
13 14
22
21
5mm
0 5,2
mm
ZCT26N12 + ZCEH0
3 4,4(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCT26N12 + ZCEH2
5,2 7,6(P)
21-22 13-14
21 22
14
13
0 1,8
5mm
0 3,1
mm
ZCT27N12 + ZCEH0
1,8 3,2(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCT27N12 + ZCEH2
3,1 5,6(P)
11-12 21-22
11 12
22
21
5mm
ZCT28N12 + ZCEH0
1,8
13-14 23-24
0 mm ZCT28N12 + ZCEH2
3,1(A)
13-14 23-24
13 14
24
23
5mm
mm
90
90
90
0.145 (0.320)
0.155 (0.342)
0.160 (0.353)
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed For tripping Minimum force or torque For positive opening Cable entry (3)
1. 2. 3. 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 10 N (2.25 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb) 1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in) On end By 30 cam
2 entries tapped M16 x 1.5 for ISO cable entry. Clamping capacity 4 to 8 mm (0.16 to 0.31 in.) (1 entry fitted with blanking plug).
Form conforming to EN 50047. See page 408. Switches with gold contacts or ring type connections: please consult your local sales office. For cable entries tapped for a PG 11 conduit thread, replace N12 in the catalog number with G11. Example: XCKT21H0N12 becomes XCKT21H0G11.
Dimensions
ZCEH0 ZCE01 + ZCY18 ZCE01 + ZCY39 ZCE01 + ZCY45
3,5
M18x1(4) 38
12,5 16
4.
52,5103
Limit Switches
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal and Plastic
Universal, XCKD, XCKP, and XCKTModular
Thermoplastic roller lever plunger, horizontal actuation Thermoplastic roller lever plunger, vertical actuation Thermoplastic roller lever plunger, horizontal or vertical actuation Retractable steel roller lever plunger
ZCE 21
ZCE 27
ZCE 28
ZCE 24
ZCE 62
ZCE 63
ZCE 64
ZCE 65
ZCE 66
ZCE H0
ZCE H2
Spring rod
Cats whisker
ZCE 02
ZCE 29
ZCE 07
ZCE 08
ZCE 06
Limit Switches
1. 2.
ZCE 10
ZCE 11
ZCE 13
ZCE 14
Plastic bodies with integral M12 connector, with: N/C + N/O snap action contact
Plastic bodies with contacts (1) for use in conjunction with cable entry (see below)
ISO M16 x 1.5 Pg 11 1/2 NPT PG 11 conduit entries convert to 1/2" NPT using adapter DE9RA1012 (included)
Cable entry:
ZCP EG11 Pg 11
For further details, see page 458. Cannot be used on bodies: ZCD21, ZCP21, ZCT21, ZCD29, ZCP29, ZCD31, ZCP31, ZCD39.ZCP39, ZCD2M12, ZCP2M12.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal and Plastic
Universal, XCKD, XCKP, and XCKTModular
Dimensions: mm (in.)
ZCY 53
ZCY 54
ZCY 55
ZCY 59
ZCY 22
ZCY 81
ZCY 91
ZCY 49
ZCY 69
ZCY 44
Thermoplastic roller lever, track: 24/40 (0.94/1.57)
ZCY 45
Steel roller lever, track: 24/40 (0.94/1.57)
ZCY 46
Steel ball bearing mounted roller lever, track: 24/40 (0.94/1.57)
ZCY 48
Thermoplastic roller lever, track: 29/36 (1.14/1.42)
ZCY 39
Steel roller lever, track: 29/36 (1.14/1.42)
ZCE 01
ZCY 18
Stay put, for actuation from left AND right (2) ZCE 09 Steel ball bearing mounted roller lever, track: 29/36 (1.14/1.42)
ZCY 19
Thermoplastic roller lever, track: 21/44 (0.83/1.73)
ZCY 12
Steel roller lever, track: 21/44 (0.83/1.73)
ZCY 15
Steel ball bearing mounted roller lever, track: 21/44 (0.83/1.73)
ZCY 16
ZCY 17
ZCY 25
Forked arm with rollers, 2 track, track: 25/39 (0.98/1.54)
ZCY 26
ZCY 23
Forked arm with rollers, 1 track, track: 32 (1.26)
ZCY 61
Metal bodies with integral M12 connector, with: N/C + N/O snap action contact ZCD 21M12 N/C + N/C snap action contact ZCD 29M12
ZCY 71
Metal bodies with contacts (1) for use in conjunction with cable entry (see below)
ZCD
Cable entry:
ZCD EG11 Pg 11
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal and Plastic
Universal, XCKD, XCKP, and XCKTModular
520710
Function diagram
Body material
Catalog Number
Weight kg (lb)
14
22
N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151) N/C + N/C snap action (XE2SP2141) N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151) N/O + N/C make before break, slow break (XE2NP2161) N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2141) N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2131) 3-pole
21
Metal Plastic Metal Plastic Metal Plastic Metal Plastic Metal Plastic Metal Plastic
ZCD21 ZCP21 ZCD29 ZCP29 ZCD25 ZCP25 ZCD26 ZCP26 ZCD27 ZCP27 ZCD28 ZCP28
0.140 (0.309) 0.070 (0.154) 0.140 (0.309) 0.070 (0.154) 0.140 (0.309) 0.070 (0.154) 0.140 (0.309) 0.070 (0.154) 0.140 (0.309) 0.070 (0.154) 0.140 (0.309) 0.070 (0.154)
11 12 13 14 13 11 13
14 12 14
24
23
22
21
22
21
22
21
22
ZCD
21
33
34
22
14
N/C + N/O + N/O snap action (XE3SP2151) N/C + N/C + N/O snap action (XE3SP2141) N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141) ZCP N/C + N/O + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2151)
1. 2.
520711
21
13
0.140 (0.309) 0.070 (0.154) 0.140 (0.309) 0.070 (0.154) 0.140 (0.309) 0.070 (0.154) 0.140 (0.309) 0.070 (0.154)
32
33 34
22
21
Bodies with gold contacts or eyelet type connections: please consult your local sales office. : bodies with contacts assuring positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
22
14
13
14
Limit Switches
31
21 22 21
32
31
13
14
13
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal and Plastic
Universal, XCKD, XCKP, and XCKTModular
Bodies with contacts, type XCKT plastic, 2 cable entries
561390
Function diagram
Cable entries
Catalog Number
Weight kg (lb)
13
14
22
N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP3151) N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP3151) ZCT N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP3141) N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP3131) N/O + N/C make before break, slow break (XE2NP3161)
21
0.085 (0.187) 0.085 (0.187) 0.085 (0.187) 0.085 (0.187) 0.085 (0.187) 0.085 (0.187) 0.085 (0.187) 0.085 (0.187) 0.085 (0.187) 0.085 (0.187)
13
21
14
22
11
12
22
21
13
23
14 13
21
24
Bodies with contacts, type XCKT, plastic, 2 cable entries with 1/2" NPT adapter
561387
14
22
Function diagram
Catalog Number
Weight kg (lb)
13
14
ZCT25N12
ZCTN12
N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP3141) N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP3131) N/O + N/C make before break, slow break (XE2NP3161)
1.
11
14
21
22
0.130 (0.287)
ZCT27N12
13
12
23
22
0.130 (0.287)
ZCT28N12
14
13
21
24
0.130 (0.287)
ZCT26N12
: bodies with contact assuring positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
14
22
0.130 (0.287)
Limit Switches
13
21
22
21
ZCT21N12
0.130 (0.287)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal and Plastic
Universal, XCKD, XCKP, and XCKTModular
561427
Accessories
Description Rotary head, without lever, spring return, for actuation from left AND right or left OR right (1) Tap-off terminal (for XCKT) Suitable levers for use with head Unit catalog number Weight kg (oz)
ZCE05
ZCY12, ZCY15, ZCY16, ZCY17, ZCY18, ZCY19, ZCY22, ZCY23, ZCY25, ZCY26, ZCY39, ZCY53, ZCY54, ZCY55, ZCY81
ZCE05
0.045 (1.59)
561392
Sold in lots of 10
XALZ09
Spacer for angular positioning of heads with adjustable levers, for values other than -90, 0 and 90 Adapter for 1/2" NPT conduit Sold in lots of 10
Converts PG 11 conduit entries to 1/2" NPT
XCMZ07
DE9RA1012
DE9RA1012
Bodies with contacts, type XCKP plastic, with rotary head (without operating lever)
Type of contact 2-pole Function diagram Positive Cable operation (2) entry Catalog Number Weight kg (lb)
0.115 (0.254) 0.115 (0.254) 0.125 (0.276) 0.115 (0.254) 0.115 (0.254)
561388
13
14
22
21
13
14
22
21
1/2" NPT PG 11
Bodies with contacts, type XCKD metal, with rotary head (without operating lever)
XCK201 Type of contact 2-pole
13 21
1/2" NPT PG 11 M12 connector XCKD2101N12 XCKD2101G11 XCKD2101M12 XCKD2501N12 XCKD2501G11 0.185 (0.408) 0.185 (0.408) 0.195 (0.430) 0.185 (0.408) 0.185 (0.408)
Function diagram
Catalog Number
Weight kg (lb)
13
14
22
21
Limit Switches
460
14
22
1/2" NPT PG 11
09/2007
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal and Plastic
Universal, XCKD, XCKP, and XCKTModular
Contact blocks with screw clamp terminals for XCKD and XCKP
Type of contact 2-pole
13
561393
Function diagram
Weight kg (lb)
14
11
12
XE221
14
11
14
13
12
14
3-pole
33
561394
24
23
22
21
22
13
21
22
13
21
22
21
22
21
XE2SP2151
0.020 (0.044)
XE2SP2141
0.020 (0.044)
XE2NP2151
0.020 (0.044)
XE2NP2161
0.020 (0.044)
XE2NP2141
0.020 (0.044)
XE2NP2131
0.020 (0.044)
34
22
31
32
22
14
N/C + N/C + N/O snap action N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break N/C + N/O + N/O break before make, slow break
21
13
14
21
13
XE3SP2151
0.035 (0.077)
XE3SP2141
0.035 (0.077)
XE321
XE3NP2141
0.035 (0.077)
XE3NP2151
0.035 (0.077)
Function diagram
Weight kg (lb)
14
14
11
14
13
12
14
1.
: contact blocks assuring positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
24
23
22
21
22
13
21
22
13
21
22
21
XE2SP3151
0.015 (0.033)
XE2NP3151
0.015 (0.033)
XE2NP3161
0.015 (0.033)
XE2NP3141
0.015 (0.033)
XE2NP3131
0.015 (0.033)
Limit Switches
31
21 33 34 22
32
21
22
14
13
14
13
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact with Manual Reset
Application, XCDRComplete Switches, Metal, with One Cable Entry, 1/2" NPT
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Rotary (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers of complete switches with one 1/2" NPT cable entry
XCDR2110N12 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151)
13 21
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCDR2102N12
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCDR2121N12
6,5(A) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCDR2127N12
6,5(B) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCDR2118N12
70
0
XCDR2119N12
70
0
14
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
14
22
XCDR2510N12
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
XCDR2502N12
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
XCDR2521N12
XCDR2527N12
6,5(B) 11,3(P)
21-22 13-14
XCDR2518N12
XCDR2519N12
13
21
6,5(A) 11,3(P)
21-22 13-14
46
21-22 13-14
46
21-22 13-14
5mm
0 5,2
0.220 (0.485)
mm
10,5 mm
10,5 mm
0
0.255 (0.562)
0
0.255 (0.562)
Weight, kg (lb)
0.215 (0.474)
0.225 (0.496)
0.225 (0.496)
Contact operation
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed For tripping Minimum force or torque For positive opening Cable entry
On end By 30 cam
Limit Switches
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in)
1 entry tapped M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry, clamping capacity 7 to 13 mm (0.28 to 0.51 in.), or 1 entry tapped PG 13.5, clamping capacity 9 to 12 mm (0.35 to 0.47 in.), or 1 entry tapped for 1/2" NPT (USAS B2-1) conduit
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact with Manual Reset
Application, XCDRComplete Switches, Metal, with One Cable Entry, 1/2" NPT
Dimensions
XCDR210 XCDR202 XCDR221
65
51
(2)
2 65 51 2 19
(2)
65 19 51
54,5
46
(2)
19
14
(3)
14
39,5 39,5
1. 2. Tapped entry for ISO M20 x 1.5 or PG 13.5 conduit thread or 1/2" NPT conduit 2 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22 mm (0.87 in.) centers, 2 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20 mm (0.79 in.) centers 2 x 3 holes for support studs, depth 4 mm (0.16 in.)
(1)
39,5
14
(1)
(3)
(3) (1)
3.
Dimensions
XCDR227 XCDR218, XCDR219
40 5,5 24
19
5,5 22
56,5
33
12 2 2
65
51
51
(2)
19 14
(2)
19
68
14
(3)
(3) (1)
(1)
39,5 39,5
1. 2. 3.
Tapped entry for ISO M20 x 1.5 or PG 13.5 conduit thread or 1/2" NPT conduit. 2 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22 mm (0.87 in.) centers, 2 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20 mm (0.79 in.) centers. 2 x 3 holes for support studs, depth 4 mm (0.16 in.).
12,5
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact with Manual Reset
Application, XCPRComplete Switches, Plastic, with One Cable Entry, 1/2" NPT
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Rotary (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers of complete switches with one 1/2" NPT cable entry
XCPR2110N12 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151)
13 21
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCPR2102N12
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCPR2121N12
6,5(A) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCPR2127N12
6,5(B) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCPR2118N12
70
0
XCPR2119N12
70
0
14
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
XCPR2510N12 2-pole N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151)
13 21
XCPR2502N12
XCPR2521N12
XCPR2527N12
XCPR2518N12
XCPR2519N12
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
6,5(A) 11,3(P)
21-22 13-14
46
21-22 13-14
46
0
14
22
5mm
0 5,2
mm
10,5 mm
XCPR2902N12
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
XCPR2921N12
6,5(A) 15,7(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
XCPR2927N12
6,5(B) 15,7(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
XCPR2918N12
70
0
12
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
0 3
mm
Weight, kg (lb)
0.115 (0.254)
0.115 (0.254)
0.125 (0.276)
0.120 (0.265)
0.155 (0.342)
Limit Switches
Contact operation
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum force For tripping or torque For positive opening Cable entry Other versions
On end By 30 cam
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in)
1 entry tapped M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry, clamping capacity 7 to 13 mm (0.28 to 0.51 in.), or 1 entry tapped PG 13.5, clamping capacity 9 to 12 mm (0.35 to 0.47 in.), or 1 entry tapped for 1/2" NPT (USAS B2-1) conduit Complete switches with cable entries other than those listed above: consult your local sales office.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact with Manual Reset
Application, XCPRComplete Switches, Plastic, with One Cable Entry, 1/2" NPT
Dimensions
XCPR210 XCPR202 XCPR221
12,5
65
51
(2)
2 51 51
(2)
19 14
19
46
14
(3)
14
19
30 39,5
1. 2.
(1)
31 39,5
(3) (1)
(3)
(1)
39,5
3.
Tapped entry for ISO M20 x 1.5 or PG 13.5 conduit thread or 1/2" NPT conduit. 2 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22 mm (0.87 in.) centers, 2 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20 mm (0.79 in.) centers. 2 x 3 holes for support studs, depth 4 mm (0.16 in.).
Dimensions
XCPR227 XCPR218, XCPR219
5,5
40 5,5 24
19 33
20 56,5
12,5 2
51
14
(1)
39,5
30 39,5
1. 2. 3.
Tapped entry for ISO M20 x 1.5 or PG 13.5 conduit thread or 1/2" NPT conduit. 2 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22 mm (0.87 in.) centers, 2 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20 mm (0.79 in.) centers. 2 x 3 holes for support studs, depth 4 mm (0.16 in.).
14
(3)
(3)
(1)
Limit Switches
19
65
51
(2)
19
68
(2)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact with Manual Reset
Application, XCTRComplete Switches, Plastic, with Two Cable Entries, 1/2" NPT
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers of complete switches with two cable entries, 1/2" NPT (1)
2-pole N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP3151) XCTR2110N12
1,8 4,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCTR2102N12
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCTR2118N12
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCTR2121N12
6,5(A) 15,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
13
21
70
0
14
22
0 0,9
5mm
0 1,5
mm
0 3
mm
14
22
13
21
XCTR2510N12
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
XCTR2502N12
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
XCTR2518N12
XCTR2521N12
6,5(A) 11,3(P)
21-22 13-14
46
21-22 13-14
5mm
0 5,2
0.125 (0.276)
mm
0
0.165 (0.364)
10,5 mm
Weight, kg (lb)
1. One PG 11 to 1/2" NPT adapter and one plug included.
0.120 (0.265)
0.135 (0.298)
Catalog numbers of complete switches with two ISO M16 x 1.5 cable entries
For complete switches with two ISO M16 x 1.5 cable entries, replace N12 with P16. Example: XCTR2110N12 becomes XCTR2110P16. 0.120 (0.265) Weight, kg (lb) Contact operation
contact closed contact open 0.125 (0.276) (A) = cam displacement (P) = positive opening point 0.165 (0.364) 0.135 (0.298)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum force or torque For tripping For positive opening
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb) 1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in) 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s) 6 N (1.35 lb) 18 N (4.05 lb) On end By 30 cam
Limit Switches
2 entries tapped M16 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry, clamping capacity 4 to 8 mm (0.16 to 0.31 in.), or 2 entries tapped PG 11, clamping capacity 7 to 10 mm (0.28 to 0.39 in.), or 2 entries tapped for 1/2" NPT (USAS B2-1) conduit using PG 11 to 1/2" NPT adapter DE9RA1012 (1 entry fitted with adapter)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Compact, Metal with Manual Reset
Application, XCDRComplete Switches with Two Cable Entries, 1/2" NPT
Dimensions
XCTR218 XCTR221
37,6 2
51
40
37,6 2
51
54,5 40
39,5
= 20/22 = 40/42 58
= 20/22 = 40/42 58
12,5
1. 2. 3.
Tapped entry for ISO M16 x 1.5 or PG 11 conduit thread. 1/2" NPT adapter included. 4 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22/42 mm (0.87/1.65 in.) centers, 4 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20/40 mm (0.79/1.57 in.) centers. 2 x 3 holes for support studs, depth 4 mm (0.16 in.).
XCTR210
XCTR202
12,5
DE9RA1012
(4)
12,5 12,5 35,5 46 26 3,5
21
(5)
37,6 2
51
51
40
37,6 2
40
(2) (3)
30 39,5
= 40/42 58
30 39,5
= 20/22 = 40/42 58
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Tapped entry for ISO M16 x 1.5 or PG 11 conduit thread. 1/2" NPT adapter included. 4 elongated holes 4.3 x 6.3 mm (0.17 x 0.25 in.) on 22/42 mm (0.87/1.65 in.) centers, 4 holes 4.3 mm (0.17 in.) on 20/40 mm (0.79/1.57 in.) centers. 2 x 3 holes for support studs, depth 4 mm (0.16 in.). Tapped entry for 1/2" NPT conduit. PG 11 threaded sleeve.
12,5
Limit Switches
(1)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKM, XCKL, and XCKML
b XCKM
with 3 cable entries
561644 561643 808148 561645 561642 808147
Page 470
b XCKL
with 1 cable entry
808145
b XCKML
with 3 cable entries and two 2-pole contacts
808140
Page 472
561639
561640
Page 482
Environmental characteristics
Conforming to standards Product certifications Protective treatment Ambient air temperature Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Repeat accuracy Cable entry or integral connector Materials Depending on model Products Machine assemblies Version For operation For storage Conforming to IEC 60068-2-6 Conforming to IEC 60068-2-27
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1, UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 IEC 60204-1, EN 60204-1 UL, CSA, CCC (for XCKM) Standard TC. Special TH - 25+70 C (-13+158 F) - 40+70 C (-40+158 F) 25 gn (10500 Hz) 50 gn (11 ms) Class I conforming to IEC 61140 and NF C 20-030 IP 66 conforming to IEC 60529; IK 05 conforming to EN 50102 XCKML 0.1 mm; XCKM and XCKL 0.05 mm on the tripping points, with 1 million operating cycles for head with end plunger XCKM: 3 tapped entries, PG 11 conduit thread (1/2" NPT adapter available), or tapped M20 XCKL: 1 tapped entry incorporating 1/2" NPT adapter XCKML: 3 tapped entries, PG 13 conduit thread (1/2" NPT adapter included), or tapped M20 Bodies: Zamak zinc alloy Rotary heads: Zamak zinc alloy or plastic depending on model; other heads: plastic
561641
808141
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKM, XCKL, and XCKML
Contact block characteristics
Rated operational characteristics XE2P XE3P XE2P Rated insulation voltage XE3P XE2P XE3P Positive operation (depending on model) Resistance across terminals XE2P Short-circuit protection XE3P XE2SP211 Cabling XE2NP211 (screw and captive cable XESP2151L and XENP2151L clamp terminals) XE3NP and XE3SP Rated impulse withstand voltage Minimum actuation speed
a AC-15; A300 (Ue = 240 V, Ie = 3 A); Ithe = 10 A c DC-13; Q300 (Ue = 250 V, Ie = 0,27 A), conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix A, EN 60947-5-1 a AC-15; B300 (Ue = 240 V, Ie = 1,5 A); Ithe = 6 A c DC-13; R300 (Ue = 250 V, Ie = 0,1 A), conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix A, EN 60947-5-1 Ui = 500 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-1 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 Ui = 400 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-1 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 U imp = 6 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 U imp = 4 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 N/C contacts with positive opening operation conforming to IEC 947-5-1 Section 3, EN 60 947-5-1 y 25 m conforming to IEC 60255-7 category 3 10 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl) 6 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl) Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.34 mm2, max: 2 x 1.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.5 mm2, max: 2 x 2.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.34 mm2, max: 2 x 1,5 mm2 or 1 x 2.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.34 mm2, max: 1 x 1 mm2 or 2 x 0.75 mm2 XE2SP211, XESP2151L and XE3SP: 0.01 m/minute (0.03 ft/minute) XE2NP211, XENP2151L and XE3NP: 6 m/minute (19.68 ft/minute)
Electrical durability
Conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 appendix C Utilization categories AC-15 and DC-13 Maximum operating rate: 3600 operating cycles/hour Load factor: 0,5 XE2SP211, XE2SP2141, XESP2151L
Millions of operating cycles
XE2NP211, XENP2151L
Millions of operating cycless
Ithe
5 4 3 2 1 0,5
1 0,5
110 V 230/400 V
24 V 48 V
0,1 0,5
10 3 4 5 Current in A
3 4 5 10 Current 1n A
Voltage V 24 48 120 Voltage V 24 48 120 o W 10 7 4 o W 13 9 7 For XE2SP151 on a or c, the N/C and N/O contacts are simultaneously loaded to the values shown with reverse polarity.
XE3SP
Millions of operating cycles
XE3NP
Millions of operating cycles
Ithe
5 4 3 2
Ithe
230 V
1 0,5
12/24/48 V 110 V
24 V 48 V
3 4 5 10 Current in A
d.c. supply c
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKMComplete Switches w/ 3 ISO M20x1.5 Cable Entries, Including One 1/2" NPT Adapter
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Rotary (mounting by the body) Multi-directional (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
XCKM102H29
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKM121H29
4,6(A) 11,1(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKM115H29
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKM106H29
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
1,8 0 0,9
4,5(P) 5,5mm 0
14
22
mm 1,5
0 2,2
mm
13
21
XCKM510H29
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKM502H29
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKM521H29
4,6(A) 8(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKM515H29
21-22 13-14
XCKM506H29
21-22 13-14
14
22
5,5mm
5,2
mm
7,6 mm
12
22
ZCKM9H29 + ZCKD10
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKM9H29 + ZCKD02
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKM9H29 + ZCKD21
4,6(A) 11,1(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKM9H29 + ZCKD15
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKM9H29 + ZCKD06
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
11
21
1,8 0 0,9
4,5(P) 5,5mm 0
mm 1,5
0 2,2
mm
11
21
ZCKM7H29 + ZCKD10
3,2(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKM7H29 + ZCKD02
5,6(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKM7H29 + ZCKD21
8(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKM7H29 + ZCKD15
11-12 21-22
ZCKM7H29 + ZCKD06
11-12 21-22
12
22
1,8
5,5mm
3,1(A) 9mm
4,6(A) mm
31
21
13
32
22
14
Limit Switches
32
22
14
ZCKMD39H29 + ZCKD10
1,8
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD39H29 + ZCKD02
3,1 (A) 7,8 (P) mm
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD39H29 + ZCKD21
4,6 (A) 11,1 (P)mm
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD39H29 + ZCKD15
26 58 (P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD39H29 + ZCKD06
30
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
31
21
13
4,5 (P) mm
0 11
70 14
3-pole N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141)
ZCKMD37H29 + ZCKD10
1,8 3,2 (P) mm
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD37H29 + ZCKD02
3,1 (A) 3,2 (P) mm
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD37H29 + ZCKD21
4,6 (A) 8 (P) mm
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD37H29 + ZCKD15
26
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD37H29 + ZCKD06
30
21-22 31-32 13-14
42 (P) 36 70 0
5,5
5,2
5,5
7,6
40
0.300 (0.661)
0.280 (0.617)
0.250 (0.551)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation
1 m/s (3.28 ft/s), any direction 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in) 0.13 Nm (1.15 lb-in) On end By 30 cam By any moving part
Maximum actuation speed Minimum force or torque Cable entry (3) For tripping For positive opening
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
3 entries tapped M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry, clamping capacity 7 to 13 mm (0.28 to 0.51 in.)
1. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 90 steps by reversing the notched washer. 2. Switches with gold contacts or eyelet type connections: please consult your local sales office. 3. For an entry tapped for a PG 11 conduit thread, delete H29 from the end of the catalog number. Example: XCKM110H29 becomes XCKM110. 4. Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mounting. Note: To convert XCKM110 from PG 11 to 1/2" NPT, use adapter DE9RA1012, included.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKMComplete Switches w/ 3 ISO M20x1.5 Cable Entries, Including One 1/2" NPT Adapter
XCKM10 ZCKMD3 + ZCKD10 XCKM02 ZCKMD3 + ZCKD02 XCKM21 ZCKMD3 + ZCKD21
14 14 4 8
14
30
48,5
88,5
(1) 30
41 64
22 15 5,5
14
41
34,5
60,5
201
142,5
112,5
108
119
(2)
27
54
54
30 8 34
(1)
41 64
(1) 30
41 64
1. 3 tapped entries for ISO M20 x 1.5 or PG 11 conduit thread. Includes 1/2" NPT conduit adapter DE9RA1012. 2. 2 x 4 H 11, depth 10. : 2 elongated holes 5.2 x 6.2.
(1)
21
(2)
1. 2.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKLComplete Switches Incorporating Adapter for 1/2" NPT
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Rotary (mounting by the body) Multi-directional (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
XCKL102
4,5(P) 5,5mm
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKL121
4,6(A) 11,1(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKL115
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKL106
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
13
21
1,8 0 0,9
14
22
mm 2,2
13
21
XCKL510
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKL502
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKL521
4,6(A) 8(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKL515
21-22 13-14
XCKL506
21-22 13-14
14
22
5,5mm
5,2
mm
7,6 mm
ZCKLD39 + ZCKD10
1,8
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKLD39 + ZCKD02
3,1 (A) 7,8 (P) mm
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKLD39 + ZCKD21
4,6 (A) 11,1 (P)mm
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKLD39 + ZCKD15
26 58 (P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKLD39 + ZCKD06
30
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
31
21
13
4,5 (P) mm
32
22
14
0 11
70 14
ZCKL7 + ZCKD02
5,6(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKL7 + ZCKD21
8(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKL7+ ZCKD15
ZCKL7 + ZCKD06
3,2(P)
11-12 21-22
12
22
1,8
5,5mm
3,1(A) 9mm
4,6(A) mm
11-12 21-22
11-12 21-22
Limit Switches
ZCKLD37 + 3-pole ZCKD10 N/C + N/C + N/O 1,8 3,2 (P) break before make, 21-22 slow break (XE3NP2141) 31-32 13-14
0 3
31
21
13
ZCKLD37 + ZCKD02
mm 5,5 3,1 (A) 3,2 (P) mm
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKLD37 + ZCKD21
4,6 (A) 8 (P) mm
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKLD37 + ZCKD15
26
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKLD37 + ZCKD06
30
21-22 31-32 13-14
42 (P) 36 70 0
32
22
14
5,2
5,5
7,6
40
0.305 (0.672)
0.285 (0.628)
0.255 (0.562)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation
1 m/s (3.28 ft/s), any direction 0.1 Nm (0.89 lb-in) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in) 0.13 Nm (1.15 lb-in) On end By 30 cam By any moving part
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb)
1 entry incorporating metal cable entry. Clamping capacity 6 to 13.5 mm (0.24 to 0.53 in.).
Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 90 steps by reversing the notched washer. Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mounting. Switches with gold contacts or eyelet type connections: please consult your local sales office.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKLComplete Switches Incorporating Adapter for 1/2" NPT
XCKL10 ZCKL + ZCKD10 ZCKLD3 + ZCKD10 XCKL02 ZCKL3 + ZCKD02 ZCKLD3 + ZCKD02 XCKL21 ZCKL + ZCKD21 ZCKLD3 + ZCKD21
14 4 30
14 8
14
48,5
97
115,5
(1) 30
41 52
= (1) 30 = 41 52 =
30
121
(1)
41 59,5
Body mountings
22 15 6 34,5
14
142,5
72
60,5
127,5
209,5
(1) 30
30 8 34
(1)
41 52
(1) 30
41 52
Limit Switches
41 52
67
54 5,5
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKM and XCKLModular
ZCK D81
ZCK D91
ZCK D41
ZCK D59
Cats whisker
Spring rod
ZCK D06
ZCK D08
ZCK D15
ZCK D16
ZCK D17
Limit Switches
1. 2.
ZCK D21
Thermoplastic roller lever plunger with protective boot, 1 direction of actuation ZCK D219
ZCK D23
ZCK D239
ZCK D10
ZCK D109
ZCK D02
ZCK D029
Dimensions: mm (in.)
For further details. See page 476. For 3 cable entries tapped ISO M20 x 1.5, add H29 to the catalog number. Example: ZCKM1 becomes ZCKM1H29.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKM and XCKLModular
ZCK Y54
ZCK Y55
ZCK Y59
ZCK Y81
ZCK Y91
ZCK Y41
ZCK Y43
ZCK Y49
ZCK Y39
ZCK Y31
For actuation from left AND right or from left OR right
ZCK Y33
ZCK Y34
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKM and XCKLModular
Bodies with 2-pole contact
With contact block For limit switches type XCKM
13 21
Function diagram
Cable entry
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
14
22
N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151) N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151) N/O + N/C make before make, slow break (XE2NP2161) N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2141) N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2131) N/C + N/C snap action (XE2SP2141) For limit switches type XCKL N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151) N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151) N/O + N/C make before make, slow break (XE2NP2161) N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2141) N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2131)
1. 2.
1/2" NPT (2) ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT (2) ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT (2) ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT (2) ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT (2) ISO M20 x 1.5
ZCKM1 ZCKM1H29 ZCKM5 ZCKM5H29 ZCKM6 ZCKM6H29 ZCKM7 ZCKM7H29 ZCKM8 ZCKM8H29
0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463)
13 21 11 13 14 11 12 22 14
21
24
23
22
21
14
13
22
21
ZCKM9H29
0.210 (0.463)
12 13
21
22
1/2" NPT
ZCKL1
0.210 (0.463)
14 13
21
22
1/2" NPT
ZCKL5
0.210 (0.463)
12
13
23
22
14
: N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator. 3 PG 11 tapped entries, one with metal adapter for 1/2" NPT (USASB2-1) conduit (PG 8).
24
Limit Switches
21
14
13
22
1/2" NPT
ZCKL6
0.210 (0.463)
22 11
21
14
1/2" NPT
ZCKL7
0.210 (0.463)
1/2" NPT
ZCKL8
0.210 (0.463)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKM and XCKLModular
Bodies with 3-pole contact
With contact block For limit switches type XCKM
33 31 13
Function diagram
Cable entry
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
34
32
14
N/C + N/O + N/O snap action (XE3SP2151) N/C + N/C + N/O snap action (XE3SP2141) N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141) N/C + N/O + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2151) For limit switches type XCKL
1/2" NPT (2) ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT (2) ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT (2) ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT (2) ISO M20 x 1.5
0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463) 0.210 (0.463)
31
21 22 21 33 34 33 22
32
31
32
21
22
34
32
31
N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141) N/C + N/O + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2151)
1. 2.
32
22
31
21
13
14
21
13
14
31
13
14
13
14
13
14
13
1/2" NPT
ZCKLD31
0.210 (0.463)
1/2" NPT
ZCKLD39
0.210 (0.463)
1/2" NPT
ZCKLD37
0.210 (0.463)
32
33
22
21
13
14
1/2" NPT
ZCKLD35
0.210 (0.463)
34
22
14
: N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator. 3 PG 11 tapped entries, one with metal adapter for 1/2" NPT (USASB2-1) conduit (PG 8).
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKM and XCKLModular
Contact blocks
Type of contact 2-pole contact N/C + N/O snap action N/C + N/O break before make, slow break N/O + N/C make before break, slow break N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break N/C + N/C snap action 3-pole contact
33 13 21
ZCKM1 ZCKL1 XE2SP2151 0.020 (0.044)
Function diagram
For bodies
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
14 13
21
22
21
14
13
22
ZCKM5 ZCKL5
XE2NP2151
0.020 (0.044)
11
22
21
14
ZCKM6 ZCKL6
XE2NP2161
0.020 (0.044)
13
12
23
22
ZCKM7 ZCKL7
XE2NP2141
0.020 (0.044)
14
11
21
24
ZCKM8 ZCKL8
XE2NP2131
0.020 (0.044)
ZCKM9
XE2SP2141
0.020 (0.044)
12
22 13
34
32
31
32
22
31
32
22
1.
: N/C contact with positive opening operation or sub-assembly assuring positive opening operation when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
22
34
14
21
33
13
14
21
13
14
21
13
14
31
ZCKMD31 ZCKLD31
XE3SP2151
0.035 (0.077)
ZCKMD39 ZCKLD39
XE3SP2141
0.035 (0.077)
ZCKMD37 ZCKLD37
XE3NP2141
0.035 (0.077)
Limit Switches
0 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ZCKMD35 ZCKLD35
XE3NP2151
0.035 (0.077)
Weight kg (lb)
0.010 (0.022)
Tap-off terminal 1 for cabling continuity Clip-in markers 25 (strips of 10 numbers: 0 to 9) Other markers, please consult your local sales office. Gold flashed contacts: consult your local sales office. Other versions
AB1R11
0.002 (0.004)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKM and XCKLModular
ZCKM1, L1
1,8
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKM5, L5
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKM6, L6
3 4,4(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKM7, L7
3,2(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKM8, L8
13-14 23-24
4,5(P) 0 5,5mm
5,5mm
1,8
5,5mm
1,8
5,5mm
1,8
5,5mm
0,9
ZCKM9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKMD39, LD39
4,5(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD37, LD37
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD31, LD31
1,8
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKMD35, LD35
1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
1,8
1,8
4,5(P) 0
4,5(P)
0 0,9
5,5mm
5,5mm
0 0,9 5,5mm
5,5mm
0,9
5,5mm
ZCKM1, L1
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKM5, L5
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKM6, L6
5,2(A)
21-22 13-14
ZCKM7, L7
5,6(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKM8, L8
13-14 23-24
7,6(P) 9mm
0 0 mm 1,5
5,2
mm
3,1
3,1(A)
9mm
3,1(A)
9mm
ZCKM9
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKMD39, LD39
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD37, LD37
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD31, LD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKMD35, LD35
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
0 1,5
mm
0 1,5 mm
5,2 mm
5,2 mm
ZCKM1, L1
4,6(A) 11,1(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKM5, L5
4,6(A) 8(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKM6, L6
7,6 11,1(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKM7, L7
8(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKM8, L8
13-14 23-24
0 0 mm 2,2
7,6 mm
4,6(A)
mm
4,6(A)
mm
4,6(A)
mm
ZCKM9
4,6(A) 11,1(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKMD39, LD39
4,6(A) 11,1(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD37, LD37
4,6(A) 8(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD31, LD31
4,6(A) 11,1(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKMD35, LD35
4,6(A) 8(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
0 2,2
mm
0 0 2,2 mm
7,6 mm
0 2,2 mm
7,6 mm
ZCKM1, L1
26
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKM5, L5
26 42 (P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKM6, L6
40
21-22 13-14
ZCKM7, L7
43 (P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKM8, L8
13-14 23-24
58 (P) 0
60 (P) 70
36
70
24
24
70
24
70
11
ZCKM9
26
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKMD39, LD39
58 (P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD37, LD37
26 42(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD31, LD31
26
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKMD35, LD35
26 42(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
26
58(P) 0
58(P) 0
0 11
70
36 70
36 70
11
70
11
70
ZCKM1, L1
26
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKM5, L5
26
21-22 13-14
ZCKM6, L6
40
21-22 13-14
ZCKM7, L7
11-12 21-22
ZCKM8, L8
13-14 23-24
0 0 70 11
36
70
24
70
24
70
24
70
ZCKM9
26
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKMD39, LD39
26
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD37, LD37
26
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD31, LD31
26
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKMD35, LD35
26
21-22 33-34 13-14
0 11
70
0 70 11
36 70
0 0 11 70
36 70
ZCKM1, L1
30
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKM5, L5
30
21-22 13-14
ZCKM6, L6
40
21-22 13-14
ZCKM7, L7
11-12 21-22
ZCKM8, L8
13-14 23-24
0 14
40
30
30
30
ZCKM9
30
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKMD39, LD39
30
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD37, LD37
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKMD31, LD31
30
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKMD35, LD35
30
21-22 33-34 13-14
30 0 40
0 14
40
14
0 14
Contact operation
Limit Switches
70
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKM and XCKLModular
Bodies with contacts ZCKM1, M5, M6, M7, M8, ZCKM1H29, M5H29, M6H29, M7H29, M8H29, M9H29
63,6
58,5
72
(1)
30
41 64
(2)
30
41
52
(3)
26
21
(4)
1. 2. : 3. 4. 5.
3 tapped entries for ISO M20 x 1.5 or PG 11 conduit thread. Incorporated cable entry. 2 elongated holes 5.2 x 6.2. Tapped entry for 1/2" NPT conduit. Threaded sleeve, PG 11. XCKL provided with 1/2" NPT adapter shown above, DE9RA1012.
Complete Switches
For interpreting the complete switch catalog number only
XCKL
Xcomplete Zcomponent
Switch type 1 SPDT N.O., N.C. snap 5 SPDT N.O., N.C. slow
Head type 00rotary programmable 02roller plunger 06wobble stick 10steel plunger 21one way 15rotary
67
Limit Switches
480
Levers (for rotary head 00 only) 11Delrin roller 41adjustable Delrin roller
NOTE: Some combinations are not available. Use this information to interpret catalog numbers, not to create them.
09/2007
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKM and XCKLModular
Plunger heads ZCKD10
ZCKD109
ZCKD02
14
14 4 30 30
14
ZCKD029
ZCKD21, D23
ZCKD219, D239
14 4 8
14 13 8
14 13
48
54
ZCKD41
ZCKD59
37 15 5,5 6
51 43 29,5...84
44,5
31,7
50 ...104,5
(1)
55
ZCKG00
54
48,5 34
ZCKD81
34,5 60,5
ZCKD91
51 51 112 179 6
51 43 29,5...84
56
Multi-directional heads ZCKD06
56
56
ZCKD08
14
14
1. 2.
142,5
129,5
50 ...104,5
Limit Switches
56
(2)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKML, 2 x 2-Pole ContactsComplete Switches
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Rotary (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers (2) Switches with 3 entries tapped ISO M20 x 1.5
2 x 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action (XESP2151L)
13 21
13 21
XCKML110H29
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKML102H29
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKML121H29
5(A) 12,6(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKML115H29
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
5(P) A B
4(A) 9(P)
A B 0 2 mm
A B
A B
14
22
14
22
0 1,2
6mm
0 3
mm
2 x 2-pole N/C + N/O XCKML510H29 break before make, slow break 2 3,4(P) (XENP2151L)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKML502H29
3,3(A) 6(P) 21-22 A 13-14 21-22 B 13-14 0 mm 6
XCKML521H29
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKML515H29
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
3,3
A B 6,6mm
6(A) 9,3(P) A B 10 mm
A B
13
21
13
21
14
22
14
Switches with 3 entries tapped for PG 13 conduit thread, plus adapter for 1/2" NPT
2 x 2-pole N/C + N/O snap action (XESP2151L)
13 21
13 21
22
XCKML110
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKML102
A B
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKML121
5(A) 12,6(P) A B
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKML115
A B
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
5(P)
4(A) 9(P)
A B
14
22
14
22
0 1,2
6mm
0 2
mm
0 3
mm
Limit Switches
2 x 2-pole N/C + N/O XCKML510 break before make, slow break 2 3,4(P) (XENP2151L)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKML502
3,3(A) 6(P) 21-22 A 13-14 21-22 B 13-14 0 mm 6
XCKML521
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKML515
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
3,3
A B 6,6mm
6(A) 9,3(P) A B 10 mm
A B
13
21
13
21
14
22
14
22
0.450 (0.992)
0.430 (0.948)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed For tripping Minimum For positive force opening
0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 60 N (13.49 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 50 N (11.24 lb) 1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 8 N (1.80 lb) 50 N (11.24 lb) 0.2 Nm (1.77 lb-in) 0.5 Nm (4.43 lb-in) On end By 30 cam
3 entries tapped ISO M20 x 1.5, clamping capacity 7 to 13 mm (0.28 to 0.51 in.); or 3 entries tapped for PG 13 conduit thread conforming to NF C 68-300 (DIN PG 13.5), Cable entry clamping capacity 9 to 12 mm (0.35 to 0.47 in.) (0.35 to 0.47 in.), plus adapter for 1/2" NPT 1. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 90 steps by reversing the notched washer. 2. Switches available with other 2-pole slow break contact blocks: N/O + N/C make before break, N/C + N/C simultaneous (with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator), N/C + N/C simultaneous, please consult your local sales office.
Replacement parts The heads of limit switches type XCKML are the same as those for types XCKM and XCKL (see heads ZCKD10, ZCKD02, ZCKD21 and ZCKD15 on page 474).
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal
XCKML, 2 x 2-Pole ContactsComplete Switches
XCKML110H29, XCKML510H29, XCKML110, XCKML510 XCKML102H29, XCKML502H29, XCKML102, XCKML502
6,5
6,5
123,2
5,5
105
6,2
5,5 81
(2)
(1)
= 61,5 77
(1)
=
(2)
6,2
(1)
(1)
(1)
35,6
5 14,65
(1)
15 35,6
14,65 8 20
22 5,5
15,45
6,5
129
59 11,5
5,5
6,2
5,5 81
135
(2)
(1)
= 61,5 77
(1)
=
(2)
(1)
(1)
(1)
15 35,6
(1)
15 35,6
1. XCKMLH29: 3 entries tapped M20 x 1.5. XCKML: 3 entries tapped for PG 13 conduit thread (adapter DE9RA1212 for 1/2" NPT available). 2. 2 centering holes 3.9 0.2, cover mounting holes axis. : 2 elongated holes 6.2 x 6.5, inclined at 2630 to the vertical axis, for M5 screws.
(1) 25.4
21.3
(2) 20.4
1. 2.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJ
b XCKJ
fixed, non-plug-in body with 1 cable entry
561646 561647 561649
Page 486
Page 486
b XCKJ
plug-in body with 1 cable entry
Page 488
561653
561654
561652
Page 488
Environmental characteristics
Conforming to standards Product certifications Protective treatment Ambient air temperature Products Machine assemblies Version Operation
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1, UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 IEC 60204-1, EN 60204-1 UL, CSA, CCC Standard TC, special TH -25+70 C (-13+158 F), special sub-assemblies available for extreme temperatures: -40 C (-40 F) or +120 C (248 F) -40+70 C (-40+158 F) 25 gn (10500 Hz) 50 gn (11 ms) Class I conforming to IEC 61140 and NF C 20-030 NEMA Types 1, 2, 4, 12; IP 66 conforming to IEC 60529; IK 07 conforming to EN 50 102 0.01 mm on the tripping points, with 1 million operating cycles for head with end plunger Tapped entry for PG 13 conduit thread, or tapped ISO M20 x 1.5 or 1/2" NPT, or M12 connector Bodies and heads in Zamak zinc alloy
Storage Vibration resistance Conforming to IEC 60068-2-6 Shock resistance Conforming to IEC 60068-2-27 Electric shock protection Degree of protection Repeat accuracy Cable entry or integral connector Depending on model Materials
561655
561650
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJ
Contact block characteristics
Rated operational characteristics XE2P XE3P XE2P Rated insulation voltage XE3P XE2P XE3P Positive operation (depending on model) Resistance across terminals XE2P Short-circuit protection XE3P XE2SP211 XE2NP211 Cabling (screw clamp terminals) XCKJ plug-in and XESP201 XE3NP and XE3SP Rated impulse withstand voltage Minimum actuation speed
a AC-15; A300 (Ue = 240 V, Ie = 3 A); Ithe = 10 A c DC-13; Q300 (Ue = 250 V, Ie = 0.27 A), conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 appendix A, EN 60947-5-1 a AC-15; B300 (Ue = 240 V, Ie = 1.5 A); Ithe = 6 A c DC-13; R300 (Ue = 250 V, Ie = 0.1 A), conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 appendix A, EN 60947-5-1 Ui = 500 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-1 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 Ui = 400 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-1 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 U imp = 6 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 U imp = 4 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 N/C contacts with positive opening operation conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix K, EN 60947-5-1 y 25 m conforming to IEC 60255-7 category 3 10 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl) 6 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl) Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.34 mm2, max: 2 x 1.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.5 mm2, max: 2 x 2.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.75 mm2, max: 2 x 1.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.34 mm2, max: 1 x 1 mm2 or 2 x 0.75 mm2 XE2SP211 and XE3SP: 0.01 m/minute (0.03 ft/minute) XE2NP211 and XE3NP: 6 m/minute (19.68 ft/minute)
Conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix C Utilization categories AC-15 and DC-13 Maximum operating rate: 3600 operating cycles/hour Load factor: 0.5 XE2NP211 XCKJ plug-in, XESP201
Millions of operating cycles
Ithe
5 4 3 2 1 0,5
5 4 3 2 1 0,5
1 0,5
110 V 230/400 V
24 V 48 V
0,2
10 3 4 5 Current in A
3 4 5 10 Current in A
10 3 4 5 Current in A
d.c. supply c
For XE2SP151 on a or c, N/C and N/O contacts simultaneously loaded to the values shown with reverse polarity. XE3NP XE3SP
Millions of operating cycles Millions of operating cycles
Ithe
5 4 3 2
Ithe
230 V
1 0,5
12/24/48 V 110 V
24 V 48 V
3 4 5 10 Current in A
d.c. supply c
Limit Switches
0,1 0,5
0,1 0,5
0,1 0,5
110 V
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJComplete Switches, Fixed Non-plug-in Body, 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Form B (1) Form C (1) Rotary (mounting by the body) (switches supplied for actuation from left AND right) Form A (1) Form D (1)
Type of operator
XCKJ167
4,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKJ10511
8,1(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKJ10513
23
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKJ10541
23
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKJ10559
23
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
3,2(A)
23
58(P)
58(P)
14
22
0 0,9
6 mm
0 1,5
mm
0 11
90
0 11
90
0 11
90
0 11
90
13
21
XCKJ561
2
21-22 13-14
XCKJ567
3,2(A)
21-22 13-14
XCKJ50511
5,9(P) 23 40(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKJ50513
23 40(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKJ50541
23
21-22 13-14
XCKJ50559
23
21-22 13-14
14
22
3,4(P) 3,2 6 mm 0
5,3
mm
33
90
33
90
33
90
33
90
12
22
ZCKJ9 + ZCKE61
2
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKJ9 + ZCKE67
4,7(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
11
21
3,2(A)
23
58(P)
58(P)
0 0,9
6 mm
0 1,5
mm
0 11
90
0 11
90
0 11
90
0 11
90
ZCKJ7 + 2-pole N/C + N/C ZCKE61 simultaneous, slow break 3,4(P) (XE2NP2141) 11-12 21-22
0 2 6 mm
11
12
22
21
ZCKJ7 + ZCKE67
5,9(P)
11-12 21-22
3,5(A)
mm
28
90
11-12 21-22
11-12 21-22
28
90
28
90
28
90
31
21
32
22
14
13
Limit Switches
ZCKJD39 + ZCKE61
2
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD39 + ZCKE67
4,7(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
31
21
13
32
22
14
3,2(A)
23
58(P)
58(P)
0 0,9
6 mm
0 1,5
mm
0 11
90
0 11
90
0 11
90
90
3-pole N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141)
ZCKJD37 + ZCKE61
2
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD37 + ZCKE67
3,2(A) 5,9(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
3,4(P) 6 mm
3,2
5,3
mm
33
90
33
90
33
90
0.455 (1.003)
0.490 (1.080)
0.485 (1.069)
0.485 (1.069)
contact closed
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum For tripping force or For positive torque opening Cable entry
1. 2. 3. 4. On end By 30 cam By any moving part
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in) 0.50 Nm (4.43 lb-in)
1 entry tapped 1/2" NPT for ISO cable entry, clamping capacity 9 to 12 mm (0.35 to 0.47 in.)
Form conforming to EN 50041. See page 409. Switches with gold contacts or eyelet type connections: please consult your local sales office. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 45 steps by reversing the lever or its mounting. Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mounting.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJComplete Switches, Fixed Non-plug-in Body, 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
XCKJ61 ZCKJ+ ZCKE61 XCKJ67 ZCKJ + ZCKE67 XCKJ051 ZCKJ + ZCKE05 + ZCKY11 or ZCKY13
17 5 37
17 5
57 41
50
107
60
60
120
(1) = 30 40 =
52 5,5 44
26,2
132177
60
(1) 33,5 60
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. :
(1) = 30 40 = 33,5 60 = 30 40 =
(3)
(4) (5)
60
63
1 tapped entry for 1/2" NPT. Rod 6 mm (0.24 in.), length 200 mm (7.87 in.). 282 max. 190 max. 212 max. 2 elongated holes 5.3 x 7.3.
XCKJ
Zcomponent Xcomplete
Head type 05Rotary 09Rotary maintained 61Top rod plunger 67Top roller plunger
Levers 11Delrin roller 13Steel roller 41Adjustable Delrin roller 59Round plastic rod
Switch type
1 2 4 5 8 SPDT 2SPDT 2SPDT SPDT SPDT Non-plug-in Non-plug-in Non-plug-in for 2 step or neutral position Non-plug-in slow make slow break Gold Contacts Plug-in Plug-in Plug-in for 2 step or neutral position
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJComplete Switches, Plug-in Body, 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Form B (1) Form C (1) Rotary (mounting by the body) (switches supplied for actuation from left AND right) Form A (1) Form D (1)
Type of operator
XCKJ1167
11-12 13-14 11-12 13-14
XCKJ110511
11-12 13-14 11-12 13-14
XCKJ110513
11-12 13-14 11-12 13-14
XCKJ110541
11-12 13-14 11-12 13-14
XCKJ110559
11-12 13-14 11-12 13-14
13
11
2 0 0,9 6mm
3,2(A) 0 1,5 mm
14
12
0.480 (1.058)
0.490 (1.080)
0.485 (1.069)
0.485 (1.069)
Characteristics
Switch actuation
On end By 30 cam By any moving part
Type of actuation
Cable entry
1. 2. 3. 4.
1 entry tapped for 1/2" NPT cable entry. Clamping capacity 7 to 13 mm (0.28 to 0.51 in.)
Limit Switches
Form conforming to EN 50041. See page 409. Switches with gold contacts: please consult your local sales office. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 45 steps by reversing the lever mounting or clamp. Value taken with actuator operating at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mounting.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJComplete Switches, Plug-in Body, 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
XCKJ1611 XCKJ1167 XCKJ110511, XCKJ110513
17 5 37
17 5
57 41
114
60
127
60
140
25 36 =
XCKJ110541
XCKJ110559
52 5,5 44
48
26,2 (2)
4085 62107
(4)
139184
(3)
60
60
(5)
60
41 63
50
25 60 =
(1) 30 42,5 = 60
25 =
(1) 30 42,5 =
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Tapped entry for 1/2" NPT conduit. Rod 6 mm (0.24 in.), length 200 mm (7.87 in.). 289 max. 190 max. 212 max.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJComplete Switches, Fixed Non-plug-in Body, Integral M12 Connector
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Form B (1) Form C (1) Rotary (mounting by the body) (switches supplied for actuation from left AND right) Form A (1) Form D (1)
Type of operator
Metal end plunger Steel roller plunger Thermoplastic roller lever (2) Steel roller lever (2)
XCKJ167D
XCKJ10511D
XCKJ10513D
XCKJ10541D
XCKJ10559D
13
21
14
22
4,7(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
0 0,9
6mm
0.455 (1.003)
0.480 (1.058)
0.490 (1.080)
0.485 (1.069)
0.485 (1.069)
Characteristics
Switch actuation
On end By 30 cam By any moving part
Type of actuation
Limit Switches
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in) 0.50 Nm (4.43 lb-in)
Form conforming to EN 50041. See page 409. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 45 steps by reversing the lever or its mounting. Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mounting. Switches with gold contacts: please consult your local sales office.
Weight, kg (lb)
0.115 (0.254) 0.270 (0.595) 0.520 (1.146)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJComplete Switches, Fixed Non-plug-in Body, Integral M12 Connector
Dimensions
XCKJ161D XCKJ167D XCKJ1051D
17 5 37
17 5
57 41
107
60
120
60
133
12
33,5 44
30 40
= 12 33,5 44 = 30 40 = 12 33,5 62
XZCP1164L
30 40
XCKJ10541D
XCKJ10559D
52 5,5 44
48 (1)
26,2 42 L
4085 62107
(3) (4)
XZCP1264L
26
132177
(2)
60
12
33,5 59
1. 2. 3. 4. : L:
30 40
59
40
Rod 6 mm (0.24 in.), length 200 mm (7.87 in.) 282 max. 190 max. 212 max. 2 elongated holes 5.3 x 7.3 Cable length 2, 5, or 10 m (6.6, 16.4, or 32.8 ft)
Connections
Limit switch XCKJD Pre-wired female connector XZCP164L
2 3 4
1-2 = N/C 3-4 = N/O 5 =t 4 A / 24 V max.
2 1 1 4
1 = brown 2 = white 3 = blue 4 = black 5 = t yellow/green
13
14
22
21
Limit Switches
12
33,5
30
60
32 40
20
60
41 63
50
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJComplete Switches, Fixed Non-plug-in Body, Integral 7/8" 16UN connector
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Form B (1) Form C (1) Rotary (mounting by the body) (switches supplied for actuation from left AND right) Form A (1) Form D (1)
Type of operator
XCKJ167A
3,2(A) 8,1(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKJ10511A
XCKJ10513A
XCKJ10541A
XCKJ10559A
13
21
2 0 0,9
4,7(P) 6mm 0
14
22
mm 1,5
0.455 (1.003)
0.480 (1.058)
0.490 (1.080)
0.485 (1.069)
0.485 (1.069)
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation
On end By 30 cam By any moving part
Type of actuation
Maximum actuation speed For tripping Minimum force or torque For positive opening Connection
1. 2. 3. 4.
1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.25 Nm (2.21 lb-in) 0.50 Nm (4.43 lb-in)
7/8" 16UN 5-pin connector, Ui = 250 V; Ie = 6 A (see suitable pre-wired female connectors below).
Form conforming to EN 50041. See page 409. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 45 steps by reversing the lever mounting or clamp. Value taken with actuator operating at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mounting. Switches with gold contacts: please consult your local sales office.
Limit Switches
Weight, kg (lb)
0.190 (0.419) 0.475 (1.047) 0.950 (2.094)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJComplete Switches, Fixed Non-plug-in Body, Integral 7/8" 16UN connector
Dimensions
XCKJ161A XCKJ167A XCKJ1051A
57 17 5 17 50 41 63 133 17 33,5 62 = 30 40 =
XZCP1771L
41
37
107
120
60
17
17
33,5 44
30 40
33,5 44
30 40
XCKJ10541A
XCKJ10559A
52 5,5 44
26,2
60
132177
(2)
60
60
(3) (4)
55
60
33,5 59
1. 2. 3. 4. : L:
30 40
33,5 59
30 40
Rod 6 mm (0.24 in.), length 200 mm (7.87 in.) 282 max. 190 max. 212 max. 2 elongated holes 5.3 x 7.3 cable length: 2, 5, or 10 m (6.6, 16.4, or 32.8 ft)
Connections
Limit switch XCKJA Pre-wired female connector XZCP1771L
3 4 5
1 = 21 2 = 22 3=t 4 = 14 5 = 13
3 2 1
13 21
2 1
4 5
14
22
Limit Switches
17
17
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies
Thermoplastic roller lever plunger, 1 direction of actuation
ZCK E21
ZCK E63
Spring rod
ZCK E08
Cats whisker
ZCK E06
Limit Switches
1. 2. 3.
ZCK E67
ZCK E62
Body with 2-pole contact, fixed, 1 step, M12 connector (2) ZCK J1D, J5D, J6D, J7D ZCK J8D
Body with contact, cable entry for PG 13, fixed, 1 step (2) (3) ZCK JD3p, ZCK J1, J5, J6, J7, J9 Body with contact, cable entry for PG 13, fixed, 1 step (2) (3) ZCK J2, J8 Body with contact, cable entry for PG 13, fixed, 2 step (2) (3) ZCK J4
Body with contact, cable entry for PG 13, plug-in, 1 or 2 step (2) (3) ZCK J11, J21, J41
Cannot be used with bodies ZCKJ4 and ZCKJ41. For further details, see page 496. For a cable entry tapped ISO M20 x 1.5, add H29 to the catalog number. Example: ZCKJ1 becomes ZCKJ1H29. For a cable entry tapped 1/2" NPT, do not add an H code to the catalog number. Example: ZCKJ1.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies
Dimensions: mm (in.)
ZCK Y51
ZCK Y53
ZCK Y59
ZCK E05
Fixed body with one SPDT contact switch per direction: past 20 CW contact 1 (1112 / 1314) switches; past 20 CCW contact 2 (2122 / 2324) switches (3)
ZCK J404
Plug-in body with one SPDT contact switch per direction: past 20 CW contact 1 (1112 / 1314) switches; past 20 CCW contact 2 (2122 / 2324) switches (3)
ZCK J4104
Limit Switches
Spring return, for actuation from left AND right or from left OR right
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Fixed bodies with 2-pole contact
Type With contact block
N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151) 2 C/O simultaneous, snap action (XESP2021) N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151) N/C + N/O make before make, slow break (XE2NP2161) N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2141) N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2131) N/C + N/C snap action (XE2SP2141) 2 C/O staggered, snap action (XESP2031)
Function diagram
13 21
Catalog number
ZCKJ1 ZCKJ1H29 ZCKJ2 ZCKJ2H29 ZCKJ5 ZCKJ5H29 ZCKJ6 ZCKJ6H29 ZCKJ7 ZCKJ7H29 ZCKJ8 ZCKJ8H29 ZCKJ9 ZCKJ9H29 ZCKJ4 ZCKJ4H29
Weight kg (lb)
0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683)
14
11
22
13
23
21
1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5
12
14
13
21
14
1 step
11
22
12
13
14
11
12
11
22
21
24
23
22
21
14
13
22
21
24 23
13
21
22
2 step
12
14
Function diagram
33 31 13
24
22
Catalog number
ZCKJD31 ZCKJD31H29 ZCKJD39 ZCKJD39H29 ZCKJD37 ZCKJD37H29 ZCKJD35 ZCKJD35H29
Weight kg (lb)
0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683)
31
N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141) N/C + N/O + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2151) 1.
32
22 21 22 33 34
32
21
: N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
22
14
13
14
13
14
Limit Switches
34 21
32
31
13
14
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Plug-in bodies with contact
Type With contact block
Single-pole C/O snap action
Function diagram
13 11
Catalog number
ZCKJ11 ZCKJ11H29 ZCKJ21 ZCKJ21H29 ZCKJ41 ZCKJ41H29
Weight kg (lb)
0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661)
1 step
11 13 23 21
Double-pole 2 C/O simultaneous, snap action Double-pole 2 C/O staggered, snap action 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5
14
12
12
14
11
24 23 24
2 step ZCKJ1
13
12
14
22
21
22
Function diagram
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
11
13
12
14
24
22
23
21
ZCKJ404H29
0.455 (1.003)
Plug-in body ZCKJ404 Neutral position 1 from the left AND 1 from the right
1/2" NPT ZCKJ4104 0.465 (1.025)
11
13
12
23 24
14
22
21
ZCKJ4104H29
0.465 (1.025)
: N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
ZCKJ0
Limit Switches
Description
Contacts
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
With Indicator Light Module Fixed non-plug-in bodies with 2-pole contact
With contact block With module comprising 1 LED, 24 Vc Type
N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151)
Function diagram
13 21
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
1/2" NPT
ZCKJ120
1 step
N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151)
14
13
21
22
0.320 (0.705)
1/2" NPT
ZCKJ520
14
13
1 step
N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151)
14
13
14
1 step
N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151)
14
13
14
1 step
N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151)
14
13
Function diagram
13 11
14
22
21
22
22
21
22
22
21
22
21
22
0.320 (0.705)
14
12
1 step
14
12
13
11
1 step
1.
: N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
14
12
13
11
Limit Switches
498
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
0.340 (0.750) 0.340 (0.750) 0.340 (0.750) 0.340 (0.750) 0.340 (0.750) 0.340 (0.750)
ZCKJ1121 ZCKJ1121H29
2 neon lights
250 Va, conforming to IEC 60947-1 2.5 mA per neon 110/120 Va 95130 Va 20 000 hours 5 mA per neon 220/240 Va 190260 Va 20 000 hours
09/2007
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in Bodies with M12 Connector
Fixed bodies with 2-pole contact
Type With contact block
N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151)
Function diagram
13 21
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
0.320 (0.705)
ZCKJ1D
14 13
N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151) N/O + N/C make before make, slow break (XE2NP2161) N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2141) N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2131) 1.
21
22
ZCKJ5D
21
14
13
22
0.320 (0.705)
1 step
ZCKJ6D
11
22
21
14
0.320 (0.705)
ZCKJ7D
13
12
23
22
0.320 (0.705)
ZCKJ8D
14
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
24
0.320 (0.705)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Low-Temperature Applications (40 F / 40 C) Body with contactsFor plunger or rotary head
Type Fixed non-plug-in body
2-pole 1 N/C + 1 N/O snap action (XE2SP2151) Double-pole 2 C/O simultaneous snap action (XESP2021) 2-pole 1 N/C + 1 N/O break before make slow break (XE2NP2151) 2-pole 1 N/O + 1 N/C make before break slow break (XE2NP2161) 2-pole 1 N/C + 1 N/C simultaneous slow break (XE2NP2141) 2-pole 1 N/O + 1 N/O simultaneous slow break (XE2NP2131) 2-pole 1 N/C + 1 N/C snap action (XE2SP2141) Double-pole 2 C/O staggered snap action (XESP2031)
Contact block
Function diagram
Cable entry
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
13
21
ZCKJ1 ZCKJ1H29 ZCKJ2 ZCKJ2H29 ZCKJ5 ZCKJ5H29 ZCKJ6 ZCKJ6H29 ZCKJ7 ZCKJ7H29 ZCKJ8 ZCKJ8H29 ZCKJ9 ZCKJ9H29 ZCKJ4 ZCKJ4H29
0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661)
14
11
22
13
23
21
1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5
12
14
ZCKJ1
13
21
14
1 step
11
22
13
12
14
11
12
11
22
ZCKJ11
21
24
23
22
21
14
13
22
21
24 23
13
21
22
2 step
12
14
Plug-in body
13 11
Single-pole 1 C/O snap action 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 ZCKJ11 ZCKJ11H29 ZCKJ21 ZCKJ21H29 ZCKJ41 ZCKJ41H29
1 step
11 13 23 21
Double-pole 2 C/O simultaneous snap action Double-pole 2 C/O staggered snap action 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5
14
12
12
24 24 23 24
14
11
2 step
13
12
Body with contactsWith spring return rotary head (without operating lever)
Type Fixed non-plug-in body Neutral position
1 from the left and 1 from the right Double-pole 2 C/O staggered snap action 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 ZCKJ4046 ZCKJ4046H29 0.455 (1.003) 0.455 (1.003) 0.465 (1.025) 0.465 (1.025)
14
22
21
22
22
11
13
12
23
14
Plug-in body
11 13 23 21
24
22
21
12
14
1.
: Operating head able to guarantee positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator. The positive opening feature requires additional travel past the trip point. See the contact function diagrams.
24
22
Limit Switches
ZCKJ4046
Contact block
Function diagram
Cable entry
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
Neutral position
1 from the left and 1 from the right
ZCKJ41046 ZCKJ41046H29
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Low-Temperature Applications (40 F / 40 C) Plunger heads
Type of operator For actuation on end ZCKE616 ZCKE636 End plunger
metal ZCKJ, ZCKJ ZCKJ, ZCKJ, except ZCKJ4 and J41 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) ZCKE616 0.140 (0.309) 0.200 (0.441)
Compatible bodies
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
Side plunger
metal
ZCKE636
ZCKE626
ZCKE676
ZCKE646
Vertical
ZCKE656
ZCKE646
ZCKE656
Thermoplastic Steel
ZCKE216 ZCKE236
Compatible bodies
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
ZCKE216
ZCKE236
Stay put,
actuation from left AND right (see page 408)
ZCKE096
Multi-directional heads
Type of operator Compatible bodies Max. actuation speed Positive operation (1) Catalog number Weight kg (lb)
ZCKE056
ZCKE096
ZCKE086
: Operating head able to guarantee positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator. The positive opening feature requires additional travel past the trip point. See the contact function diagrams.
ZCKE066
ZCKE086
Limit Switches
0.190 (0.419)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
Low-Temperature Applications (40 F / 40 C) Operating levers for rotary heads
Description For actuation by 30 cam
Thermoplastic ZCKY11 ZCKY13 ZCKY14 ZCKY41 ZCKY43 0.025 (0.055) 0.035 (0.077) 0.030 (0.066) 0.030 (0.066) 0.040 (0.088) 0.025 (0.055) 0.025 (0.055) 0.020 (0.044) 0.030 (0.066) 0.020 (0.044) 0.025 (0.055) 0.035 (0.077) 0.035 (0.077)
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
Roller lever (2) ZCKY1 ZCKY4 Variable length roller lever (3)
Steel Steel, ball bearing mounted Thermoplastic Steel U 3 mm (0.12 in.) steel, L = 125 mm (4.92 in.) 3 mm (0.12 in.) steel, L = 125 mm (4.92 in.) 3 mm (0.12 in.) glass fibre, L = 125 mm (4.92 in.) 6 mm (0.24 in.) thermoplastic, L = 200 mm (7.87 in.)
Spring lever (3) ZCKY51 ZCKY5 ZCKY59 Spring metal rod lever (3)
For actuation by specific cam (for operation with ZCK-E096 head) Forked arm and rollers (2) thermoplastic
1 track 2 track ZCKY71 ZCKY61
Catalog number
XE2SP2151
Weight kg (lb)
0.020 (0.044)
ZCKY81
ZCKY91 1 N/C + 1 N/O break before make slow break 2 C/O simultaneous snap action
13 21
ZCKJ5 XE2NP2151 0.020 (0.044)
14 14
11
22
22
11
13
12
14
21
11
13
12
14
11
XESP201
1.
2. 3.
: Operating lever able to guarantee positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator, or N/C contact with positive opening operation. The positive opening feature requires additional travel past the trip point. See the contact function diagrams. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 45 steps by reversing the lever mounting or clamp. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps.
12
22
21
24
23
22
21
XE2SP211
XE2NP211
22
14
13
24
22
23
21
Limit Switches
13
23
21
ZCKJ2
XESP2021
12
14
ZCKY71
ZCKY61
24
22
0.045 (0.099)
ZCKJ4
XESP2031
0.045 (0.099)
ZCKJ6
XE2NP2161
0.020 (0.044)
ZCKJ7
XE2NP2141
0.020 (0.044)
ZCKJ8
XE2NP2131
0.020 (0.044)
ZCKJ9
XE2SP2141
0.020 (0.044)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
High-Temperature Applications (+248 F /+120 C) Body with contactsFor plunger or rotary head
Type Fixed body
2-pole 1 N/C + 1 N/O snap action (XE2SP2151) Double-pole 2 C/O simultaneous snap action (XESP20215) 2-pole 1 N/C + 1 N/O break before make slow break (XE2NP2151) 2-pole 1 N/O + 1 N/C make before break slow break (XE2NP2161) 2-pole 1 N/C + 1 N/C simultaneous slow break (XE2NP2141) 2-pole 1 N/O + 1 N/O simultaneous slow break (XE2NP2131) 2-pole 1 N/C + 1 N/C snap action (XE2SP2141) Double-pole 2 C/O break before make snap action (XESP20315)
Contact block
Function diagram
Cable entry
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
13
21
ZCKJ1 ZCKJ1H29 ZCKJ25 ZCKJ25H29 ZCKJ5 ZCKJ5H29 ZCKJ6 ZCKJ6H29 ZCKJ7 ZCKJ7H29 ZCKJ8 ZCKJ8H29 ZCKJ9 ZCKJ9H29 ZCKJ45 ZCKJ45H29
0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683) 0.310 (0.683)
14
11
22
13
23
21
1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5
12
14
13
21
14
1 step
11
22
13
12
14
ZCKJ15
11
12
11
22
21
24
23
22
21
14
13
22
21
24 23
13
21
22
ZCKJ
1 step
11 13 23 21
Double-pole 2 C/O simultaneous snap action Double-pole 2 C/O break before make snap action 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 ZCKJ215 ZCKJ215H29 ZCKJ415 ZCKJ415H29
14
12
ZCKJ115 ZCKJ115H29
0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661) 0.300 (0.661)
12
14
11
24
13
2 step
12
23
14
Body with contactsWith spring return rotary head (without operating lever)
Type Fixed body 2 step
1 from the left AND 1 from the right Double-pole 2 C/O break before make snap action 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 ZCKJ4045 ZCKJ4045H29 0.455 (1.003) 0.455 (1.003) 0.465 (1.025) 0.465 (1.025)
24
22
21
22
Contact block
Function diagram
Cable entry
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
13
12
11
14
Plug-in body
11 13 23 21
24
22
2 step
1 from the left AND 1 from the right
12
14
24
22
ZCKJ41045 ZCKJ41045H29
ZCKJ4045
1.
: Operating head able to guarantee positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator. The positive opening feature requires additional travel past the trip point. See the contact function diagrams.
Limit Switches
0.310 (0.683)
12
14
13
11
24
22
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
High-Temperature Applications (+248 F /+120 C) Plunger heads
Type of operator ZCKE615 ZCKE635 For actuation on end End plunger Side plunger For actuation by 30 cam End ball bearing plunger ZCKE665 ZCKE625 End roller plunger End reinforced roller plunger
Steel Steel ZCKJ1, J2, J4, ZCKJ115, J215, J415, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 ZCKJ1, J2, J4, ZCKJ115, J215, J415, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 ZCKJ1, J2, J4, ZCKJ115, J215, J415, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 ZCKJ1, J2, ZCKJ115, J215, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 ZCKJ1, J2, ZCKJ115, J215, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 ZCKJ1, J2, J4, ZCKJ115, J215, J415, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 ZCKJ1, J2, J4, ZCKJ115, J215, J415, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 0.1 m/s (0.33 ft/s) 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s) ZCKE665 0.150 (0.331) 0.155 (0.342) 0.155 (0.342) 0.205 (0.452) 0.205 (0.452) 0.195 (0.430) 0.185 (0.408) Metal ZCKJ1, J2, J4, ZCKJ115, J215, J415, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 ZCKJ1, J2, ZCKJ115, J215, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) ZCKE615 0.140 (0.309) 0.200 (0.441)
Compatible bodies
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
Metal
ZCKE635
ZCKE625
1 m/s (3.28 ft/s) 0.6 m/s (1.97 ft/s) 0.6 m/s (1.97 ft/s) 1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s)
ZCKE675
ZCKE645
ZCKE655
ZCKE235
ZCKE215
Compatible bodies
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
0.165 (0.364) 0.190 (0.419)
Limit Switches
ZCKE055
Stay put
actuation from left AND right (see page 408
ZCKE095
Multi-directional heads
Type of operator ZCKE055 ZCKE095 For actuation by any moving part Cats whisker Spring rod lever
1. ZCKJ1, J2, ZCKJ115, J215, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 ZCKJ1, J2, ZCKJ115, J215, ZCKJ5, J6, J7, J8, J9 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s) in any direction 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) in any direction ZCKE065 0.115 (0.254) 0.125 (0.276)
Compatible bodies
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
ZCKE085
: Operating head able to guarantee positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator. The positive opening feature requires additional travel past the trip point. See the contact function diagrams.
ZCKE065
ZCKE085
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in Bodies with 1/2" NPT Cable Entry
High-Temperature Applications (+248 F /+120 C) Operating levers for rotary heads
Description For actuation by 30 cam
Thermoplastic ZCKY115 ZCKY13 ZCKY14 ZCKY415 ZCKY43 ZCKY51 ZCKY53 ZCKY52 ZCKY715 ZCKY615 0.025 (0.055) 0.035 (0.077) 0.030 (0.066) 0.030 (0.066) 0.040 (0.088) 0.025 (0.055) 0.025 (0.055) 0.020 (0.044) 0.035 (0.077) 0.035 (0.077)
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
ZCKY1
ZCKY43
Thermoplastic Variable length roller lever (3) Steel For actuation by any moving part U 3 mm (0.12 in.) Steel, L = 125 mm (4.92 in.) Square rod (2)
3 mm (0.12 in.) steel, L = 125 mm (4.92 in.) 3 mm (0.12 in.) glass fibre, L = 125 mm (4.92 in.)
For actuation by specific cam (for operation with ZCK-E095 head only) 1 track Forked arm and rollers (2)
thermoplastic 2 track
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
1 N/C + 1 N/O break before make slow break 2 C/O simultaneous snap action 2 C/O staggered snap action 1 N/O + 1 N/C make before break slow break 1 N/C + 1 N/C simultaneous slow break 1 N/O + 1 N/O simultaneous slow break 1 N/C + 1 N/C snap action
1. 2. 3.
14
13
21
22
ZCKJ1
XE2SP2151
0.020 (0.044)
ZCKJ5
XE2NP2151
0.020 (0.044)
14
11
22
13
23
21
ZCKJ25
XESP20215
0.045 (0.099)
12
14
11
24 23
13
21
22
ZCKY715
ZCKY615
ZCKJ45
XESP20315
0.045 (0.099)
ZCKJ6
XE2NP2161
0.020 (0.044)
XE2SP211
XE2NP211
11
21
ZCKJ7
XE2NP2141
0.020 (0.044)
13
12
23
22
ZCKJ8
XE2NP2131
0.020 (0.044)
14
11
21
24
ZCKJ9
XE2SP2141
0.020 (0.044)
: Operating head able to guarantee positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator. The positive opening feature requires additional travel past the trip point. See the contact function diagrams. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 45 steps by reversing the lever mounting or clamp. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps.
12
22
XESP2015
Limit Switches
12
14
21
22
14
13
24
22
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in BodiesComponents
Contact blocks
Type of contact 2-pole contact N/C + N/O snap action N/C + N/O break before make, slow break 2 C/O simultaneous, snap action 2 C/O staggered, snap action N/O + N/C make before break, slow break N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break N/C + N/C snap action 3-pole contact
33 13 21
ZCKJ1 ZCKJ1D XE2SP2151 0.020 (0.044)
Function diagram
For bodies
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
14 13
21
22
14
11
22
ZCKJ5 ZCKJ5D
XE2NP2151
0.020 (0.044)
13
23
21
ZCKJ2
XESP2021
0.045 (0.099)
12
14
11
24 23
13
21
22
ZCKJ4
XESP2031
0.045 (0.099)
12
14
21
13
24
22
11
22
21
14
ZCKJ6 ZCKJ6D
XE2NP2161
0.020 (0.044)
13
12
23
22
ZCKJ7 ZCKJ7D
XE2NP2141
0.020 (0.044)
14
11
21
24
ZCKJ8 ZCKJ8D
XE2NP2131
0.020 (0.044)
ZCKJ9
XE2SP2141
0.020 (0.044)
12
22 13
34
32
31
32
22
31
32
22
1.
: N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
22
34
14
21
33
13
14
21
13
14
21
13
14
31
Limit Switches
ZCKJD31
XE3SP2151
0.035 (0.077)
ZCKJD39
XE3SP2141
0.035 (0.077)
ZCKJD37
XE3NP2141
0.035 (0.077)
ZCKJD35
XE3NP2151
0.035 (0.077)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in BodiesComponents
Covers + indicator light module
For use with Number and type of indicators
1 LED
Voltage
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
0.060 (0.132) 0.060 (0.132) 0.060 (0.132) 0.060 (0.132) 0.200 (0.441) 0.200 (0.441) 0.200 (0.441)
24 Vc
ZCKZ020
2 LEDs
24 Vc
ZCKZ021
2 LEDs
24 Vc
ZCKJ0121
110/120 Va
ZCKJ0133
220/240 Va
ZCKJ0134
Voltage
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
0.030 (0.066) 0.030 (0.066) 0.030 (0.066) 0.030 (0.066)
24 Vc
ZCKJ902
2 LEDs
24 Vc
ZCKJ906
15 k, 1/4 W Covers + indicator light module for other supply voltages. Please consult your local sales office.
ZCKJ82A
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in BodiesComponents
Function diagrams (positive operation assured only if the associated sub-assemblies are
ZCKJ1
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
)
ZCKJ7
3,4(P)
11-12 21-22 13-14 23-24
ZCKJ2
4,7(P) 6mm
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKJ5
2
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ6
3,4(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ8
2 0 0,9
2 6mm 0
0 0,9
3,2
6mm
6mm
6mm
ZCKJ9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKJD39
4,7(P) 6mm
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD37
4,7(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD31
2
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKJD35
4,7(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
2 0
2 0
0 0,9
0,9
6 mm
0,9
6mm
ZCKJ1
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKJ2
4(P) 5,5mm
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKJ5
1,5 2,9(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ6
2,7 4,1(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ7
2,9(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ8
21-22 13-14
1,5 0 0,9
2,7 5,5mm
0 1,5
5,5mm
0 1,5
5,5mm
0 1,5
5,5mm
ZCKJ9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKJD39
4(P) 5,5mm
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD37
4(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKJD35
4(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
1,5 0 0,9
1,5
1,5
0,9
5,5mm
0 0,9
5,5mm
ZCKJ1
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKJ2
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-24/23-24
ZCKJ5
2,6(A) 2,6(A) 4,7(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ6
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ7
4,7(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ8
21-22 13-14
0 0 1,5 mm
4,6 mm
2,6(A) mm
2,6(A) mm
ZCKJ9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKJD39
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD37
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKJD35
2,6(A) 4,7(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
2,6(A) 6,4(P)
4,6 mm
1,5
mm
ZCKJ1
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKJ2
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKJ5
3,2(A)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ6
5,3(A)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ7
8(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKJ8
13-14 23-24
3,2(A) 8,1(P) mm 0
3,2(A)
mm
1,5
1,5
ZCKJ9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKJD39
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD37
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKJD35
21-22 33-34 13-14
11
13
23
21
13
11
23
21
11
21
ZCKJ4
12
14
24
22
12
14
24
22
12
14
Contact operation
24
22
3,5
13
23
Limit Switches
3,2
8,1(P) 0
3,2(A) 8,1(P)
1,5
mm
1,5
mm
ZCKJ1
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKJ2
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKJ5
5(A)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ6
8,(A) 11,5(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ7
8,5(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ8
mm
21-22 13-14
5(A) 8,5(P) 0 8 mm 0
5(A)
mm
5(A)
5(A)
mm
2,2
mm
ZCKJ9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKJD39
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD37
5(A) 8,5(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKJD35
11,5(P) 5(A) 8,5(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
5(A) 11,5(P) 0 mm
5(A)
11,5(P) 0
5(A)
mm
0 2,2 mm
mm
2,2
2,2
mm
ZCKJ1
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKJ2
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKJ5
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ6
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ7
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ8
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKJD39
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD37
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKJD35
21-22 33-34 13-14
Unactuated
1st step
2nd step
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in BodiesComponents
Function diagrams (positive operation assured only if the associated sub-assemblies are
Head ZCKE05 with body ZCKJ1 ZCKJ2
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
)
ZCKJ8
13-14 23-24
ZCKJ5
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ6
21-22 13-14
ZCKJ7
11-12 21-22
ZCKJ9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKJD39
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD37
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKJD39
21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKJD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKJ4 Unactuated
11 21 13 23
12
22
12
14
24
14
24
22
ZCKJD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKJD39
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
0
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
12
22
12
14
24
14
Contact operation
Wiring diagrams
+
21 13 13
+
13 13 15 k 1/4 W
X3
X3
X2
(1)
X1
(1)
(2)
X1
(1)
X1
X2
X3
(2)
ZCKJD
2 3 4
13 21
12= N/C 34= N/O 5= t 4 A / 24 V max.
14
22
Limit Switches
24
22
14
14
14
22
14
14
12
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in BodiesComponents
Bodies
Non-plug-in ZCKJ1, J2, J5, J4, J2, J3, J6, J7, J8, J9 ZCKJ1H29, J2H29, J5H29, J4H29, J2H29, J3H29, J6H29, J7H29, J8H29, J9H29 Plug-in ZCKJ11, J21, J41, J11 ZCKJ11H29, J21H29, J41H29, J11H29 Non-plug-in ZCKJ1D, J5D, J6D, J7D, J8D
6,5
6,5
83,5
76,5
60
60
76,5
(1)
33,5 44 = 30 40 =
(1)
36
30 42,5
=
33,5 44
12
30 40
10
M6
M6
102
22
109
(1)
33,5 44 60 = 30 40 =
60
(1)
36 60
30 42,5
Plunger heads
ZCKE61 ZCKE619 ZCKE63
60
22
10
37
ZCKE64
ZCKE65
49,5
ZCKE66
10
63,6 5
63,6 10 5
17
20
ZCKE62, ZCKE67
ZCKE629
20
ZCKE21, E23
17 5 5
17
17 7 19
50
50
41 61
20
10
17
17
52,3
60 =
6,5
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Metal, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKJModular, Fixed Non-plug-in or Plug-in BodiesComponents
Rotary head ZCKE05 with operating lever
ZCKY11, Y13, Y14 ZCKY41, Y43 ZCKY51, Y52, Y53, Y59
62 57 5 41
57 52 44
59 J1 J
4085
63
5,5
62107
41
J1
49 49 49 48
K K1 max
137 137 137 212 123 125 125 200
K1
U3 3 3 6
53
53
92
114
157
68 56 5
56 15 5
68
56
Multi-directional heads
ZCKE06 ZCKE08
17
17
155
141
Limit Switches
15
63
63
179
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Plastic, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKSDouble Insulated
b XCKS fixed, non-plug-in body with 1 cable entry
v With head for linear movement (plunger) operators
561656
Page 514
561658
561659
561657
561660
Page 514
Environmental characteristics
Conforming to standards Approvals Protective treatment Ambient air temperature Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Repeat accuracy Cable entry Materials Products Machine assemblies Version For operation For storage Conforming to IEC 60068-2-6 Conforming to IEC 60068-2-27
IEC 60947-5-1, EN 60947-5-1, UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 IEC 60204-1, EN 60204-1 UL, CSA, CCC Standard TC and TH - 25+70 C (-13+158 F) - 40+70 C (-40+158 F) 25 gn (10500 Hz) 50 gn (11 ms) Class II conforming to IEC 61140 and NF C 20-030 IP 65 conforming to IEC 60529; IK 03 conforming to EN 50102 0.05 mm on the tripping points, with 1 million operating cycles for head with end plunger
Depending on model
Tapped entry for PG 13 conduit thread, or tapped ISO M20 x 1.5, 1/2" NPT with adapter Body and heads: plastic
561661
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Plastic, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKSDouble Insulated
Contact block characteristics
Rated operational characteristics XE2P XE3P XE2P Rated insulation voltage XE3P Rated impulse withstand voltage XE2P XE3P
a AC-15; A300 (Ue = 240 V, Ie = 3 A); Ithe = 10 A c DC-13; Q300 (Ue = 250 V, Ie = 0,27 A), conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix A, EN 60947-5-1 a AC-15; B300 (Ue = 240 V, Ie = 1,5 A); Ithe = 6 A c DC-13; R300 (Ue = 250 V, Ie = 0,1 A), conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix A, EN 60947-5-1 Ui = 500 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-1 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 Ui = 400 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-1 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 U imp = 6 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 U imp = 4 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 N/C contacts with positive opening operation conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix K, EN 60947-5-1 y 25 m conforming to IEC 60255-7 category 3 10 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl) 6 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl) Clamping capacity, min.: 1 x 0.34 mm2, max.: 2 x 1.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min.: 1 x 0.5 mm2, max.: 2 x 2.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min.: 1 x 0.75 mm2, max.: 2 x 1.5 mm2 Clamping capacity, min.: 1 x 0.34 mm2, max.: 1 x 1 mm2 or 2 x 0.75 mm2 XE2SP211, XESP3021 and XE3SP: 0.01 m/minute (0.03 ft/minute) XE2NP211 and XE3NP: 6 m/minute (19.68 ft/minute)
Positive operation (depending on model) Resistance across terminals Short-circuit protection Cabling (screw and captive cable clamp terminals) Minimum actuation speed XE2P XE3P XE2SP211 XE2NP211 XESP3021 XE3NP and XE3SP
Conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix C Utilization categories AC-15 and DC-13 Maximum operating rate: 3600 operating cycles per hour Load factor: 0.5 XE2NP211 XESP3021
Millions of operating cycles
Ithe
5 4 3 2 1 0,5
5 4 3 2 1 0,5
1 0,5
110 V 230/400 V
24 V 48 V
0,1 0,5
10 3 4 5 Current in A
3 4 5 10 Current in A
0,1 0,5
110 V
1 2 10 3 4 5 Current in A
d.c. supply c
For XE2SP151 on a or c, N/C and N/O contacts simultaneously loaded to the values shown with reverse polarity. XE3SP XE3NP
Millions of operating cycles
Ithe
5 4 3 2
Ithe
230 V
1 0,5
12/24/48 V 110 V
24 V 48 V
3 4 5 10 Current in A
d.c. supply c
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Plastic, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKSDouble Insulated, Complete Switches with 1/2" NPT Adapter Included
Type of head Plunger (mounting by the body) Form B (1) Form C (1) Rotary (mounting by the body) Form A (1) Form D (1)
Type of operator
Elastomer roller Thermoplastic roller lever, 50 mm lever (4) (1.97 in.) (4)
Variable length Round thermoplastic elastomer roller lever, rod lever, 6 mm 50 mm (1.97 in.) (4) (0.24 in.) (5) (6)
XCKS102
4,5(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKS131
7,8(P)
XCKS139
58(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKS141
23
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKS149
23
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCKS159
23
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
13
21
3,1(A)
23
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
23
14
22
0 0,9
5,5 mm
0 1,5
mm
0 11
80
0 11
80
0 11
80
0 11
80
0 11
80
2-pole N/C + N/O XCKS501 break before make, slow 1,8 3,2(P) 21-22 break 13-14 0 3 5,5 (XE2NP2151) mm ZCKS9 + 2-pole N/C + N/C ZCKD01 snap action (XE2SP2141) 1,8
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
13
21
XCKS502
3,1(A)
21-22 13-14
XCKS531
5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
XCKS539
23
21-22 13-14
XCKS541
23
21-22 13-14
XCKS549
23
21-22 13-14
XCKS559
23
21-22 13-14
14
22
23 0
42(P) 33 80
5,2
mm
33
80
33
80
33
80
33
80
11
21
ZCKS9 + ZCKD02
4,5(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKS9 + ZCKD31
7,8(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKS9 + ZCKD39
58(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKS9 + ZCKD41
23
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKS9 + ZCKD49
23
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKS9 + ZCKD59
23
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
12
22
3,1(A)
23
23
0 0,9
5,5 mm
0 1,5
mm
0 11
80
0 11
80
0 11
80
0 11
80
0 11
80
ZCKS7 + 2-pole N/C + N/C ZCKD01 simultaneous, slow break 3,2(P) (XE2NP2141) 11-12
21-22
11
12
22
21
ZCKS7 + ZCKD02
5,6(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKS7 + ZCKD31
42(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKS7 + ZCKD39
ZCKS7 + ZCKD41
ZCKS7 + ZCKD49
ZCKS7 + ZCKD59
1,8
5,5 mm
3,1(A)
11-12 21-22
11-12 21-22
11-12 21-22
11-12 21-22
23
80
23
80
23
80
23
80
23
80
31
21
13
ZCKSD39 + ZCKD01
1,8
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD39 + ZCKD02
3,1(A)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD39 + ZCKD31
23
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD39 + ZCKD39
23
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD39 + ZCKD41
23
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD39 + ZCKD49
23
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD39 + ZCKD59
23
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
32
22
14
Limit Switches
32
22
14
4,5(P)
7,8(P)
58(P)
0 0,9
5,5 mm
0 1,5
mm
0 11
80
0 11
80
0 11
80
0 11
80
0 11
80
3-pole N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141) Weight, kg (lb)
31 21 13
ZCKSD37 + ZCKD01
1,8
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37 + ZCKD02
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37 + ZCKD31
23
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37 + ZCKD39
23
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37 + ZCKD41
23
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37 + ZCKD49
23
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37 + ZCKD59
23
21-22 31-32 13-14
3,2(P) 3 5,5 mm
42(P) 33 80 0
5,2
mm
33
80
33
80
33
80
33
80
0.105 (0.231)
0.145 (0.320)
0.150 (0.331)
0.155 (0.342)
0.155 (0.342)
0.150 (0.331)
Contact operation
contact closed
N/C contact with positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator
Characteristics
Switch actuation Type of actuation Maximum actuation speed Minimum For tripping force or For positive torque opening Cable entry (3)
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 15 N (3.37 lb) 45 N (10.12 lb) 12 N (2.70 lb) 36 N (8.09 lb) 1.5 m/s (4.92 ft/s) 0.15 Nm (1.33 lb-in) 0.3 Nm (2.66 lb-in) 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s) By 30 cam By any moving part
1 entry tapped M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry, clamping capacity 7 to 13 mm (0.28 to 0.51 in.) Form conforming to EN 50041. See page 409. Switches with gold contacts or eyelet type connections: please consult your local sales office. To convert PG 13 to 1/2" NPT, use adapter DE9RA1212. For ISO M20 x 1.5, add H29 to the end of the catalog number. Example: XCKS101 becomes XCKS101H29. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 90 steps by reversing the notched washer. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 45 steps by reversing the lever mounting. Value taken with actuation by moving part at 100 mm (3.94 in.) from the mounting.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Plastic, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKSDouble Insulated, Complete Switches with 1/2" NPT Adapter Included
XCKS01 ZCKS + ZCKD01 XCKS02 ZCKS + ZCKD02 XCKS31 ZCKS + ZCKD31
16 4 16
49,5
36,5
103
60
116
60
(1) 29,5 36
XCKS39 ZCKS + ZCKD39
(1) = 30 40 = 29,5 36
XCKS41 ZCKS + ZCKD41
30 40
58
57 10 54,5 6
53 45
10
45...99,5 = 30 40 =
51,5...106
117...172
132,5...187,5
142,5
60
60
(1) 29,5 65
XCKS59 ZCKS + ZCKD59
(1) = 30 40 = 29,5 57 = 30 40 =
(1) 29,5 57
60
67...121,5
29,5...84
76,5
60
63
48,5
24
(3)
(2)
98...280
(1) 29,5 57
1.
30 40
1 tapped entry for PG 13 conduit thread (convertible to 1/2" NPT using adapter DE9RA1212, included); or 1 tapped entry for ISO M20 x 1.5 conduit thread (with suffix H29 added to the catalog number). 2. Rod 6 mm (0.24 in.), length 200 mm (7.87 in.) 3. 190 max. 4. 212 max. : 2 elongated holes 5.3 x 7.3.
60
(4)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Plastic, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKSDouble Insulated, Modular
Dimensions: mm (in.)
Limit Switches
1. 2. 3.
Spring rod
Cats whisker
ZCK D08
ZCK D06
For further details, see page 518. For a cable entry tapped ISO M20 x 1.5, add H29 to the catalog number. Example: ZCKS1 becomes ZCKS1H29. To convert PG 13 to 1/2" NPT, use adapter DE9RA1212. See page 521 for dimensional drawing. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 90 steps by reversing the notched washer. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 45 steps by reversing the lever mounting.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Plastic, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKSDouble Insulated, Modular
Dimensions: mm (in.)
ZCK Y54
ZCK Y55
ZCK Y59
ZCK Y39
ZCK D05
Body with double-pole 2 C/O staggered, snap action contact cable entry for PG 13 2 step, 1 from left and 1 from right (1)
ZCK S404
For further details, see page 518. For a cable entry tapped ISO M20 x 1.5, add H29 to the catalog number. Example: ZCKS1 becomes ZCKS1H29. To convert PG 13 to 1/2" NPT, use adapter DE9RA1212. : N/C contact with positive opening operation or head assuring positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator. 2. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 90 steps by reversing the notched washer. 3. Adjustable throughout 360 in 5 steps, or in 45 steps by reversing the lever mounting. 1.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Plastic, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKSDouble Insulated, Modular
Bodies with 2-pole contact
Type With contact block
N/C + N/O snap action (XE2SP2151) 2 C/O simultaneous, snap action (XESP3021) N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE2NP2151) N/O + N/C make before make, slow break (XE2NP2161) N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2141) N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break (XE2NP2131) N/C + N/C snap action (XE2SP2141)
Function diagram
13 21
Cable entry
1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5
Catalog number
ZCKS1 ZCKS1H29 ZCKS2 ZCKS2H29 ZCKS5 ZCKS5H29 ZCKS6 ZCKS6H29 ZCKS7 ZCKS7H29 ZCKS8 ZCKS8H29 ZCKS9 ZCKS9H29
Weight kg (lb)
0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176)
14
11
22
13
23
21
1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5
12
14
13
21
14
1 step
11
22
12
13
14
11
12
22
21
24
23
22
21
14
13
22
21
24
22
Function diagram
11 13 23 21
Cable entry
1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5
Catalog number
ZCKS404 ZCKS404H29
Weight kg (lb)
0.150 (0.331) 0.150 (0.331)
33
31
13
34
32
14
31
21
13
1 step
N/C + N/C + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2141) N/C + N/O + N/O break before make, slow break (XE3NP2151) 1.
32
22
14
31
21
13
32
22
14
21
33
13
: N/C contact with positive opening operation or head assuring positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
22
34
14
Limit Switches
12
14
24
22
Function diagram
Cable entry
1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5 1/2" NPT ISO M20 x 1.5
Catalog number
ZCKSD31 ZCKSD31H29 ZCKSD39 ZCKSD39H29 ZCKSD37 ZCKSD37H29 ZCKSD35 ZCKSD35H29
Weight kg (lb)
0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176) 0.080 (0.176)
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Plastic, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKSDouble Insulated, Modular
Contact blocks
Type of contact 2-pole contact N/C + N/O snap action N/C + N/O break before make, slow break 2 C/O simultaneous, snap action N/O + N/C make before break, slow break N/C + N/C simultaneous, slow break N/O + N/O simultaneous, slow break N/C + N/C snap action 3-pole contact
33 13 21
ZCKS1 XE2SP2151 0.020 (0.044)
Function diagram
For body
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
14 13
21
22
ZCKS5
XE2NP2151
14
11
22
0.020 (0.044)
13
23
21
ZCKS2
XESP3021
12
14
21
13
24
22
0.045 (0.099)
ZCKS6
XE2NP2161
11
22
21
14
0.020 (0.044)
ZCKS7
XE2NP2141
13
12
23
22
0.020 (0.044)
ZCKS8
XE2NP2131
14
11
21
24
0.020 (0.044)
ZCKS9
XE2SP2141
12
22
0.020 (0.044)
34
32
31
21
13
14
31
13
ZCKSD31
XE3SP2151
0.035 (0.077)
32
22
31
32
22
Other versions
1.
: N/C contact with positive opening operation or sub-assembly assuring positive opening operation, when properly mounted and using a conforming operator.
22
34
14
21
33
13
14
21
13
14
ZCKSD39
XE3SP2141
0.035 (0.077)
ZCKSD37
XE3NP2141
0.035 (0.077)
ZCKSD35
XE3NP2151
0.035 (0.077)
Catalog number
DE9RA1212
Weight kg (lb)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Plastic, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKSDouble Insulated, Modular
ZCKS1
1,8
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKS2
4,5(P)
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKS5
1,8
21-22 13-14
ZCKS6
3 4,4(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKS7
3,2(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKS8
13-14 23-24
5,5mm
5,5mm
0,9
5,5mm
0,9
5,5mm
ZCKS9
1,8
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKSD39
4,5(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37
4,5(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKSD35
4,5(P) 1,8 3,2(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
1,8
1,8
0,9
5,5mm
0 5,5mm
3 5,5mm
0 0,9
5,5mm
0 0,9
ZCKS1
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKS2
3,1(A)
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKS5
3,1(A) 5,6(P)
21-22 13-14
ZCKS6
5,2(A)
21-22 13-14
ZCKS7
7,6(P) mm 5,6(P)
11-12 21-22
ZCKS8
13-14 23-24
0 1,5 mm
5,2 mm
3,1
1,5
mm
ZCKS9
3,1(A) 7,8(P)
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKSD39
3,1
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37
7,8(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKSD35
7,8(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
3,1
1,5
mm
1,5
5,5mm
1,5
mm
ZCKS1
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKS2
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKS5
21-22 13-14
ZCKS6
21-22 13-14
ZCKS7
11-12 21-22
ZCKS8
13-14 23-24
ZCKS9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKSD39
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37
58(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKSD35
58(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
23
23 42(P) 0 33 80
23
23 42(P) 0 33 80
11
80
11
80
ZCKS1
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKS2
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKS5
21-22 13-14
ZCKS6
21-22 13-14
ZCKS7
11-12 21-22
ZCKS8
13-14 23-24
Heads ZCKD39, D41, D49, D54, D55, D59, D81, D91 with body
ZCKS9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKSD39
23
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37
23
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKSD35
23
21-22 33-34 13-14
11
21
11
21
11
13
23
13
23
13
22
12
22
12
23
14
12
24
14
24
14
Contact operation
G contact closed
H contact open
24
22
21
Limit Switches
23 0 11 80
0 80
33 80
33 80
0 11
ZCKS1 Heads ZCKD05 (positive operation only assured with a operating lever) with body
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKS2
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKS5
21-22 13-14
ZCKS6
21-22 13-14
ZCKS7
11-12 21-22
ZCKS8
13-14 23-24
ZCKS9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKSD39
23
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37
58(P)
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKSD35
58(P)
21-22 33-34 13-14
23 42(P) 0 33 80
23
23 42(P) 0 33 80
0 11
80
11
80
ZCKS1
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
ZCKS2
11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24 11-12/21-22 13-14/23-24
ZCKS5
21-22 13-14
ZCKS6
21-22 13-14
ZCKS7
11-12 21-22
ZCKS8
13-14 23-24
ZCKS9
11-12 21-22 11-12 21-22
ZCKSD39
30
21-22 31-32 13-14 21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD37
30
21-22 31-32 13-14
ZCKSD31
21-22 33-34 13-14 21-22 33-34 13-14
ZCKSD35
30
21-22 33-34 13-14
30 0 14
0 14 80
40
80
40
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, Plastic, Conforming to CENELEC EN 50041
XCKSDouble Insulated, Modular
Plunger heads ZCKD01
ZCKD019
ZCKD02
ZCKD029
16
ZCKD39
ZCKD41
ZCKD49
55 6 39
57 10 6
53 45 29,5...84 51,5...106
57 10
41
54,5 76,5
60 65 58 65
ZCKD54, D55, D59 ZCKD81 ZCKD91
(4)
(5)
53
53
(1)
(2) (3)
113,5
179
45...99,5 67...121,5
63
49,5
57
ZCK D54 D55 D59 (1) rod
U 3, L = 125 3, L = 125 6, L = 200
(2)
115 max. 115 max. 190 max.
(3)
137 max. 137 max. 212 max.
(4)
49 49 46.5
(5)
24 24 26.2
NOTE: operating lever spindle threaded M6. Bodies with contacts ZCKS1, S2, S5, S6, S7, S8, S9 ZCKS1H29, S2H29, S5H29, S6H29, S7H29, S8H29, S9H29 ZCKSD3, SD3H29
ZCKS404, S404H29
6,5
16
16 72,5
M6 10 32
60
144
131
(1)
29,5 36 = 30 40 = 29,5 57 =
2x5,3
30 40
(1) 25.4
21.3
(2) 20.4
1.
1 tapped entry for PG 13 conduit thread (convertible to 1/2" NPT using adapter DE9RA1212); or 1 tapped entry for ISO M20 x 1.5 conduit thread (with suffix H29 added to the catalog number). : 2 elongated holes 5.3 x 7.3.
1. 2.
60
(1)
2x5,8
98,5
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Hoisting, Mechanical Handling, and Conveyer Belt Shift Monitoring
XCR and XCRT
b XCR
v With head for rotary movement operators, spring return to off position 1 contact actuation position per direction
562249
Page 524 v With head for rotary movement operators, stay put 1 contact actuation position per direction
Page 524
b XCRT
v With head for rotary movement operators, spring return to off position 2 contact actuation positions per direction 1 actuated at 10, other contact actuated at 18
562252
500779_1
562248
Page 526
562253
562250
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Hoisting, Mechanical Handling, and Conveyer Belt Shift Monitoring
XCR and XCRT
Environmental characteristics
Conforming to standards Product certifications Protective treatment Ambient air temperature Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Enclosure Cable entry Products Machine assemblies Standard version Special version Standard version
IEC/EN 60947-5-1, VDE 0660-200 (CSA C22-2 n 14 for XCR), CCC (for XCR) IEC/EN 60204-1, NF C 79-130 XCRA, B, E, F: CSA A300 XCRA, B, E, F: CSA A300, 1/2" NPT TC Operation: -25+70 C (-13+158 F); Storage: -40+70 C (-40+158 F) 9 gn (10500 Hz) XCRA, B, E, F: 68 gn; XCRT: 30 gn (18 ms) Class I conforming to IEC 60536 and NF C 20-030 XCRA, B, E, F: IP 54 conforming to IEC 60529; IP 545 conforming to NF C 20-010 XCRT: IP 65 conforming to IEC 60529; IP 655 conforming to NF C 20-010 Metal, except XCRT315: polyester Tapped entry for PG 13 (PG 13.5) conduit thread a AC-15; A300 (Ue = 240 V, Ie = 3 A) c DC-13; Q300 (Ue = 250 V, Ie = 0.27 A), conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix A, EN 60947-5-1 Ui = 500 V degree of pollution 3 conforming to IEC 60947-1 and VDE 0110, group C conforming to NF C 20-040 Ui = 300 V conforming to UL 508, CSA C22-2 n 14 U imp = 6 kV conforming to IEC 60947-1, IEC 60664 N/C contacts with positive opening operation to IEC 60947-5-1 Section 3, EN 60947-5-1 25 m conforming to NF C 93-050 method A or IEC 60255-7 category 3 10 A cartridge fuse type gG (gl) XE2SP2151: Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.34 mm2, max: 2 x 1.5 mm2 XE2NP2151: Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.5 mm2, max: 2 x 2.5 mm2 XCRT contacts: Clamping capacity, min: 1 x 0.5 mm2, max: 2 x 2.5 mm2 XE2SP2151 and XCRT contacts: 0.01 m/minute (0.03 ft/minute), XE2NP2151: 6 m/minute (19.68 ft/minute) Conforming to IEC 60947-5-1 Appendix C Utilization categories AC-15 and DC-13 Maximum operating rate: 3600 operating cycles per hour Load factor: 0.5
XE2SP2151
Millions of operating cycles
XE2NP2151
Millions of operating cycles
Ithe
5 4 3 2 1 0,5
1 0,5
110 V 230/400 V
24 V 48 V
0,1 0,5
10 3 4 5 Current in A
3 4 5 10 Current in A
XCRT contacts
Millions of operating cycles
5 4 3 2 1 0,5
0,1 0,5
d.c. supply c
110 V
1 2 10 3 4 5 Current in A
Voltage 24 V 48 V 120 V XE2SP2151 10 7 4 Power switched in W for 5 million XE2NP2151 13 9 7 operating cycles W XCRT contacts 10 7 4 For XE2SP2151 on a or c N/C and N/O contacts simultaneously loaded to the values shown with reverse polarity.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Hoisting and Material Handling
XCRComplete Switches with One Cable Entry
Type of head Rotary with spring return to off position Stay put
Both contacts operate in each direction Two 2-pole 1 N/C + 1 N/O snap action XE2SP2151
21 12 13 21
XCRA12
30 (P) 0 30 (P) 16 16 55
XCRA15
30 (P) 0 30 (P) 16 16 55
XCRE18
75 (P) 75 (P) 0 90 65 65
55
(1) (2)
5 5
55
(1) (2)
5 5
55
(1) (2)
5 5
90
(1) (2)
25
15 (P)
25
22
14
1st contact
14
2nd contact
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
22
XCRB11
34 (P) 34 (P) 0 20 20 55
XCRB12
34 (P) 34 (P) 0 20 20 55
XCRB15
34 (P) 34 (P) 0 20 20 55
XCRF17
75 (P) 0 75 (P) 65 65 90
55
(1) (2)
5 5
55
(1) (2)
5 5
55
(1) (2)
5 5
90
(1) (2)
35 35
Both contacts operate in each direction Two 2-pole 1 N/C + 1 N/O break before make, slow break XE2NP2151
XCRA51
0
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
XCRA52
0
XCRA55
0
XCRE58
0
(1) (2)
(1) (2)
(1) (2)
(1) (2)
Limit Switches
12
21
13
21
1st contact
14
22
14
2nd contact
21-22 13-14 21-22 13-14
22
XCRB51
0
XCRB52
0
XCRB55
0
XCRF57
0
(1) (2)
(1) (2)
(1) (2)
(1) (2)
1.145
1.155
1 entry tapped for PG 13 conduit thread conforming to NF C 68-300 (DIN PG 13.5). Clamping capacity 9 to 12 mm (0.35 to 0.47 in.). 1/2" NPT with adapter DE9RA1212.
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Hoisting and Material Handling
XCRComplete Switches with One Cable Entry
Separate components
Description For switches
XCRA XCRB XCRA XCRB XCRA XCRB XCRA, XCRB XCRE, XCRF
Type
L = 200 mm (7.87 in.) L = 300 mm (11.81 in.)
Catalog number
XCRZ03 XCRZ04 XCRZ02
Weight kg (lb)
0.020 (0.044) 0.030 (0.066) 0.050 (0.110)
XCRZ05
0.090 (0.198)
XCRZ02
XCRZ05
XCRZ09
0.520 (1.146)
XCRZ12
0.135 (0.298)
XCRZ15
0.135 (0.298)
Description
Application
PG 13.5 to ISO M20 x 1.5 PG 13.5 to 1/2" NPT
Sold in lots of
Weight kg (lb)
0.050 (0.110)
Adapter
XCRZ09
XCRZ1
Adapter
DE9RA1212
0.050 (0.110)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Conveyer Belt Shift Monitoring
XCRTComplete Switches with One Cable Entry and 1/2" NPT Adapter Included
Type of switch Standard For corrosive atmospheres
Features
Zinc alloy enclosure Color: industrial blue Zinc plated steel lever, spring return to off position Cam angles: 10 and 18 Maximum displacement: 90
Zinc alloy enclosure Color: blue Stainless steel lever, spring return to off position Cam angles: 10 and 18 Maximum displacement: 90
Glass reinforced polyester enclosure Color: grey Stainless steel lever, spring return to off position Cam angles: 10 and 18 Maximum displacement: 70
XCRT115
90 10
11-12 13-14 11-12 13-14
XCRT215
10 90 4 90 10
11-12 13-14 11-12 13-14
XCRT315
10 90 4 70 10
11-12 13-14 11-12 13-14
10 70 4
14
12
4
1st contact
13
11
14
12
90 18 4
18 90 4
90 18 4
18 90 4
70 18 4
18 70 4
2nd contact
1.170 (2.579)
1.520 (3.351)
Limit Switches
Switch operation
Normal position Fault signalling Stopping of the conveyor belt Maximum rotation
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Conveyer Belt Shift Monitoring
XCRTComplete Switches with One Cable Entry and 1/2" NPT Adapter Included
Separate components
Description Type For switches
XCRT115 XCRT215 XCRT115 XCRT215 XCRT315
Catalog number
XCRZ901
Weight kg (lb)
0.230 (0.507)
XCRZ9
XCRZ42
0.135 (0.298)
Description
Application
PG 13.5 to ISO M20 x 1.5 PG 13.5 to 1/2" NPT
Sold in lots of
5
Weight kg (lb)
0.050 (0.110)
Adapter
Adapter
DE9RA1212
0.050 (0.110)
XCRZ09
XCRZ42
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Hoisting, Mechanical Handling, and Conveyer Belt Shift Monitoring
XCR and XCRT
XCRA11, B11, A51, B51 XCRA12, B12, A52, B52
66 9
6
7260
(2)
(3)
=
18
95
85
18
75
4
XCRA15, B15, A55, B55
75
75 85
68 9
66
6
(2)
78 102
= =
= 32 = 53
(1) = 75 85
= 32 = 53
95
(1)
85 18
18
95
85
= 32 = 53 75
1. 2. 3. 4.
(1) = 75 85
= 32 = 53 75
95
(1) = 75 85 =
1 tapped entry for PG 13 conduit thread. Rod length: 200 mm (7.87 in.). Rod + roller length: 160 mm (6.30 in.). Rod length: 300 mm (11.81 in.) for XCRF17 and F57, 200 mm (7.87 in.) for XCR E18 and E58.
Supplementary mounting using 2 adjustable lugs (included with switch) Horizontally positioned Vertically positioned
127
53
36 = = = =
95 11 10 = 117 50 50 10 = 140 85
= 11
=
107
100
: 1 elongated hole 6 x 8.
137
95
85
(4)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Hoisting, Mechanical Handling, and Conveyer Belt Shift Monitoring
XCR and XCRT
XCRT115, T215
66
80
(2)
(2)
(1)
18
= 32 = 53 75
XCRT315
95
(3) = 75 85
107
80
(4)
= = (4)
188
85
83 87
1. 2. 200 max., 83 min. 90 max. 3. 4.
(5) 85
1 tapped entry for PG 13 conduit thread. 70 max. 5.
70
Supplementary mounting using 2 adjustable lugs (included with XCRT115 and T215) Horizontally positioned Vertically positioned
127 53 11 = = 5 = 107 =
36 = = =
95 11 10
117
100
95
137
: 1 elongated hole 6 x 8.
50
50
10
140
85
Limit Switches
54
146
105
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Material Handling
XC1AC
b XC1AC with slow break contacts
v With head for linear movement (plunger)
500769_1
Page 532
500768_1
Page 532
500771_1
500772_1
500770_1
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Material Handling
XC1AC
Environmental characteristics
Conformity to standards Product certifications Protective treatment Ambient air temperature Operating position Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Mechanical durability Cable entry
IEC/EN 60947-5-1, IEC 60337-1, VDE 0660-200, CSA C22-2 n 14
CSA 600 V (ac) HD Standard TC, special TH - 25+70 C (-13+158 F) - 40+70 C (-40+158 F) All positions 9 gn (10500 Hz) conforming to IEC 60068-2-6 95 gn (11 ms) conforming to IEC 60068-2-27 Class I conforming to IEC 60536 and NF C 20-030 IP 65 conforming to IEC 60529 and NF C 20-010 10 million operating cycles 3 tapped entries for PG 13 conduit thread
Power switched in W
Voltage V For 1 million operating cycles For 3 million operating cycles
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Material Handling
XC1ACComplete Switches with Slow-Break Contacts and 1/2" NPT Adapter Included
Type of head Plunger
Type of operator
End plunger
Roller lever
XC1AC111
2,1
11-12 13-14
XC1AC115
9
11-12 13-14
XC1AC116
9
11-12 13-14
XC1AC118
12
11-12 13-14
XC1AC117
12
11-12 13-14
XC1AC119
1,6
11-12 13-14
2,1 5,6
2,3 7,3
2,3 7,3
1,6 6,2
11,5 mm
11,5 6,2 mm
5,6
mm
mm
mm
mm
12
14
XC1AC121
6 7,5
11-12 13-14
XC1AC125
6 7,5
11-12 13-14
XC1AC126
7 11,5
11-12 13-14
XC1AC128
7 11,5
11-12 13-14
XC1AC127
5,2 11,5
11-12 13-14
XC1AC129
5,2 11,5
11-12 13-14
6,8 mm
6,8 mm
mm
mm
6,8
mm
6,8
mm
12
14
XC1AC131
3,5
11-12 13-14
XC1AC135
8
11-12 13-14
XC1AC136
8
11-12 13-14
XC1AC138
4,5 10,5
11-12 13-14
XC1AC137
4,4
11-12 13-14
XC1AC139
4,4
11-12 13-14
3,5 4,8
4,5 10,5 7 mm
11,5 mm
11,5 mm
4,8
mm
mm
mm
6,5
6,5
12
14
XC1AC141
4,3
11-12 21-22
XC1AC145
4,3
11-12 21-22
XC1AC146
5,5
11-12 21-22
XC1AC148
12
11-12 21-22
XC1AC147
12
11-12 21-22
XC1AC149
5
11-12 21-22
9,3 mm
9,3 mm
5,5
12,5 mm
12,5 mm
mm
mm
12
22
XC1AC151
5,6 9
13-14 23-24
XC1AC155
5,6 9
13-14 23-24
XC1AC156
7,2 11,5
13-14 23-24
XC1AC158
7,2 11,5
13-14 23-24
XC1AC157
7 11,5
13-14 23-24
XC1AC159
7 11,5
13-14 23-24
13
23
14
24
Limit Switches
mm
mm
mm
mm
mm
mm
14
24
XC1AC161
3,7
11-12 21-22
XC1AC165
9
11-12 21-22
XC1AC166
9
11-12 21-22
XC1AC168
12
11-12 21-22
XC1AC167
4
11-12 21-22
XC1AC169
12
11-12 21-22
3,7 4,9
4,5 6,2
4,5 6,2
12 mm
4 5,5
12 mm
4,9
mm
mm
mm
5,5
mm
12
22
XC1AC171
4,8 8,5
13-14 23-24
XC1AC175
4,8 8,5
13-14 23-24
XC1AC176
5,8
13-14 23-24
XC1AC178
5,8
13-14 23-24
XC1AC177
6
13-14 23-24
XC1AC179
12
13-14 23-24
12
12
12
mm
mm
7,6 mm
7,6 mm
7,5 mm
7,5 mm
0.530 (1.168)
0.595 (1.312)
0.595 (1.312)
0.870 (1.918)
0.870 (1.918)
Type of actuation
Direction A: 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s); Direction B: 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) (1)
3 tapped entries for PG 13 (DIN PG 13.5) conduit thread, clamping capacity 9 to 12 mm (0.35 to 0.47 in.) (2 entries fitted with blanking plug) 1/2" NPT with adapter DE9RA1212 Screw terminals. Clamping capacity: min 1 x 0.5 mm 2, max 1 x 2.5 mm 2
For a 45 cam the maximum actuation speed becomes 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) and for a 15 cam, 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s).
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Material Handling
XC1ACComplete Switches with Slow-Break Contacts and 1/2" NPT Adapter Included
XC1AC11 XC1AC15 XC1AC16
53 20 20 53 30 47 56 53 26 5 37
113
83
83
(1) 44
XC1AC18
67 77
(1) 44
67 77
(1) 44
83 =
12
12
130
12
139
67 77
XC1AC17, XC1AC19
110 3 5 53 37 20 14 30 53 45,5 28
(1) 25.4
21.3
(2) 20.4
1. 2.
56
12
139
12 83
156,5 83
44
77
77
1. 3 tapped entries for PG 13 conduit thread or ISO 20 with adapter DE9RA1620. : 2 elongated holes 6.5 x 10.
Limit Switches
(1)
67
(1) 44
73,5 =
67
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Material Handling
XC1ACRenewal Parts
Plunger heads
Type of operator For actuation on end End plunger For actuation by 30 cam End ball bearing plunger Roller lever
Direction A 1 m/s (3.28 ft/s) Direction B 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) ZC1AC005 0.050 (0.110) 0.5 m/s (1.64 ft/s) ZC1AC001 0.035 (0.077)
Type of actuation
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
ZC1AC001
B
ZC1AC006
0.100 (0.220)
B
ZC1AC007
0.375 (0.827)
B
ZC1AC008
0.100 (0.220)
B
ZC1AC009
3.380 (7.452)
Contact blocks
Type of contact Function diagram
11 13
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
0.040 (0.088)
ZC1AZ11
11
13
ZC1AZ12
0.045 (0.099)
13
12
23
22
14
11
21
24
12
ZC1AC008
13 23
22
14
Adapter plate
Description Mounting plate
(For replacing an old version type RN-67522 limit switch with an XC1AC limit switch)
24
Limit Switches
11
13
N/O + N/C make before break ZC1AC007 ZC1AC009 N/C + N/C simultaneous
12 14
ZC1AZ13
0.040 (0.088)
11
21
ZC1AZ14
0.045 (0.099)
ZC1AZ15
0.045 (0.099)
ZC1AZ16
0.040 (0.088)
ZC1AZ17
0.040 (0.088)
Catalog number
ZC1AZ8
Weight kg (lb)
3.380 (7.452)
ZC1AZ1
Limit Switches
Osiswitch Classic, For Material Handling
XC1ACRenewal Parts
Dimensions
ZC1AC001 ZC1AC005 ZC1AC006
53 20 20 53 30 47 56 53 26 5 37
ZC1AC008
ZC1AC007, AC009
110 53 3 5 37 20 16 30 53 45,5 28
(1) 25.4
21.3
(2) 20.4
1. 2.
56
73,5
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Snap Action Industrial Switches
Class 9007
Industrial Snap Switches and Limit Switches without Enclosures
Industrial Snap Switches have been incorporated in many Square D products such as timers, specialty push buttons, foot switches, operating mechanisms, door interlocks, motor control centers, position switches, and many other control products.
Recommended ActuatorAn adjustable actuator is recommended. If a non-adjustable actuator is used, a resilient type or a mechanical stop should be used to prevent bottoming of button mechanism. Adjustable Actuator OvertravelMinimum recommended overtravel in both trip and reset directions is 0.015 in. (0.38 mm). Non-Adjustable Actuator Total TravelMaximum differential limit plus 0.030 in. (0.76 mm). Example: 0.076 in. (1.9 mm) for Type AO2. Non-Adjustable Actuator Total TravelFully retractedfrom mounting surface, at least 0.139 in. (3.5 mm) for Type AO1 and 0.160 in. (4.0 mm) for Types AO2 and CO3. Fully engagedfrom mounting surface, at least 0.061 in. (1.5 mm) but not closer than 0.045 in. (1.1 mm).
Type
AO1 AO1A AO1B AO2 AO6 (Plug-in) AO2A AO2B CO3 CO6 (Plug-in) CO7 AB21 (RH) q AB22 (LH) q
Type of Operator
Contact Arrangement k
Type
CB31 (RH) q CB32 (LH) q
Type of Operator
Contact Arrangement
1 N.O. 1 N.C.
Type
AP321 AP324 j CP321 CP324 j AP301 t AP304 j t AP323 AP325 j CP323
2 N.O. 2 N.C.
CB41 q (without Side Mtg. Bracket) CB33 (RH) f CB34 (LH) f AB25 (RH) AB26 (LH) CB35 (RH) CB36 (LH) AC1 CC1
1 N.O. 1 N.C. 2 N.O. 2 N.C. 1 N.O. 1 N.C. 2 N.O. 2 N.C. 1 N.O. 1 N.C.
2 N.O. 2 N.C.
CP325 j AP303 t
Operator Only AP221 CP221 Mushroom Button Type Panel Mounting 1 N.O. 1 N.C. 2 N.O. 2 N.C. Operator Only j q f t Roller turned 90 from standard (perpendicular to mounting holes). With 0.22 in. (5.6 mm) width roller. With 0.47 in. (12.0 mm) width roller. For use with Type AO and CO basic switches. AP305 j t AP222 CP222 AP202 t
1 N.O. 1 N.C.
2 N.O. 2 N.C.
Limit Switches
Operator Only
AP201 t
Single-pole snap switches that contain two double-break contact elements (1 N.O. and 1 N.C.) must be used on circuits of the same polarity. Two-pole snap switches contain two electrically separated sets of contact elements allowing use on circuits of opposite polarity. Each set contains two doublebreak contact elements (1 N.O. and 1 N.C.) that must be used on circuits of the same polarity.
Switch Type
Inductive and Resistive Voltage Make and Break Amperes Single Double Pole Pole
0.5 0.25 0.05 2.0 0.5 0.1 1.0 0.3 0.1 0.25 0.1 0.5 0.2 0.02 0.2 0.1
AC or DC
Contacts
Break A
15 10 6 5 15 10 6 5 3 1.5 0.75 0.6
VA
1800 2400 2880 3000 1800 2400 2880 3000 360 360 360 360
AO1, AC
AW, AO2 and AO6, AB, AP AW, CO3 and CO6, CB, CC, CP
Acceptable Wire Size . . . . . . . . . . . . .1422 AWG Recommended Terminal Clamp Torque 69 lb-in (0.71 Nm)
Marking
Limit Switches
Snap Action Industrial Switches
Class 9007
Approximate Dimensions and Operating Data, Types AO, CO, AP, and CP
Class 9007 Type AO, Single-Pole Snap Switch
0.25 R 6.35 0.17 R 4.3
0.83 21.1
1.06 27.0
0.19 4.8
0.19 4.8
.167 Max.
2.5 63.5
.167 Max.
Mounting Surface
0.31 7.9
Mounting Surface
.330 .310
1.03 26.2
1.14 29.0
1B 1A Pole 1
2A 2B Pole 2
CO3
0.0570.074 (1.41.8) 0.0250.046 (0.61.16) 0.1030.125 (2.63.2) 712 oz (0.050.084 N)
C07
0.0350.060 (0.91.5) 0.0600.085* (1.52.1) 0.0100.020 (0.250.50) 712 oz (0.050.084 N)
t Separation between first and second stage trip points is 0.020.025 (0.50.6). Note: Shipping weight of Type AO and CO is 0.25 lb (0.11 kg).
Type AP301, 303, 304, 305, 321, 323, 324, 325, and CP321, 323, 324, 325
Plunger to mount in 1/2" Dia. Hole in panels up to 0.38" (9.6mm) thick. .192
0.47" x 32 thread 2.20 55.9 0.39 9.9 A 2.5 63.5 .414 0.83 21.0
1.59 40.3
2.69 68.3
2.5 63.5
Type
AP321, 323, 324, 325 CP321, 323, 324, 325
Dimension A
0.70 (17.8) 0.80 (20.3)
AP321, 324
0.0600.150 (1.53.8) 0.0350.046 (0.91.2) 0.2000.340 (5.18.6) 20 oz (0.14 N)
AP323, 325
0.0600.150 (1.53.8) 0.0350.046 (0.91.2) 0.2000.340 (5.18.6) 28 oz (0.2 N)
CP321, 324
0.0600.150 (1.53.8) 0.0250.046 (0.91.2) 0.2000.340 (5.18.6) 26 oz (0.18 N)
CP323, 325
0.0600.150 (1.53.8) 0.0350.046 (0.91.2) 0.2000.340 (5.18.6) 28 oz (0.2 N)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Snap Action Industrial Switches
Class 9007
Approximate Dimensions and Operating Data, Types AB, CB, AC, and CC Types AB21 through 24 and CB31 through 34
Dia. 0.5 12.7 Provisions for #6 Mtg. Screws C Initial Position 1.41 35.8 0.53 13.4 A B
0.53 13.4 B
0.19 4.8
0.53 13.4
0.19 4.8
2.13 54.1
0.56 14.2
0.19 4.8
0.41 10.4
Note: Type CB31 RH mounting shown. Type AB41 and CB41 same as above except without side mounting plates.
Type
AB21, 22 AB23, 24 AB41 CB31, 32 CB33, 34 CB41
Dimension A
1.03 (26.2) 1.03 (26.2) 1.03 (26.2) 1.13 (28.7) 1.13 (28.7) 1.13 (28.7)
B
0.5 (12.7) 0.5 (12.7) 0.59 (15.0) 0.59 (15.0)
C
0.22 (5.6) 0.47 (12.0) 0.22 (5.6) 0.22 (5.6) 0.47 (12.0) 0.22 (5.6)
Type
AB25, 26 CB35, 36
Dimension A
1.03 (26.2) 1.13 (28.7)
B
0.5 (12.7) 0.59 (15.0)
C
0.22 (5.6) 0.22 (5.6)
Operating Data
Pre-travel Differential Overtravel Total travel Operating force 0.16 (4.5) 0.08 (2.0) 0.06 (1.5) 0.22 (5.6) 8 oz (0.23 kg)
Operating Data
Pre-travel Differential Overtravel Total travel Operating force 0.16 (4.5) 0.08 (2.0) 0.06 (1.5) 0.22 (5.6) 8 oz (0.23 kg)
Dimension Type A
AC1 CC1 Note: Shipping weight 0.25 lb (0.11 kg). 1.91 (48.5) 2 (50.8)
Limit Switches
CC1
0.16 (4.5) 0.07 (1.8) 0.09 (2.3) 0.25 (6.4) 8 oz (0.23 kg)
0.16 (4.5) 0.05 (1.3) 0.09 (2.3) 0.25 (6.4) 8 oz (0.23 kg)
3.88 98.5
B
1.5 (38.1) 1.59 (40.4
Limit Switches
Miniature
Class 9007 Type MS and ML
Description Mini-Switch (MS) miniature switches meet the need for very small, enclosed switches with environmental sealing. A full range of styles are available, including top push plunger, parallel roller plunger, cross roller plunger, rotary lever, and omnidirectional whisker. Factory prewiring with industrial grade cable (type SJTO) eliminates the need to remove the cover to wire the switch. Bottom- or side-entrance cable connection is available. Housings are rugged diecast zinc construction. Excellent sealing is achieved with an epoxy compound encapsulation of the electrical cable connections and switch housing. A Viton O-ring seal on the plunger keeps liquids from entering the switch cavity. Features The heavy-duty, completely encapsulated miniature MS limit switch is intended for difficult applications such as machine tools, earth moving equipment, and general transportation. Key features include:
Symmetrical design and top mounting holes for easy gang mounting of several switches for multiple switching Epoxy encapsulation sealing the pre-wired heavy duty #18 AWG SJTO cable and protecting against temporary submersion Single-pole double-throw (SPDT) Form C or Form Z, 1 N.O. + 1 N.C. contact Fine rotary lever adjustment Compact diecast zinc housing NEMA Type 6P and IP67 rated 10 ampere continuous current rating Gold contacts for low level logic switching
Stainless steel rollers UL Listed and CSA Certified CE Marking Standard temperature range: -40 to +220 F (-40 to +104 C)
Options
Rotary Head Conventional rotary limit switches have mounting holes in the base or body of the switch. In our rotary design, mounting holes are located in the head also. Cycling and stress forces are transmitted from the shaft in the head directly to the mounting bolts. The strain on the joint between the body and the head is eliminated. The result is a stronger and more rigid mounting, less subject to vibration or a weakness in the joint. Bulkhead Mounted Mini-Switches
Shown with 4-Pin Micro-Connector
The MS housing is designed for multiple switching by gang mounting several switches. Two mounting holes can be tapped in the top of each switch (except rotary lever) for #8-32 thread bolts. Switches can be readily mounted to any frame or plate by drilling holes through same to accommodate #8-32 bolts and switch plungers. Both sides of the housing are counter-bored for surface mounting.
Marking
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Miniature
Class 9007 Types MS and ML
General Specifications
Temperature range Enclosure rating Shock resistance Cable -40 to +220 F (-40 to +104 C) The minimum temperatures listed are based on the absence of freezing moisture or water. NEMA Types 1, 2, 4, 6, 6P, 12, 13, IP67 35G #18 AWG SJTO
Electrical Ratings/SPDT
Silver Contacts Voltage Make 120 AC 60 A 240 AC 30 A Break 6A 3A 100 mA @ 125 Vac 30 mA 28 Vdc Gold Contacts
Contact Characteristics
Rated thermal current Rated insulation voltage 10 A (standard) 300 Vac and Vdc (standard)
Electrical Rating/SPDT-DB
Silver Contacts Voltage 120 AC 240 AC Make 60 A 30 A Break 6A 3A
ML
0.80" max.
MS
Top plunger
ML
MS
ML
MS
Adjustable top plunger
ML
Form Z ML01S0100
Form Z ML06S0100
Form Z ML09S0100
MS
Parallel roller plunger
ML
MS
ML
Limit Switches
Form Z ML02S0100
Form Z ML07S0100
MS
Cross roller plunger
ML
MS
ML
Form Z ML03S0100
Form Z ML08S0100
MS
ML
Note: Lever not included.
Limit Switches
Miniature
Class 9007 Type MS and ML
Description / Functional Diagram
Booted Devices MS
0.70" max. Bk-Rd Bk-W Bk-Rd Bk-W 0 .004" max. .19" min. Bk-Rd Bk-W Bk-Rd Bk-W 0 .003" max. .19" min.
ML
0.80" max.
MS
ML
MS
ML
MS
ML
Form Z ML12S0100
Form Z ML13S0100
Note: See the available options on page 542 and add the designator (up to three) to the end of the catalog number, if applicable. See the example on page 542 for conductor length selection.
Lever
Length
1.38 to 3.38 (35 to 85.8) 1.38 to 3.38 (35 to 85.8) 6 (152.4) 5 (127)
Diameter
0.75 (19) 0.75 (19) 0.3 (7.6) 0.3 (7.6)
Width
0.25 (6.35) 0.25 (6.35)
Catalog Number
7D 7DN 7S 7N S
Corrosion proof (option available with nylon rollers only)Suffix to add to the end of catalog number
Lever tightening torque for mounting the lever on the shaft: minimum 17 lb-in (1.9 Nm).
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Miniature
Class 9007 Type MS and ML
Catalog Number Interpretation and Options
For Interpretation of the Catalog Number Only
9007 M S 0 1 S 0 1 0 0
Mini Line M Contact Form S L Conductor Length Options 0 0 0 0 Actuator Type Top Push Plunger 0 Parallel Roller Plunger 0 Cross Roller Plunger 0 Rotary Lever CW & CCW 0 Omnidirectional Wire Whisker 0 Bushing Mounted Top Push Plunger 0 Bushing Mounted Parallel Roller Plunger 0 Bushing Mounted Cross Roller Plunger 0 Adjustable Top Push Plunger 0 Booted Top Push Plunger 1 Booted Parallel Roller Plunger 1 Booted Cross Roller Plunger 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 2 3 S G 0 0 1 Contact Type 10 A Silver Contacts (standard) Gold Contacts Examples Option 0 0 1 1 2 2 6 0 1 1 Description # 16 AWG SJTO Cable Side Entrance 18-4 SJTO Cable Gray 18-4 SJTO Cable # 18 AWG Individual Conductors Low Force (top plunger only) 18 oz. 0 1 2 3 4 5 3 No Cable 3 ft (0.9 m) (stranded) 6 ft (1.8 m) 9 ft (2.7 m) 12 ft (3.7 m) 18 ft (5.5 m) 33 ft (10 m)
List options in numerically ascending order. Example: 9007MS01S030621. See other options below.
Conductor Length
No cable 3 ft (0.9 m)standard 6 ft (1.8 m) 9 ft (2.7 m) 12 ft (3.7 m) 18 ft (5.5 m) 33 ft (10 m)
Designator
c 00 01 02 03 04 05 13
Designator
c 02 06 10 11 12 21 30 54 55 81 82 83 84
Limit Switches
Male Plug (face) Pin-outs
C #4 N.C. #3
N.O. #4
c t
Ex: 9007MS01S0100 with a 9 ft (2.7 m) cable becomes 9007MS01S0300. 9007MS01S0100 with side entrance becomes 9007MS01S0106. For side entry connectors, include 06, then 12, 54, 55, 82, or 84; otherwise the connector will come from bottom of housing. Example of catalog no. with side entrance connector: 9007MS01S000654. No cable available with 54 and 55. Option 12 is supplied with 3 ft (0.9 m) of cable. DC connectors are rated 3 A, 250 Vac/Vdc.
N.O. #5
N.C. #3
#1 C
#4 GND
G #4
N.C. #3
N.O. #4
G #3
Keys
GND #1
KEY
N.O. #2
GND #1
KEY
N.C. #2
N.O. #2
N.C. #3
C #1
N.O. #2
C #1
Key
N.C. #2
Limit Switches
Miniature
Class 9007 Type MS and ML
Dimensions
Top Push Plunger MS01, MLO1
0.20/(5.1) Dia. Typ. mounting holes 0.40/(10.2) Dia. C Bore 0.21/(5.3) deep 0.62 TYP (15.8)
Booted Top Push Plunger with Mid-Side Entry Cable MS10, ML10
0.98 (25.0)TYP
R 0.29 (7.3)
0.98 (24.89)
0.31 (7.8)
0.20 Dia. Mtg. Holes 0.406 Dia. C Bore 0.20 Deep (0.25 Dia. Mtg. holes optional)
1.19 (30.2)
M14 x 1 Threaded
1.49 (37.8)
1.49 (37.8)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
Miniature Enclosed Reed
Class 9007 Type XA
Description and Specifications
Sealed construction keeps contaminants out of the contact area, making it the ideal choice for low voltage, low current circuits used by programmable controllers. Type XA is designed for use in applications where contact reliability, environmental immunity, small size, or low cost are required. NOTE:
Straight Plunger
Because reed switches are operated by a magnet, they should not be installed in areas where strong magnetic fields may be present. The devices should always be checked for proper operation after installation. Type XA cannot be used in Division 2 locations since the National Electrical Code (NEC) requires provisions for conduit connection. The Type C reed switches have this provision for conduit but the Type XA do not.
Straight Plunger N.O. Type XA7303E XA7306E XA7309E N.C. Type XA7503E XA7506E XA7509E Roller Plunger N.O. Type XA7303D XA7306D XA7309D N.C. Type XA7503D XA7506D XA7509D Cross Roller Plunger N.O. Type XA7303DC XA7306DC XA7309DC N.C. Type XA7503DC XA7506DC XA7509DC
Other cable lengths are available. Order by changing the last two numerical digits of the Type number to the length desired. Example: An XA7303E with 15 ft (4.5 m) of cable would become an XA7315E.
Roller Plunger
Operating Data
Dimensions in. (mm)
Initial position (D) Trip position (B) Pre-travel (E) Reset position (C) maximum Differential (F) Final position (A) Total stroke
F (DIFFERENTIAL)
The contact is a fully encapsulated, hermetically sealed reed, suitable for controlling solid-state loads as well as industrial relays. Switches can also be used as inputs to intrinsically safe systems. Use of a transient suppressor extends the life of the switch when used on heavy electrical loads. Diecast zincbaked, gray enamel finish. Meets NEMA Types 2, 4, 4X, 6P, 12 and 13 requirements. Oil-tight, dust-tight, water-tight, and submersible. SJTOWA jacketed cable with 18 gauge wire. -20 to +140 F (-28.9 to +60 C). UL: File E42259 CCN NKCR CSA: File LR 25490, Class 3211 03
Limit Switches
NOTE: The XA switch is available with a 3 ft (0.9 m) cable and 3-pin Brad Harrison male connector No. 40904 (or equivalent). Form Y190.
DC Resistive (75% Power Factor) Resistive Volts Make and Break Amperes Single Throw
120 0.2
Make VA
240 240
Break A
0.2 0.1
VA
24 24
Contact Diagrams
0.070
Dimensions
Bk-W Bk-W
0 0.035 0.198
9007XA73 (N.O.)
0.070
Bk-W Bk-W
0 0.035 0.198
9007XA75 (N.C.)
Limit Switches
9007AW Heavy Duty Industrial
Precision, Oiltight
Lever Arm And Plunger Types
Select Operator Select Switch Lever Arm Type Without Lever Arm. Select from CCW Operation c Type
AW16 u AW19u AW12 AW14 AW18 AO16 u u AO12 AO18 AF12 5 30 2.5 25 2.75 lb-in (0.31 Nm) 0.002 (0.05) Linear travel of cam on 1.38 (35) lever arm
Mounting
Surface Mounting Plug-in
Contacts
1 N.O.1 N.C. 2 N.O. 2 N.C. 1 N.O.1 N.C. 1 N.O.1 N.C. 2 N.O.2 N.C. 1 N.O.1 N.C. 2 N.O. 2 N.C. 1 N.O.1 N.C. 2 N.O.2 N.C. 1 N.O.1 N.C. Pre-travel Total-travel Differential Reverse Over-travel Operating Torque or Force Repeat Accuracy
Surface Mounting Nonplug-in Standard Box Surface Mounting Nonplug-in Deep Box Open Type (Without Box) Plug-in Open Type (Without Box) Nonplug-in Flush Mounting
Plunger Type
0.09 (2.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.06 (1.5) Adjustable 0.05 (1.3) 3 lb-in (0.34 Nm) 0.001 (0.02)
0.09 (2.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.06 (1.5) Adjustable 0.05 (1.3) 3 lb-in (0.34 Nm) 0.001 (0.02)
Field convertible to CW operation. 2 N.O. contact only when Type AW19 is operated in clockwise direction. 2 N.C. contacts only when Type AW19 is operated in counterclockwise direction. Lever arms, see page 574.
Approximate Dimensions
Type AW
0.25 6.35 0.19 4.8 0.25 6.35 0.06 1.5 Adjustment G ON AW14 and AW18, 0.5 Pipe Tap may be placed here for straight through wiring. 1.44 36.6 H F 0.69 17.5 1.06 27.0 0.19 4.8 0.53 13.5
Type AO
0.19 4.8 0.25 6.35 0.06 1.5 G Adjustment 0.06 1.5 H F 0.19 4.8 0.69 17.5 1.38 35.0 0.31 7.9
Initial Position
0.63 16.0 C 0.44 11.2 D E 0.19 4.8 3.06 77.7 3.88 98.5 3.5 88.9 0.84 21.3
3.47 88.1
3.09 78.5
2.5 63.5
0.25 6.35
Pipe Tap
0.5 12.7
0.25 6.35
0.53 13.5
Type
AW12 AW14 AW16 AW18 AW19 AO12 AO18
C
0.31 (7.9) 1.25 (32)
D
2.69 (68.3) 3 (76)
E
2.19 (56) 2.5 (63.5)
F
1.16 (29.4) 1.47 (37) 1.03 (26 1.13 (29)
G
2.52.56 (63.565) 2.812.88 (7173) 1.061.13 (2729) 1.061.13 (2729)
H
2.062.13 (52.354) 2.382.44 (6062) 0.630.69 (1617.5) 0.630.69 (1617.5)
0.38 9.6 0.19 4.8 A B 0.19 4.8 3.06 3.5 77.7 88.9 3.88 98.5
0.75 19.0 0.5 12.7 Pipe Tap (6) 0.198 Dia. mtg. holes
Type
AW32 and AW42 AW36, 38, 46, 48, and 49
A
0.31 (7.9) 1.25 (32)
B
2.22 (56) 2.53 (64)
C
1.16 (29.4) 1.47 (37.3)
D
1.81 (46) 2.13 (5.4)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Standard and Compact
Standard plug-in body type with 1 cable entry (1) The standard plug-in body types with one cable entry are also available with reed contacts With head for linear movement side plunger
top plunger
Page 548
Page 552
Page 550
Page 554
Top plunger
Limit Switches
Page 556 Page 557
Page 559
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Standard and Compact
Environmental characteristics
Conforming to standards Product certifications Protective treatment Ambient air temperature Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Cable entry or connector (1) Materials
1.
Products
NEMA 250, EN 60947-1, EN 60947-5-1, IEC 60947, UL 508, C22-2-14-95, e conformity documentation UL, CSA, e Epoxy powder coat (additional protection available)
Operation Storage Conforming to IEC 60068-2-6 Conforming to IEC 60068-2-27 Conforming to IEC 61140 Conforming to IEC 60529 Depending on model Bodies, heads, levers
-20+185 F (-28.9+85 C), wider range available -20+185 F (-28.9+85 C), wider range available 25 gn (10150 Hz, 11 ms) (Reed switch good for 18.5g only) 60 gn (9 ms) 40 gn (9 ms) for reed switch Class 0 IP 67 1/2-14 NPT, M20 x 1.5, ISO cable entry, 5-pin mini connector, 4-pin micro connector Bodies and heads in Zamak zinc alloy, levers and rods in zinc, steel, stainless steel, Delrin resin.
A wide range of connectors are available. Contact your local field office.
X B
Single break
Double break
Y C
Double break
Single break
Za
Same polarity
Double break
Zb
Electrically separate
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Standard Body
Type of head Side Plunger (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. 1 N.C. snap action
3 1 4
2 2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54F
9007C54G
9007C54GD
2
9007C54H
3.6
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
6.3 mm
9007C62F
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62G
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62GD
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62H
3.6
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
6.3 mm
9007C66F
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66G
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66GD
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
Limit Switches
Switch actuation Type of actuation Pre-travel Pre-travel two Stage Total travel Differential Reverse overtravel Minimum force or torque Terminal wire sizes (Cabling/Screw Clamp) Repeatability (linear travel of cam) Cable entry
1. 2.
On end
2 mm (0.08 in.) 2 mm (0.08 in.) First stage First stage to second stage 0.5 mm (0.02 in.) 6.3 mm (0.25 in.) 0.8 mm (0.03 in.)
4 lb (17.8 N) 1 or 2, 1222AWG (2.050.644 mm2) wires maximum 0.03 mm (0.001 in.) 1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry
7 lb (31.1 N)
Can be converted to horizontal roller type in the field. To order horizontal roller version add the letter H at the end of the equivalent vertical roller version type. To lock the nut in the desired position, crimp the slot near the bottom of the nut.
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Standard Body
Type of head Top Plunger (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. 1 N.C. snap action
3 1 4 2
9007C54D
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54E
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54ED
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54R (2)
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
0.5
6.3 mm
0.5
6.3 mm
0.5
6.3 mm
0.5
6.3 mm
9007C62D
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62E
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62ED
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62R (2)
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
9007C66D
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66E
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66ED
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66R (2)
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
Type of actuation Pre-travel Pre-travel two Stage First stage First stage to second stage
2 mm (0.08 in.) 2 mm (0.08 in.) 0.3 mm (0.01 in.) 6.3 mm (0.25 in.) 0.5 mm (0.02 in.)
Total travel Differential Reverse overtravel Minimum force or torque Terminal wire sizes (Cabling/Screw Clamp) Repeatability (linear travel of cam) Cable entry
1. 2.
3 lb (13.3 N) 1 or 2, 1222 AWG (2.050.644 mm2) wires maximum 0.03 mm (0.001 in.) 1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry
7 lb (31.1 N)
To lock the nut in the desired position, crimp the slot near the bottom of the nut. Does not include mushroom button. Must be ordered separately see page 573.
Limit Switches
Switch actuation
On end
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Standard Body
Type of head Rotary (lever arm type) (1)
Neutral position Standard pre-travel, Low differential, spring return spring return CW & CCW CW & CCW
Catalog numbers
1 N.O., 1 N.C. snap action 3 4
9007C54B2
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54A2
5
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54N2
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54C
45 90
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
90
90
90
9007C62B2
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62A2
5
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62N2
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62C
45
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
3 2
7 6
90
90
90
90
9007C68T10
CCW
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C68T5
CCW
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
100 10 CW
50 5
CW
90CCW 4
90CW 4
90CCW 2
90CW 2
9007C66B2
10 12.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66A2
5 6.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66N2
10 12.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
3 2 1
7 6 5
4 4
90
2 2
90
4 4
90
CW
Limit Switches
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
Type of actuation
Pre-travel 10 5 10 5 10 45 Pre-travel two stage First stage 10 5 10 First stage to second stage 2.5 1.5 2.5 Total travel 90 90 Differential 4 2 4 2 4 Reverse overtravel 90 Operating torque/force 4 lb-in (0.45 Nm) 25 oz-in (018 Nm) 3 lb-in (0.34 Nm) 1 pole & 2 pole Terminal wire sizes 2) wires maximum 1 or 2, 1222 AWG (2.050.644 mm (Cabling/Screw Clamp) Repeatability 0.05 mm ( 0.002 in.) 0.03 mm ( 0.001 in.) 0.05 mm ( 0.002 in.) 0.05 mm ( 0.002 in.) 0.05 mm ( 0.002 in.) 0.05 mm ( 0.002 in.) (linear travel of cam) Cable entry 1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry 1. Lever arm type must be ordered separately from pages 574 to 579. 2. These devices are factory set to operate the contacts in both the CW and CCW directions. Mode of operation is field convertible to CW only or CCW only. To order factory converted devices: For CCW only operation, change the 2 at the end of the Type number to 1 (for example, C54B2 becomes C54B1). For CW only operation, delete the 2 at the end of the Type number (for example C54B2 becomes C54B).
/CCW CW
Mode of operation of the lever arm is easily convertible to clockwise or both. Simply pull out and rotate the arrow to the letters representing the desired directionCW, CCW, or CW/CCW.
CCW
CW
/C C W
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Standard Body
Type of head Flexible operator (wobble stick)
Type of operator
Universal (1)
Cat whisker
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. 1 N.C. snap action
3 1 4 2
9007C54JKC
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54J
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54K
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54KC
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C54L
20
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
90
90
90
90
90
9007C62JKC
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62J
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62K
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62KC
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007C62L
20
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
90
90
90
90
90
9007C66JKC
10 14
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66J
10 14
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66K
10 14
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66KC
10 14
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007C66L
20 25
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
3 3
90
3 3
90
3 3
90
3 3
90
6 6
90
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
Switch actuation Type of actuation Pre-travel Pre-travel two stage First stage First stage to second stage Total travel Differential Reverse overtravel Operating torque/force 1 pole & 2 pole Terminal wire sizes (Cabling/Screw Clamp) Repeatability (linear travel of cam) Cable entry
1.
10 (any direction) 10 (any direction) 4 90 3 3 lb-in (0.34 Nm) 1 or 2, 1222 AWG (2.050.644 mm2) wires maximum 1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry
20 20 5 6
Wobble stick extensions are available separately for the universal head. See page 573.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Standard BodyReed Contacts
Type of head Side Plunger (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. Reed contacts snap action
3 4
3-4 3-4
9007C84F
2.8
9007C84G
2.8
3-4 3-4
9007C84GD
2.8
3-4 3-4
9007C84H
3.6
3-4 3-4
1.8
6.3 mm
1.8
6.3 mm
1.8
6.3 mm
6.3 mm
9007C86F
2.8
1-2 1-2
9007C86G
2.8
1-2 1-2
9007C86GD
2.8
1-2 1-2
9007C86H
3.6 6.3 mm
1-2 1-2
1.8
6.3 mm
1.8
6.3 mm
1.8
6.3 mm
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
Limit Switches
1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry
Can be converted to horizontal roller type in the field. To order horizontal roller version add the letter H at the end of the equivalent vertical roller version type. To lock the nut in the desired position, crimp the slot near the bottom of the nut.
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Standard BodyReed Contacts
Type of head Top Plunger (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. Reed contacts snap action
3 4
3-4 3-4
9007C84D
2.5
9007C84E
2.5
3-4 3-4
9007C84ED
2.5
3-4 3-4
9007C84R (2)
2.5
3-4 3-4
1.3
6.3 mm
1.3
6.3 mm
1.3
6.3 mm
1.3
6.3 mm
9007C86D
2.5
1-2 1-2
9007C86E
2.5
1-2 1-2
9007C86ED
2.5
1-2 1-2
9007C86R (2)
2.5
1-2 1-2
1.3
6.3 mm
1.3
6.3 mm
1.3
6.3 mm
1.3
6.3 mm
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
To lock the nut in the desired position, crimp the slot near the bottom of the nut. Does not include mushroom button. Must be ordered separately from page 573.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Standard BodyReed Contacts
Type of head Rotary (lever arm type) (1)
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. Reed contacts snap action
3 4
3-4 3-4
9007C84B2
13
9007C84A2
7
3-4 3-4
9007C84N2
13
3-4 3-4
9007C84C
45
3-4 3-4
90
90
90
90
9007C86B2
13
1-2 1-2
9007C86A2
7
1-2 1-2
9007C86N2
13
1-2 1-2
9007C86C
45
1-2 1-2
90
90
90
90
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
CW
Limit Switches
1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry
Lever arm type must be ordered separately from pages 574 to 579. These devices are factory set to operate the contacts in both the CW and CCW directions. Mode of operation is field convertible to CW only or CCW only. To order factory converted devices: For CCW only operation, change the 2 at the end of the Type number to 1 (for example, C54B2 becomes C54B1). For CW only operation, delete the 2 at the end of the Type number (for example, C54B2 becomes C54B).
Mode of operation of the lever arm is easily convertible to clockwise or both. Simply pull out and rotate the arrow to the letters representing the desired directionCW, CCW, or CW/CCW.
/CCW CW
CCW
CW
/C C W
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Standard BodyReed Contacts
Type of head Flexible operator (wobble stick)
Type of operator
Universal (1)
Cat whisker
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. Reed contacts snap action
3 4
3-4 3-4
9007C84JKC
13 0 90
9007C84J
13
3-4 3-4
9007C84K
13
3-4 3-4
9007C84KC
13
3-4 3-4
9007C84L
25
3-4 3-4
11
11
90
11
90
11
90
18
90
9007C86JKC
13
1-2 1-2
9007C86J
13
1-2 1-2
9007C86K
13
1-2 1-2
9007C86KC
13
1-2 1-2
9007C86L
25
1-2 1-2
11
90
11
90
11
90
11
90
18
90
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
0.568 (1.25)
13 (any direction) 90 11 3 lb-in (0.34 Nm) 1 or 2, 1222 AWG (2.050.644 mm2) wires maximum 1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry
25 18
1. Wobble stick extensions are available separately for the universal head. See page 573. Acceptable wire sizes: 12-22 AWG Recommended, Terminal clamp torque: 7 lb-in (0.80 Nm).
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Compact Body
Type of head Side Plunger (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Side roller plunger Side push rod plunger spring return vertical roller spring return (1)
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. 1 N.C. snap action
3 1 4 2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52F
2
9007C52G
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52GD
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52H
3.6 6.3 mm
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
0.445 (0.98)
0.422 (0.93)
0.568 (1.25)
2 mm (0.08 in.) 0.5 mm (0.02 in.) 6.3 mm (0.25 in.) 0.8 mm (0.03 in.)
Limit Switches
1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry. Prewired options available.
Can be converted to horizontal roller type in the field. To order horizontal roller version add the letter H at the end of the equivalent vertical roller version type. To lock the nut in the desired position, crimp the slot near the bottom of the nut.
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Compact Body
Type of head Top Plunger (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. 1 N.C. snap action
3 1 4 2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52D
2
9007C52E
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52ED
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52R (2)
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
0.5
6.3 mm
0.5
6.3 mm
0.5
6.3 mm
0.5
6.3 mm
0.169 (0.43)
0.422 (0.93)
0.568 (1.25)
2 mm (0.08 in.) 0.03 mm (0.01 in.) 6.3 mm (0.25 in.) 0.5 mm (0.02 in.)
1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry. Prewired options available.
To lock the nut in the desired position, crimp the slot near the bottom of the nut. Does not include mushroom button. Must be ordered separately see page 573.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Compact Body
Type of head Rotary (lever arm type) (1)
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. 1 N.C. snap action
3 1 4 2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52B2
10
9007C52A2
5
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52N2
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52C
45
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
90
90
90
90
0.481 (1.06)
0.481 (1.06)
0.481 (1.06)
CW
Limit Switches
1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry
Lever arm type must be ordered separately from pages 574 to 579. These devices are factory set to operate the contacts in both the CW and CCW directions. Mode of operation is field convertible to CW only or CCW only. To order factory converted devices: For CCW only operation, change the 2 at the end of the Type number to 1 (for example, C52B2 becomes C52B1). For CW only operation, delete the 2 at the end of the Type number (for example, C52B2 becomes C52B).
Mode of operation of the lever arm is easily convertible to clockwise or both. Simply pull out and rotate the arrow to the letters representing the desired directionCW, CCW, or CW/CCW.
/CCW CW
CCW
CW
/C C W
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Compact Body
Type of head Flexible operator (wobble stick)
Universal (1)
Cat whisker
9007C52JKC
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52J
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52K
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52KC
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007C52L
20
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
90
90
90
90
90
0.568 (1.25)
0.540 (1.19)
0.568 (1.25)
0.468 (1.03)
Type of actuation
1 or 2, 1222 AWG (2.050.644 mm2) wires maximum 1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry
1.
Wobble stick extensions are available separately for the universal head. See page 573.
Limit Switches
Pre-travel Pre-travel two stage First stage First stage to second stage Total travel Differential Reverse overtravel Operating torque/force 1 pole & 2 pole Terminal wire sizes (Cabling/Screw Clamp) Repeatability (linear travel of cam) Cable entry
20 20 5 6
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Factory Modifications (Forms)
Special features and modifications
Special features do not apply to 9007CR unless noted. Not field installable, except where noted. Shaft equipped with hub for mounting larger diameter lever used with 9007T/FT limit switches Any rotary lever arm 9007C, CF or CR switch can be furnished with an optional shaft and hub combination which will accept the lever arms normally used with 9007T and FT limit switches. To order, add S9 as suffix to the device number. For example, to order a 9007C54B2 with this modification, order as a 9007C54B2S9. For details about switches and lever arms that can be furnished with this modification, see the appropriate catalog or the Digest. S9 Rotary head shown with S9 option
L1
Light normally on CR1
Description Optional hub for 9007T/FT levers Hub only: can be field installed on rotary shaft; see accessories, page 565 Addition of LED pilot light (1)
L2
Weight kg (lb)
0.018 (0.04)
Description
Addition of LED pilot light in parallel with N.O. contact (light normally on) Addition of LED pilot light in parallel with N.C. contact (light normally off)
Weight kg (lb)
0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25)
B A
CR2
Light normally off
Form P5 Thru P9
L1 L2 CR1 CR2
* Customer
installed jumper
LED Pilot light, 24 to 120 V AC or DC on plug-in type switch (9007C52, C54, C62, C66, C68 or (2))
Addition of two LED pilot lights, one in parallel with N.O. contact (light normally on), P7 one in parallel with N.C. contact (light normally off) Addition of two LED pilot lights in parallel with N.O. contacts (lights normally on) Addition of two LED pilot lights in parallel with N.C. contacts (lights normally off) Addition of one isolated LED pilot light (light on when load is energized) P8 P9 P10 (3) (3) (4)
0.57 (1.25)
Form P10
* Only one of the jumpers may be used. Pilot light is On when load is energized 1. 2. 3. 4.
Bleeder circuit must be added to ensure PLC compatibility. 9007C84 and C86 are available with P5 or P6 pilot lights only. 9007C62, C66 or C68 only. 9007C54 only. Not available with prewired receptacles.
Examples of complete units with pilot lights in standard plug-in body type Single pole Side plunger Top plunger Rotary Wobble stick Two poles Side plunger Top plunger Rotary Wobble stick
9007C62FP6 9007C62DP6 9007C62EP6 9007C62B2P6 9007C62LP6 9007C62JP6 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25)
Catalog number
9007C54FP6 9007C54DP6 9007C54EP6 9007C54B2P6 9007C54LP6 9007C54JP6
Weight kg (lb)
0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25)
Limit Switches
560
09/2007
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Factory Modifications (Forms)
Special features and modifications (continued)
Special features do not apply to 9007CR unless noted. Not field installable, except where noted. Manifold mounting Suffix to add to the Description device catalog number Manifold mounting available on standard and compact types. Replaces existing type B installations if new hole is drilled to Y2051 match knockout. Supersedes type C with form Y205. Receptacle is furnished with a wiring hole and a gasket in the base. Special chemical resistant coating (includes Viton fluorocarbon sealsY140, and stainless steel head and body screws) (1) Low temperature lever types only: limit switch will operate in an ambient temperature range of -40 to 185 F (standard limit switch ambient temperature range is -20 to 185 F). Minimum temperature is based on the absence of freezing moisture or water. Viton fluorocarbon gaskets and seals (1) Substitution of Viton fluorocarbon gaskets and seals on: Lever arm type, standard box (Viton fluorocarbon shaft seals on lever arm types as standard) Lever arm type, compact box (Viton fluorocarbon shaft seals on lever arm types as standard) Plunger type, standard box Plunger type, compact box Substitution of Viton fluorocarbon boot only on plunger type switches
1. L3
Weight kg (lb)
Form Y205
0.57 (1.25)
0.57 (1.25)
0.58 15
Y2051
Y128
0.57 (1.25)
0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25)
Fluorocarbon (as found in Viton seals) has been shown to resist sunlight aging problems.
Mini and micro connectors, ISO M20 (Form M11) To order 9007C with ISO M 20 thread add the suffix M11 to the device number. Examples of complete unit catalog numbers with ISO M20 thread in standard plug-in body type Weight Type of head Catalog number kg (lb) Single pole 9007C54FM11 0.57 (1.25) Side plunger
Rotary Wobble stick Two poles Side plunger Top plunger Rotary Wobble stick
0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25)
Limit Switches
Top plunger
9007C54DM11 9007C54EM11
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Factory Modifications (Forms)
Special features and modifications (continued)
Special features do not apply to 9007CR unless noted. Not field installable, except where noted. Pre-wired receptacle (1) (2) Suffix to add to the device Description For use catalog number Plug-in limit switch furnished with pre-wired mini 5-pin Brad Harrison male connector Single pole
For use with Brad Harrison female portable plug Y1901 No.41306, 41307 or 41308 (or equal). Same as Y1901 but with different wire color Y1905 coding Same as Y1901 but with tamper proof screws on head and body Similar to Y1905 except for double pole device 1. 2. Plug and cable assemblies: see accessories page 565 Not available with P10 or for Hazardous location switches
Weight kg (lb)
0.60 (1.33) 0.60 (1.33)
Tamper proof screws in complete switch only Y190 Standard body shown with Y190 option Single pole
Y1903 Y19013 0.60 (1.33) 0.60 (1.33)
Examples of complete unit catalog numbers with mini or micro connectors in standard plug-in body type Weight Type of head Catalog number kg (lb) Single pole, 5-pin mini connector (7/8"-16 UN-2A thread) 9007C54FY1901 0.57 (1.25) Side plunger Top plunger Rotary Wobble stick Two poles, 9-pin mini connector (1-2/8"-16 UN-2A thread) Side plunger Top plunger Rotary Wobble stick Single pole, 5-pin micro single key (M12 x 1 thread) Side plunger Top plunger
9007C54DY1901 9007C54EY1901 9007C54B2Y1901 9007C54LY1901 9007C54JY1901 9007C62FY19016 9007C62DY19016 9007C62EY19016 9007C62B2Y19016 9007C62LY19016 9007C62JY19016 9007C62FY1912 9007C54DY1912 9007C54EY1912 9007C54B2Y1912 9007C54LY1912 9007C54JY1912 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25) 0.57 (1.25)
Limit Switches
562
Single pole, 5-pin micro connector two keys (1/2-20 UNF-2A thread) 9007C54FY19019 Side plunger Top plunger Rotary Wobble stick
9007C54DY19019 9007C54EY19019 9007C54B2Y19019 9007C54LY19019 9007C54JY19019 Red Orange
3 4 2
4 3 1
8 7 5
Red Black
Black Red
White 1 Green
Green
Form Y19013
Form Y1905
09/2007
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Factory Modifications (Forms)
Special features and modifications (continued)
Special features do not apply to 9007CR unless noted. Not field installable, except where noted. Potted limit (position) switch or plug-in receptacle only (1) Suffix to add to the Description (2) device catalog number With five #16 wires five ft long Y1841 With individual Single pole wires Two pole With nine #16 wires five ft long Y1842 With STOWA cord
Single pole Single pole Two pole Two pole With five conductor #16 STOWA cord eight ft long Same as Y1851 but with different wire color coding With nine conductor #16 STOWA cord eight ft long Same as Y1852 but with different wire color coding Y1851 Y1855 Y1852 Y1856 Y1843 Y1844 Y1853 Y1854 Y1857 Y1858
Weight kg (lb)
0.59 (1.30) 0.60 (1.32) 1.30 (2.88) 1.30 (2.88) 1.31 (2.90) 1.31 (2.90) 0.59 (1.30) 0.60 (1.32) 1.30 (2.88) 1.30 (2.88) 1.31 (2.90) 1.31 (2.90)
Tamper proof screwscomplete switch only With individual Same as Y1841but with tamper proof screws on head and body wires Same as Y1842 but with tamper proof screws on head and body With STOWA cord
1. 2. Same as Y1851 but with tamper proof screws on head and body Same as Y1852 but with tamper proof screws on head and body Same as Y1855 but with tamper proof screws on head and body Same as Y1856 but with tamper proof screws on head and body Not for 9007CR Hazardous location devices Wire entry completely sealed with epoxy resin.
Dust boot (protects against abrasive dusts, dirt, grit and sand) Description Lever type limit switch furnished with On all 9007C and 9007CR lever type switches a boot around the shaft See accessories, page 565 Dust boot only Suffix to add to the device catalog number
Y33
Weight kg (lb)
0.01 (0.01)
Wiring Diagrams
Forms Y1851 and Y1853
Red White
3 1 4 2
Orange Black
Black Red
Green
Green
Green
Green
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Factory Modifications (Forms)
Special features and modifications (continued)
Special features do not apply to 9007CR unless noted. Not field installable, except where noted. Optional shafts Suffix to add to the Description device catalog number Optional shaft, 7.8 mm (0.306 in.) diameter: Y247 To accommodate lever arms from the obsolete R.B.Denison C limit switches. Available on all 9007C, CF, or CR limit switches Optional shaft, 7.1 mm (0.28 in.) diameter: Y249 Available on all 9007C, CF, or CR limit switches Switch with adapter plate Suffix to add to the Description device catalog number Switch with adapter plate permitting substitution of any 9007C switch with standard Y147 body for any type T switch with style B base plate
Weight kg (lb)
0.57 (1.25)
0.57 (1.25)
Weight kg (lb)
Direct acting contacts / Positive opening contacts Y1561 One pole, normally closed, slow make-slow break, direct acting contact mechanism substituted for standard snap switch on 9007C52, C54 and CR53 devices. This mechanism was designed for use in emergency overtravel applications. The movable contact of this basic switch unit is acted upon directly by the actuating mechanism of the limit switch and is not dependent upon the force exerted by a snap switch blade or spring to open the circuit. Because these contacts are slow make-slow break, they are best suited for applications where they are not actuated during normal operation, but only if abnormal overtravel is encountered. Electrical contact ratings ACNEMA A600 DC maximum current maximum current35% power factor Continuous Continuous Make Break Make or break carrying carrying Volts A VA A VA A Volts A VA A
120 60 7200 6 720 10 125 1.1/0.55 (1) 240 30 7200 3 720 10 480 15 7200 1.5 720 10 250 0.27 600 12 7200 1.2 720 10 600 0.10 1. 9007C52 compact unit ratings at 125 Vdcsame ratings as 9007C54 and 9007CR53 at other voltages. 138/69 (1) 67.5 60 5/2.5 (1) 2.5 2.5
Description
Weight kg (lb)
0.566 (1.25)
Limit Switches
564
Direct acting contact/positive opening contact block (slow break single pole only)
09/2007
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Accessories
Accessories
Hub only Description Catalog number Weight kg (lb)
0.02 (0.04)
Hub can be field installed on any 9007C lever type switch, increasing the shaft diameter from 0.3750.749 in. (9.5319 mm), to accept levers 9007S9 normally used with 9007T/FT switches. Dust boot only Description Dust boot can be field installed on any 9007C and CR lever type switch Conduit seal insert (field instable) Description Conduit seal fits in conduit entrance and excludes liquids 5 hole seal 9 hole seal Plug and cable assemblies Description 5-pin mini connecting cables (to fit certain switches with Form Y190) Plug and 3 ft (0.91 m) cable Plug and 6 ft (1.83 m) cable Plug and 12 ft (3.66 m) cable
Note: Other cables available. See the Cabling section beginning on page 625.
Catalog number
9007BT3
Weight kg (lb)
0.01 (0.01)
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
0.01 (0.02) 0.01 (0.02)
31032-488-01 31032-815-01
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
AdapterField installable Description Adapter plate kit only Plate plus mounting screws for substitution of any 9007C switch with standard box for any 9007T switch with style B base plate Adapter plate for direct substitution of any 9007C plunger switches for 9007B plug-in plunger switchesuse only if there is a problem in lining up cam tracks Standard body type Compact body type Adapter plate kit permitting direct substitution of any 9007C lever arm switch with standard box for any 9007AW lever arm switch 20 mm conduit connection adapter male 0.5 in. (12.7 mm) NPT on one end, female 0.787 in. (20 mm) on other end
1. 2. Dimensions: 0.22 x 2.94 x 1.54 in. (5.6 x 75 x 39 mm) Dimensions: 0.22 x 2.07 x 1.54 in. (5.6 x 53 x 39 mm)
Catalog number
9007BT1
Weight kg (lb)
0.23 (0.50)
9007CT11
0.23 (0.50)
9007CT12
0.01 (0.20)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
DimensionsStandard Body
9007CG
2.16 55 1.41 36 0.58 15 1.24 31
9007CGD
2.71 Min. 69 1.96 Min. 50 0.58 15 1.24 31 4.02 102
9007CH
3.12 79 1.44 37
0.63 16 0.75 19
0.78 20 0.12 3
0.37 9 0.75 19
0.78 20
1.68 43 0.58 15
0.37 9 0.75 19
1.24 31
0.78 20
(1)
4.02 102 2.35 60
(1)
2.35 60
(1)
2.35 60
(2)
(2)
(3)
(2)
4.02 102
(1)
2.35 60
(3)
(2)
4.02 102
(3)
(3)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45 1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45 1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45
1.17 30 1.55 39
0.64 16 1.79 45
Dual dimensions:
1. 2. 3. 4.
in. mm
2 x 0.20/5 x 0.22/6 HLS. 2 x 10-24 Tapped HLS Back Mtg 0.29/7 DP. 1/2 14 NPT. Adjustable.
9007CE
0.58 15
9007CED
(4)
0.78 20 0.19 5
0.63 16 1.88 48
0.12 3
0.58 15
0.50 13
0.78 20
2.19 56
2.25 57
(1)
2.35 60
(1)
2.35 60
4.50 115
(1)
2.35 60
5.22 133
Limit Switches
(2)
(3)
(2)
(3)
(2)
(3)
1.17 30 1.55 39
0.64 16 1.79 45
1.17 30 1.55 39
0.64 16 1.79 45
1.17 30 1.55 39
0.64 16 1.79 45
Dual dimensions:
1. 2. 3. 4.
in. mm
2 x 0.20/5 x 0.22/6 HLS. 2 x 10-24 Tapped HLS Back Mtg 0.29/7 DP. 1/2 14 NPT. Adjustable.
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
DimensionsStandard Body
Rotary 9007C A, B, C, N, T5, T10
2.50 64 1.72 44 0.75 19 0.44 11
0.58 15 1.24 31
Dual dimensions:
4.02 102
1. 2. 3.
2.35 60
(1) (2)
in. mm
(3)
2 x 0.20/5 x 0.22/6 HLS. 2 x 10-24 Tapped HLS Back Mtg 0.29/7 DP. 1/2 14 NPT.
1.17 30 1.55 39
0.64 16 1.79 45
9007CJ
0.78 20 0.25 6
0.58 15
0.25 6
0.78 20
0.58 15
2.16 55
1.80 46
5.50 140
(1)
2.35 60
4.94 126
3.00 76
8.28 211
(2)
(1) (3)
2.35 60
(2)
(3)
9007CK
9007CKC
9007CL
0.58 15 0.07 2
0.78 20
0.78 20
0.78 20
6.29 160
8.14 207
16.08 409
2.28 58
9.07 231
(1)
2.35 60
(1)
2.35 60
(2)
(2)
(1) (3)
2.35 60
(3)
1.17 30 1.55 39
(2)
(3)
1.17 30 1.55 39
0.64 16 1.79 45
0.64 16 1.79 45
1.17 30 1.55 39
0.64 16 1.79 45
Dual dimensions:
1. 2. 3.
in. mm
2 x 0.20/5 x 0.22/6 HLS. 2 x 10-24 Tapped HLS Back Mtg 0.29/7 DP. 1/2 14 NPT.
Limit Switches
1.17 30 1.55 39
0.64 16 1.79 45
1.17 30 1.55 39
0.64 16 1.79 45
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
DimensionsCompact Body
9007C52G
2.16 55 1.41 36 0.58 15 1.24 31 3.14 (3) 80 1.47 37
9007C52GD
2.71 Min. 69 1.96 Min. 50 0.58 15 1.24 31 3.14 (3) 80 1.47 37
9007C52H
3.12 79 1.44 37
0.63 16 0.75 19
0.78 20 0.12 3
0.36 9 0.75 19
0.78 20
0.78 20
1.68 43 0.58 15
0.37 9 0.75 19
1.24 31
0.78 20
0.75 19
3.14 (3) 80
1.47 37
(3) (2)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45
3.14 80
(1)
1.17 30 1.55 39
(2)
0.64 16 1.79 45
(1)
1.17 30 1.55 39
(2)
0.64 16 1.79 45
(1)
1.17 30 1.55 39
(2)
0.64 16 1.79 45
(1)
Dual dimensions:
1. 2. 3. 4.
in. mm
2 x 0.20/5 HLS. 2 x 10-24 Tapped HLS Back Mtg 0.20/5 DP. 1/2 14 NPT. Adjustable.
9007C52E
0.36 9 1.72 44 1.47 37 0.58 15
9007C52ED
0.19 (4) 5 0.58 15
0.50 13
0.12 3
0.78 20
0.78 20
2.19 56 3.78 97
2.25 57
(3) (2)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45
(3) (2)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45
3.62 93
4.15 105
1.47 37
(3) (2)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45
(1)
(1)
(1)
Limit Switches
Dual dimensions:
1. 2. 3. 4.
in. mm
2 x 0.20/5 HLS. 2 x 10-24 Tapped HLS Back Mtg 0.20/5 DP. 1/2 14 NPT. Adjustable.
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
DimensionsCompact Body
(3)
Dual dimensions:
(1)
1.17 30 1.55 39
(2)
0.64 16 1.79 45
1. 2. 3.
in. mm
2 x 0.20/5 x 0.22/6 HLS. 2 x 10-24 Tapped HLS Back Mtg 0.29/7 DP. 1/2 14 NPT.
9007C52J
0.78 20 0.25 6 5.50 140 4.06 104 3.00 76 7.40 189
0.58 15
0.25 6
0.78 20
0.58 15
2.16 55 1.47 37
1.80 46
(3) (2)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45
1.47 37
(3) (2)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45
(1)
(1)
9007C52K
9007C52KC
9007C52L
0.58 15 0.07 2 0.78 20
0.78 20
0.78 20
15.2 386
1.47 37
6.29 160
8.19 209
1.47 37
(3) (2)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45
(3) (2)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45 1.47 37
(3) (2)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45
(1)
(1)
(1)
Dual dimensions:
1. 2. 3.
in. mm
2 x 0.20/5 x 0.22/6 HLS. 2 x 10-24 Tapped HLS Back Mtg 0.29/7 DP. 1/2 14 NPT.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Adaptable Sub-Assemblies
9007 H
9007 G
9007 K
9007 L
9007 GD
Limit Switches
570
9007 E
9007 ED
9007 J
9007 D
9007 F
9007 JKC
9007 KC
9007 CT52 9007 CT54 9007 CO54 9007 CT62 9007 CO62 9007 CO52
09/2007
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Adaptable Sub-Assemblies
9007 MA11
9007 HA1
9007 FA1
9007 EA1
9007 FA6
9007 LA19
9007 AA1
9007 LA4
9007 KB11
9007 CA11
9007 BA3
9007 KA11
9007 HA21
9007 RA11
9007 HA23
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Adaptable Sub-Assemblies
Body with contacts for plunger or rotary heads
Plug-in Unit (Top) with contacts
DF563880
Type
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
0.19 (0.42)
Single pole
9007CO54
Two pole
4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 3 4 2
8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
9007CO62
0.20 (0.44)
9007CO66
0.23 (0.50)
DF563881
Neutral position
9007CO68
0.20 (0.45)
Single pole
9007CO52
0.18 (0.40)
Plug-in Receptacle (Base) with screw terminals (1) Type Type of contact Function diagram
3 4 2
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
0.22 (0.48)
9007CO62
DF563882
Single pole
9007CT54
Two pole
4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1
8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5 4
9007CT62
0.22 (0.48)
Neutral position
9007CT62
0.22 (0.48)
Limit Switches
9007CT54
Two stage
DF563883
4 3 2 1
9007CT62
0.22 (0.48)
3 1 3
9007CT54
2 4 2
0.22 (0.48)
Single pole
9007CT52
0.15 (0.34)
Acceptable wire sizes: 12-22 AWG (2.05 mm2-0.644mm2). Recommended terminal clamp torque: 7 lb-in (0.80 Nm). Reed switches: plug-in switches less heads are not available as separate units. Order complete plug-in unit with a head. Example: 9007C084B2.
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Adaptable Sub-Assemblies
Heads for linear, rotary and multi-directional movements
Side plunger heads
DF563884 DF563885
Type of operator Side roller plunger, spring return, vertical roller (1) Side push rod plunger, spring return Side push rod plunger, adjustable spring return Side push rod plunger, maintained contact Top plunger heads Type of operator Top roller plunger, spring return Top push rod plunger, spring return Top push rod plunger, adjustable spring return Palm operated turret head without mushroom button Mushroom button see Accessories (below) Rotary heads (without lever arm type) Type of Type of operator direction CW & CCW Standard pre-travel spring return CW & CCW Low differential spring return Neutral position CW & CCW Standard pre-travel spring return Neutral position CW & CCW Low differential spring return CW & CCW Extra light operating torque spring return Maintained contact
CW (trip) CCW (reset)
Catalog number
9007F 9007G 9007GD 9007H
Weight kg (lb)
0.16 (0.36) 0.15 (0.34) 0.16 (0.36) 0.16 (0.36)
9007F
DF564138 DF563886
9007GD
Catalog number
9007D 9007E 9007ED 9007R
Weight kg (lb)
0.12 (0.26) 0.11 (0.24) 0.12 (0.27) 0.13 (0.28)
9007H 9007D
DF563887
Catalog number
9007B 9007A 9007T10 9007T5 9007N 9007C
Weight kg (lb)
0.19 (0.41) 0.19 (0.41) 0.16 (0.36) 0.16 (0.36) 0.18 (0.40) 0.19 (0.41)
9007ED
DF563888
DF563889
Weight kg (lb)
0.19 (0.41) 0.20 (0.43) 0.26 (0.57) 0.17 (0.37)
9007C
DF563890
9007JKC
DF563891
Accessories
Description Diameter in. (mm)
1.38 (35)
Color
Black Red Green Yellow Black Red Green Yellow
Catalog number
2358C6G3 2358C6G2 2358C6G6 2358C6G8 2358C22G3 2358C22G6 2358C22G8
Weight kg (lb)
0.03 (0.06) 0.03 (0.06) 0.03 (0.06) 0.03 (0.06) 0.05 (0.10) 0.05 (0.10) 0.05 (0.10)
9007J
9007L
Description (2)
Type of extension
Delrin extension
Catalog number
9007WJ 9007WK 9007WKC
Weight kg (lb)
0.01 (0.03) 0.01 (0.02) 0.02 (0.04)
Coil spring extension Field convertible to horizontal. Acceptable wire sizes: 12-22 AWG (2.05 mm2-0.644mm2). Recommended terminal clamp torque: 7 lb-in (0.80 Nm).
Limit Switches
Wobble stick, Delrin extension (2) Wobble stick, wire extension (2) Wobble stick, coil spring extension (2) Cat whisker
0.22 (0.48)
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Lever Arms for Rotary Heads
Cast zinc lever arms with standard roller
Lever arms with steel roller (1)
DF563135
Catalog number
9007AA1 9007AA2 9007BA11 9007BA12 9007BA1 9007BA2 9007MA11 9007MA12 9007MA1 9007MA2 9007CA11 9007CA12 9007CA1 9007CA2 9007DA11 9007DA12 9007DA1 9007DA2 9007EA11 9007EA12 9007EA1 9007EA2
Weight kg (lb)
0.02 (0.05) 0.03 (0.07) 0.03 (0.07) 0.05 (0.10) 0.03 (0.07) 0.04 (0.08) 0.03 (0.07) 0.05 (0.11) 0.03 (0.06) 0.05 (0.10) 0.04 (0.08) 0.05 (0.12) 0.04 (0.08) 0.05 (0.10) 0.05 (0.10) 0.06 (0.13) 0.04 (0.08) 0.05 (0.11) 0.05 (0.10) 0.06 (0.14) 0.04 (0.09) 0.06 (0.14)
1.38 (35)
0.63 (16)
0.75 (19)
1.5 (38)
0.63 (16) 0.75 (19)
DF563899
2 (51)
0.63 (16) 0.75 (19)
2.5 (63.5)
0.63 (16)
9007AA1
0.75 (19)
3 (76)
DF563900
0.63 (16)
Catalog number
9007AA8 9007AA17 9007BA18 9007BA8 9007BA17 9007BA4 9007BA13 9007MA18 9007MA8 9007MA17 9007MA4 9007MA13 9007CA18 9007CA8 9007CA17 9007CA4 9007CA13 9007DA18 9007DA8 9007DA17 9007DA4 9007DA13 9007EA18 9007EA8 9007EA17 9007EA4 9007EA13
Weight kg (lb)
0.02 (0.05) 0.03 (0.07) 0.03 (0.07) 0.05 (0.10) 0.05 (0.11) 0.03 (0.06) 0.05 (0.10) 0.03 (0.06) 0.05 (0.10) 0.05 (0.10) 0.05 (0.10) 0.05 (0.12) 0.05 (0.10) 0.03 (0.06) 0.03 (0.07) 0.05 (0.12) 0.06 (0.14) 0.03 (0.07) 0.06 (0.13) 0.06 (0.13) 0.06 (0.14) 0.07 (0.15) 0.04 (0.08) 0.06 (0.14) 0.07 (0.16) 0.07 (0.15) 0.08 (0.17)
9007MA11
DF531684
9007EA1
0.25 (6.3) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 1.38 (35) 0.25 (6.3) 1 (25.4) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 1.5 (38) 0.25 (6.3) 1 (25.4) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 2 (51) 0.25 (6.3) 1 (25.4) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 2.5 (63.5) 0.25 (6.3) 1 (25.4) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 3 (76) 0.25 (6.3) 1 (25.4) 0.63 (16) 1. Material is hardened, oil-impregnated, sintered iron.
DF531698
Limit Switches
9007CA11
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Lever Arms for Rotary Heads
Cast zinc lever arms (continued)
Lever arms with ball bearing roller
DF563135
Arm Length (a) in. (mm) 0.88 (22) 1.38 (35) 1.5 (38) 2 (51) 2.5 (63.5) 3 (76) Lever arm Length (a) in. (mm) 0.88 (22) 1.38 (35)
Ball bearing roller Diameter (b) Width (c) in. (mm) in. (mm)
0.69 (17.5) 0.69 (17.5) 0.69 (17.5) 0.69 (17.5) 0.69 (17.5) 0.69 (17.5) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3)
Catalog number
9007AA9 9007BA9 9007MA9 9007CA9 9007DA9 9007EA9
Weight kg (lb)
0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09)
Catalog number
9007AA5 9007AA6 9007BA15 9007BA5 9007BA6 9007MA15 9007MA5 9007MA6 9007CA15 9007CA5 9007CA6 9007DA15 9007DA5 9007DA6 9007EA15 9007EA5 9007EA6
Weight kg (lb)
0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09) 0.04 (0.09)
1.5 (38)
2 (51)
2.5 (63.5)
3 (76)
Catalog number
9007MA31 9007CA31 9007DA31
Lever arms with cable operated with eyebolt (I.D.) instead of roller
Cable Length in. (mm)
0.38 (9.6)
Catalog number
9007MA22
Weight kg (lb)
0.05 (0.10)
Limit Switches
Weight kg (lb)
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Lever Arms for Rotary Heads
Flat steel lever arms with standard roller (1)
b c
Arm Length (a) in. (mm) Lever arms with steel roller 0.88 (22) 1.38 (35) 2 (51)
DF563135
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
2.5 (63.5) 3 (76) Lever arms with nylon roller 1.38 (35) 1.5 (38) 2 (51) 2.5 (63.5) 3 (76) Lever arms without roller 0.88 (22) 1.38 (35) 2 (51) 2.5 (63.5) 3 (76)
1.
9007AA1S 9007AA2S 9007BA1S 9007BA2S 9007CA1S 9007CA2S 9007DA1S 9007DA2S 9007EA1S 9007EA2S 9007BA4S 9007MA18S 9007CA4S 9007DA4S 9007EA4S 9007AA0S 9007BA0S 9007CA0S 9007DA0S 9007EA0S
0.01 (0.03) 0.01 (0.03) 0.01 (0.03) 0.01 (0.03) 0.03 (0.07) 0.04 (0.08) 0.04 (0.08) 0.04 (0.08) 0.04 (0.08) 0.04 (0.08) 0.01 (0.03) 0.01 (0.03) 0.03 (0.07) 0.04 (0.08) 0.04 (0.08)
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
1.5 (38)
9007LA4 9007LA1 9007LA5 9007LA2 9007LA6 9007LA3 9007LA16 9007LA10 9007LA17 9007LA11 9007LA18 9007LA12 9007LA7 9007LA8 9007LA9
0.05 (0.12) 0.07 (0.15) 0.05 (0.12) 0.07 (0.15) 0.05 (0.12) 0.07 (0.15) 0.04 (0.09) 0.06 (0.14) 0.04 (0.09) 0.06 (0.14) 0.04 (0.09) 0.06 (0.14) 0.11 (0.25) 0.11 (0.25) 0.11 (0.25)
Limit Switches
9007LA4
1.5 (38)
1.5 (38)
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Lever Arms for Rotary Heads
One-way lever arm
DF563135
Arm
b c
Steel roller Diameter (b) in. (mm) Width (c) in. (mm) Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
0.75 (19)
0.25 (6.3)
9007RA11
0.05 (0.12)
Roller Diameter (b) in. (mm) Width (c) in. (mm) Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
9007RA11
DF531683
9007BA3
3 (76)
0.25 (6.3) 0.63 (16) 0.25 (6.3) 0.63 (16) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3)
0.04 (0.08) 0.04 (0.08) 0.04 (0.09) 0.05 (0.12) 0.04 (0.10) 0.04 (0.10)
2 (51)
0.44 (11)
DF531691
1.5 (38)
0.88 (22)
Limit Switches
Weight kg (lb)
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Lever Arms for Rotary Heads
DF563136
d b c
a: Length of lever arm b: Roller diameter c: Roller width d, e, f: see page 581
Non-bendable, adjustable from 0.63 (16) 0.88 (22) to 4 (101) 0.63 (16) Bendable, adjustable from 0.88 (22) to 4 (101)
0.63 (16) 0.63 (16)
e
DF531688
Non-bendable, adjustable from 0.88 (22) to 4 (101) Bendable, adjustable from 0.88 (22) to 4 (101)
0.25 (6.3) 0.63 (16) 0.25 (6.3) 0.63 (16) 0.25 (6.3)
0.05 (0.12) 0.06 (0.13) 0.06 (0.14) 0.07 (0.16) 0.08 (0.17)
DF531687
DF531689
Adjustable length arm with ball bearing roller Non-bendable, adjustable from 0.88 (22) to 4 (101) Bendable, adjustable from 0.88 (22) to 4 (101)
0.69 (17.5) 0.25 (6.3) 9007HA24 0.06 (0.13)
0.69 (17.5)
0.25 (6.3)
9007HA25
0.07 (0.16)
Adjustable length arm with ball Delrin roller Bendable, adjustable from 0.88 (22) to 4 (101)
1.63 (41) 0.25 (6.3) 9007HA20 0.07 (0.16)
9007HA1
DF531687
9007HA23
DF531687
9007HA21
Adjustable length arm with rubber tire roller Bendable, adjustable from 0.88 (22) to 4 (101)
2.13 (54) 0.5 (12.7) 9007HA21 0.10 (0.22)
Adjustable length arm without roller Non-bendable, adjustable from 0.88 (22) to 4 (101) Bendable, adjustable from 0.88 (22) to 4 (101)
9007HA0 0.15 (0.33)
DF531697
Limit Switches
9007FA1 9007FA6 9007LA19 Dimensions: page 581
9007HA9
0.11 (0.25)
Weight kg ( lb)
2.5 (63.5)
9007LA19
0.06 (0.13)
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Lever Arms for Rotary Heads
360 angular adjustable lever arm
360 angular adjustable lever arm Length (a) Roller (1) in. (mm) position Lever arms with steel roller Roller Diameter (b) Width (c) in. (mm) in. (mm)
0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.63 (16) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3)
Catalog number
Weight kg (lb)
d b c e
0.88 (22)
1.38 (35)
1.5 (38)
f
a: Length of lever arm b: Roller diameter c: Roller width d, e: see page 581 2 (51)
2.5 (63.5)
Roller outside Roller inside Roller outside Roller outside Roller inside Roller outside Roller outside Roller inside Roller outside Roller outside Roller inside Roller outside Roller outside Roller inside Roller outside Roller outside Roller inside Roller outside
9007AA1M 9007AA5M 9007AA11M 9007BA1M 9007BA5M 9007BA11M 9007MA1M 9007MA5M 9007MA11M 9007CA1M 9007CA5M 9007CA11M 9007DA1M 9007DA5M 9007DA11M 9007EA1M 9007EA5M 9007EA11M 9007AA8M 9007AA18M 9007BA8M 9007BA18M 9007MA8M 9007MA18M 9007CA8M 9007CA18M 9007DA8M 9007DA18M 9007EA8M 9007EA18M 9007AA9M 9007BA9M 9007MA9M 9007CA9M 9007DA9M 9007EA9M
0.09 (0.20) 0.09 (0.20) 0.09 (0.20) 0.09 (0.22) 0.10 (0.22) 0.10 (0.22) 0.11 (0.24) 0.11 (0.24) 0.11 (0.24) 0.11 (0.24) 0.11 (0.24) 0.11 (0.25) 0.11 (0.25) 0.12 (0.27) 0.12 (0.27) 0.12 (0.27) 0.12 (0.27) 0.13 (0.29) 0.09 (0.20) 0.09 (0.20) 0.11 (0.25) 0.11 (0.25) 0.10 (0.23) 0.11 (0.25) 0.12 (0.27) 0.12 (0.27) 0.12 (0.27) 0.12 (0.27) 0.12 (0.26) 0.12 (0.27) 0.10 (0.23) 0.11 (0.24) 0.19 (0.26) 0.19 (0.26) 0.12 (0.27) 0.13 (0.28)
3 (76)
Lever arms with nylon roller 0.88 (22) 1.38 (35) 1.5 (38) 2 (51) 2.5 (63.5) 3 (76)
Roller outside Roller outside Roller outside Roller outside Roller outside Roller outside
Lever arms with ball bearing roller Roller outside 0.69 (17.5) 0.88 (22) Roller outside 0.69 (17.5) 1.38 (35) Roller outside 0.69 (17.5) 1.5 (38) Roller outside 0.69 (17.5) 2 (51) Roller outside 0.69 (17.5) 2.5 (63.5) Roller outside 0.69 (17.5) 3 (76)
1.
Roller can be changed in the field from roller outside to roller inside position or vice versa.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Bodies and Heads, Dimensions
Body
Standard
0.58 15 0.36 9 (1) 2.35 60 0.78 20
Compact
0.58 15 0.78 20 0.36 9 1.47 37
Dual dimensions:
(3)
in. mm
(3) (2)
1.17 30 1.55 39 0.64 16 1.79 45
Dual dimensions:
1. 2. 3.
in. mm
(2)
1. 2. 3.
1.17 30 1.55 39
0.64 16 1.79 45
2 x 0.20/5 x 0.22/6 HLS. 2 x 10-24 Tapped HLS Back Mtg 0.29/7 DP. 1/2 14 NPT.
(1)
2 x 0.20/5 HLS. 2 x 10-24 Tapped HLS Back Mtg 0.20/5 DP. 1/2 14 NPT.
9007G
2.16 55 1.41 36 0.58 15 1.24 31
9007GD
2.71 Min. 69 1.96 Min. 50 0.58 15 0.88 22 1.24 31
9007H
3.12 79 1.44 37
0.63 16 0.75 19
0.78 20
0.12 3 0.88 22
0.36 9 0.75 19
0.78 20
1.68 43 0.58 15
0.78 20 0.88 22
9007E
0.58 15
9007ED
(1) 0.19 5
0.58 15 0.50 13 0.78 20
0.63 16 1.88 48
0.12 3
0.78 20 1.36 35
2.19 56
2.25 57
1.89 48
1.
Adjustable
1.55 39
1.55 39
1.55 39
Rotary heads
Multi-directional heads
9007JKC 9007J
0.58 15 0.78 20 5.50 140 1.80 46 3.00 76 0.25 6 5.14 131 0.78 20
Limit Switches
9007C
9007KC
0.78 20
0.58 15
0.25 6
5.00 127
1.80 46
1.55 39
1.55 39
1.55 39
1.55 39
9007L
0.58 15 0.07 2 5.93 151 0.78 20
1.55 39
1.55 39
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialPlug-in Body, Metal
Lever Arms for Rotary Heads, Dimensions
Lever arms 9007AA, BA, CA, DA, EA, FA, KA, LA, MA, RA
b c
a: Length of lever arm b: Roller diameter c: Roller width d = 0.38/10 e= 4.38/111 a, b, c: page 578
0.34 86
360 angular adjustable lever arms 9007AAM, 9007BAM, 9007CAM, 9007DAM, 9007EAM, 9007MAM
d b c e
0.88 22 f
a, b, c: page 579
9007FA6
2.06 52
9007LA19
10.72 272
0.13 3.3
45
5 2. 3.5 6
1.19 30
0.67 17
2.56 65
0.66 17
1.00 25
0.41 10
0.41 10 0.80 20
0.41 10 1.00 25
0.41 10 1.00 25
Limit Switches
a: Length of lever arm b: Roller diameter c: Roller width d = 0.84/21 e = 0.38/10 f = 1.05/27
0.69 17.5
0. 78 .8 19
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialNon-Plug-in Body, Metal
Hazardous Location
Hazardous Non-Plug-in Body Type (1)
With head for linear movement side plunger top plunger
Page 584
Page 585
1.
Page 586
Page 587
Limit Switches
Classes The Classes (I, II, III) differentiate between the type of hazardous materials: I is for gases, II is for dusts, and III is for fibers. Groups The Groups (A, B, C, D, E, F, and G) further subdivide each class according to the relative explosive force of the materials. Group A atmosphere is acetylene which has a higher explosive force than Group B (which may contain hydrogen, for example); and Group B has a higher explosive force than Group D, etc. Divisions The Divisions (1 and 2) refer to the presence of these hazardous gases and dusts. Division 1 areas can have these gases or dusts present at all times under normal operating conditions in an ignitable concentration. Division 2 areas only have ignitable concentrations of dusts or gases present during abnormal conditions, such as machine failures or container breakage.
Group
A. Acetylene B. Manufactured Gases Containing Hydrogen C. Petrochemicals (e.g. ethylene) D. Petrochemicals (e.g. alcohol) A. Acetylene B. Manufactured Gases Containing Hydrogen C. Petrochemicals (e.g. ethylene) D. Petrochemicals (e.g. alcohol) E. Conductive and Combustible Dust (Resistivity y105 ohms/cm) F. Carbonaceous Dusts (Resistivity >102 ohm/cm but < 108ohm/cm) G. Non-Conductive Combustible Dust (Resistivity > = 105 ohms/cm) G. Non-Conductive Combustible Dust (Resistivity > = 105 ohms/cm) Easily Ignitable Fibers Easily Ignitable Fibers
I. Gas
2. Potential Hazard A. May be present in atmosphere only under abnormal circumstances. 1. Hazard May Exist
II. Dust
May Exist In Atmosphere Under Normal Operating Conditions 2. Potential Hazard A. May be present in atmosphere only under abnormal circumstances. 1. Production Areas 2. Handling and Storage Areas
III. Fibers
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialNon-Plug-in Body, Metal
Hazardous Location
Environmental characteristics
Conforming to standards Product certifications Protective treatment Ambient air temperature (Lever/rotary head) Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Cable entry or connector Materials Products Machine assemblies
NEMA 250, EN 60947-1, EN 60947-5-1, IEC 60947, UL 508, C22-2-14-95, CE conformity documentation IEC 60204-1 UL, CSA, CE Epoxy powder coat
-20+185 F (-29+85 C), wider range available -20+185 F (-29+85 C), wider range available 25 gn (10150 Hz, 11 ms) (C86F switch good for 18.5g only) 60 gn (9 ms)
Conforming to IEC 60068-2-27 40 gn (9 ms) for reed switch Class 0 Conforming to IEC 61140 IP 67 Conforming to IEC 60529 1/2-14 NPT, M20 X 1.5, ISO cable entry, 5-pin mini connector, 4-pin micro connector Depending on model Bodies in aluminum, heads in Zamak zinc alloy, levers and rods in zinc, steel, stainless steel, Delrin resin. Bodies, heads, levers 9007CR53 (single pole) 9007CR61 (two pole) 9007CR65 (two pole two stage) 9007CR67 (two pole neutral) 9007CR53 (single pole) 9007CR61 (two pole) 9007CR65 (two pole two stage) 9007CR67 (two pole neutral)
NEMA A600 (Ue = 600 V, Ie = 1.2 A); Ithe = 10 A NEMA A600 (Ue = 600 V, Ie = 1.2 A); Ithe = 10 A NEMA A600 (Ue = 600 V, Ie = 1.2 A); Ithe = 10 A NEMA A600 (Ue = 600 V, Ie = 1.2 A); Ithe = 10 A NEMA Q600 (Ue = 600 V. Ie = 0.1 A); Ithe = 2.5 A NEMA R300 (Ue = 250 V. Ie = 0.11 A); Ithe = 1.0 A NEMA R300 (Ue = 250 V. Ie = 0.11 A); Ithe = 1.0 A NEMA R300 (Ue = 250 V. Ie = 0.11 A); Ithe = 1.0 A 600 V 2,500 Vac for 1 minute for CE; 2,200 Vac for 1 minute for UL; and 2,640 Vac for 1 s for CSA Special Y1561 (one pole slow break only) 10 A Bussmann Class CC KTK-R-10 fuse non-time-delay 1 or 2, 1222 AWG (2.050.644 mm2) wires maximum 50 fpm / 90 fpm (15.2 m/min / 27.4 m/min) with 45 degree cam angle, levers only 1 million operating cycles
Rated insulation voltage Rated Impulse Withstand Voltage Positive Opening Special Y1561 Short Circuit Protection Terminal wire sizes (Cabling/Screw Clamp) Maximum Actuation Speed Electrical Durability
Form A
Symbol
Form A
Symbol
Description
Form 3
Symbol
Description
X B Single break B 2
Double break
Y C C 1
Za
Same polarity
Double break
Zb
Electrically separate
Limit Switches
IEC 60947-5-1
NEMA
JIS
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialNon-Plug-in Body, Metal
Hazardous Location
Type of head Side Plunger (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Side roller plunger Side push rod plunger spring return vertical roller spring return (1)
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. 1 N.C. snap action
3 1 4 2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53F
2
9007CR53G
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53GD
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53H
3.6 6.3 mm
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
9007CR61F
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61G
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61GD
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61H
3.6
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
6.3 mm
9007CR65F
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65G
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65GD
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
1.020 (2.25)
1.020 (2.25)
1.020 (2.25)
Limit Switches
Total travel Differential Reverse overtravel Minimum force or torque 1 pole & 2 pole Terminal wire sizes (Cabling/Screw Clamp) Repeatability (linear travel of cam) Cable entry
1. 2.
Can be converted to horizontal roller type in the field. To order horizontal roller version add the letter H at the end of the equivalent vertical roller version type. To lock the nut in the desired position, crimp the slot near the bottom of the nut.
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialNon-Plug-in Body, Metal
Hazardous Location
Type of head Top Plunger (mounting by the body)
Type of operator
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. 1 N.C. snap action
3 1 4 2
9007CR53D
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53E
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53ED
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53R (2)
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
0.5
6.3 mm
0.5
6.3 mm
0.5
6.3 mm
0.5
6.3 mm
9007CR61D
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61E
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61ED
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61R (2)
2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
0.8
6.3 mm
9007CR65D
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65E
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65ED
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65R (2)
2 2.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
0.8 0.8
6.3 mm
1.020 (2.25)
1.020 (2.25)
1.020 (2.25)
Type of actuation
Pre-travel Pre-travel two Stage First stage First stage to second stage
2 mm (0.08 in.) 2 mm (0.08 in.) 0.3 mm (0.01 in.) 6.3 mm (0.25 in.) 0.5 mm (0.02 in.) 3 lb (13.3 N) 1 or 2, 1222 AWG (2.050.644 mm2) wires maximum 0.03 mm (0.001 in.) 1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry 7 lb (31.1 N)
Total travel Differential Reverse overtravel Minimum force or torque 1 pole & 2 pole Terminal wire sizes (Cabling/Screw Clamp) Repeatability (linear travel of cam) Cable entry
1. 2.
To lock the nut in the desired position, crimp the slot near the bottom of the nut. Does not include mushroom button. Must be ordered separately see page 573.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialNon-Plug-in Body, Metal
Hazardous Location
Type of head Rotary (lever arm type) (1)
Type of operator Type of direction Catalog numbers 1 N.O. 1 N.C. snap action
3 1 4 2
Neutral position Standard pre-travel Low differential spring return spring return CW & CCW CW & CCW
9007CR53B2
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53A2
5
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53N2
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53C
45 90
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
90
90
90
9007CR61B2
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61A2
5
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61N2
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61C
45
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
90
90
90
90
9007CR67T10
CCW
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR67T5
CW CCW
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
10 0 10
5 0 5
CW
90CCW 4
90CW 4
90CCW 2
90CW 2
9007CR65B2
10 12.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65A2
5 6.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65N2
10 12.5
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
4 4
90
2 2
90
4 4
90
CW
Limit Switches
1.020 (2.25) Weight, kg (lb) contact closed Contact operation Characteristics (nominal operating data) By 30 cam Switch actuation
1.020 (2.25)
1.020 (2.25)
1.020 (2.25)
1.020 (2.25)
Type of actuation Pre-travel Pre-travel two stage First stage First stage to second stage Total travel Differential Reverse overtravel Operating torque/force 1 pole & 2 pole Terminal wire sizes (Cabling/Screw Clamp) Repeatability (linear travel of cam) Cable entry
1. 2. 10 10 2.5 90 4 90 4 lb-in (0.45 Nm) 1 or 2, 1222 AWG (2.050.644 mm2) wires maximum 0.05 mm ( 0.002 in.) 0.03 mm ( 0.001 in.) 0.05 mm ( 0.002 in.) 0.05 mm ( 0.002 in.) 0.05 mm ( 0.002 in.) 0.05 mm ( 0.002 in.) 25 oz-in (0.18 Nm) 2 4 2 4 5 5 1.5 10 5 10 10 2.5 45 90 3 lb-in (0.34 Nm)
1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry
Lever arm type must be ordered separately from page 574 to 577. These devices are factory set to operate the contacts in both the CW and CCW directions. Mode of operation is field convertible to CW only or CCW only. To order factory converted devices: For CCW only operation, change the 2 at the end of the Type number to 1 (for example: C54B2 becomes C54B1). For CW only operation, delete the 2 at the end of the Type number (for example, C54B2 becomes C54B). Mode of operation of the lever arm is easily convertible to clockwise or both. Simply pull out and rotate the arrow to the letters representing the desired directionCW, CCW, or CW/CCW.
/CCW CW
CCW
CW
/C C W
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialNon-Plug-in Body, Metal
Hazardous Location
Type of head Flexible operator (wobble stick)
Type of operator
Universal (1)
Cat whisker
Catalog numbers
1 N.O. 1 N.C. snap action
3 1 4 2
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53JKC
10
9007CR53J
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53K
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53KC
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
9007CR53L
20
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4
90
90
90
90
90
9007CR61JKC
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61J
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61K
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61KC
10
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
9007CR61L
20
1-2 3-4 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
90
90
90
90
90
9007CR65JKC
10 14
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65J
10 14
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65K
10 14
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65KC
10 14
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
9007CR65L
20 25
1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8 1-2 3-4 5-6 7-8
3 3
90
3 3
90
3 3
90
3 3
90
6 6
90
1.020 (2.25)
1.020 (2.25)
1.020 (2.25)
1.020 (2.25)
Type of actuation Pre-travel Pre-travel two-stage First stage First stage to second stage Total travel Differential Reverse overtravel Operating torque/force 1 pole & 2 pole Terminal wire sizes (Cabling/Screw Clamp) Repeatability (linear travel of cam) Cable entry
1.
10 (any direction) 10 (any direction) 4 90 3 3 lb-in (0.34 Nm) 1 or 2, 1222 AWG (2.050.644 mm2) wires maximum 1/2-14 NPT standard, optional M20 x 1.5 mm for ISO cable entry
20 20 5 6
Wobble stick extensions are available separately for the universal head or as replacements for complete devices (see page 573)
Limit Switches
Switch actuation
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialNon-Plug-in Body, Metal
Hazardous LocationDimensions
Side Plunger 9007CF
3.24 62 1.88 48 1,68 43 1.07 27
9007CG
2.77 70 1.41 36 2.07 53 6.10 155
0.63 16 1.19 30
0.12 3
1.58 40
(1)
4.13 105
(3)
3.00 76
(1)
4.13 105
(3)
1.5 38 2.72 69
(2)
(4) (5)
1.1 28 2.08 53
1.01 26 0.34 9
1.5 38 2.72 69
(2)
(4) (5)
1.1 28 2.08 53
1.01 26 0.34 9
9007CGD
2.71 69 1.96 50
9007CH
3.12 79 1.44 37
1.07 27
1.68 43
1,68 43
(1)
4.13 105
(3)
3.00 76
(1)
4.13 105
(3)
1.5 38 2.72 69
(2)
(4) (5)
1.1 28 2.08 53
1.01 26 0.34 9
1.5 38 2.72 69
(2)
(4) (5)
1.1 28 2.08 53
1.01 26 0.34 9
Limit Switches
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
2 x 0.27/7, front Mtg holes. 2 x 0.63/16 1/4-20 DP UNC-2B back mounting holes. 2 x 0.26/7 dia. holes. 2 1/4-20 UNC-2B, both sides 0.32/8 DP. 1/2 or 3/4 NPT. Adjustable.
9007CE
0.36 9 0.75 19 1.07 27 2.16 55
9007CED
0.19 (6) 5 0.75 19 0.50 13 0.75 19
0.12 3
2.32 59
2.63 67
2.71 69
2.55 65
2.69 68
(1)
4.13 105
(3)
(1)
7.05 3.00 179 76
(3)
4.13 105
(1) (3)
1.5 38 2.72 69
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
(2)
(4) (5)
1.1 28 2.08 53
1.01 26 0.34 9
1.5 38 2.72 69
(2)
(4) (5)
1.1 28 2.08 53
1.01 26 0.34 9
1.5 38 2.72 69
1.01 26 0.34 9
2 x 0.27/7, front Mtg holes. 2 x 0.63/16 1/4-20 DP UNC-2B back mounting holes. 2 x 0.26/7 dia. holes, back Mtg. holes. 2 1/4-20 UNC-2B, both sides 0.32/8 DP. 1/2 or 3/4 NPT. Adjustable.
Dual dimensions:
in. mm
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty IndustrialNon-Plug-in Body, Metal
Hazardous LocationDimensions
Rotary 9007C
2.79 71
0.44 11
1.72 44
2.07 53
(1)
4.13 105
(3)
1.5 38 2.72 69
(2)
(4) (5)
1.1 28 2.08 53
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
2 x 0.27/7, front Mtg holes. 2 x 0.63/16 1/4-20 DP UNC-2B back mounting holes. 2 x 0.26/7 dia. holes, back Mtg. holes. 2 1/4-20 UNC-2B, both sides 0.32/8 DP. 1/2 or 1/4 NPT.
1.01 26 0.34 9
9007CJ
0.75 19 1.07 27 5.93 151 0.25 6 1.07 27
0.75 19
0.25 6
2.60 66
2.24 57
2.99 76
3.45 88
6.32 161
10.35 263
(1)
4.13 105
(3)
3.00 76
(1)
(3)
3.00 76
1.5 38 2.72 69
(2)
(4) (5)
1.1 28 2.08 53
1.01 26 0.34 9
1.5 38 2.72 69
(2)
(4) (5)
1.1 28 2.08 53
1.01 26 0.34 9
9007CK
0.75 19 0.08 2 1.07 27
9007CKC
9007CL
0.75 19 1.07 27 0.04 1
0.75 19 0.25 6
1.07 27
14.13 359
5.80 147
6.19 157,2
18.16 461
10.22 260
(1)
4.13 105
(3)
3.00 76
4.13 105
(1)
(3)
3.00 76 4.13 105
(1)
(3)
3.00 76
(4)
1.5 38 2.72 69
(4)
1.1 28 2.08 53 1.01 26 0.34 9
1.5 38 2.72 69
(4)
1.1 28 2.08 53 1.01 26 0.34 9 1.5 38 2.72 69
(2)
(5)
(2)
(5)
(2)
(5)
1.1 28 2.08 53
1.01 26 0.34 9
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
2 x 0.27/7, front Mtg holes. 2 x 0.63/16 1/4-20 DP UNC-2B back mounting holes. 2 x 0.26/7 dia. holes, back Mtg. holes. 2 1/4-20 UNC-2B, both sides 0.32/8 DP. 1/2 or 1/4 NPT.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty Industrial
Technical Information
Glossary
CCWCounterclockwise only (for lever types).
531627
Free position
CWClockwise only (for lever types). DifferentialThe movement differential or differential is the distance or angle from the operating position to the releasing position.
Operating position
l Overtrave
Free or normal positionFree or normal position is the initial position of the actuator when there is no external force (other than gravity) applied on the actuator. Neutral positionLever operated switch with a minimum of two contacts. One contact changes state only when lever moves CW. The second contact changes state only when the lever moves CCW. (The center position is the free position.) Operating positionOperating position is the position of the actuator at which the contacts change state. OvertravelOvertravel is the distance or angle through which the actuator moves when traveling from the operating position to the overtravel limit position. Pre-travelPre-travel is the distance or angle through which the actuator moves from the free position to the position at which the contacts change state, the operating position. Release positionRelease position is that position of the actuator at which the contacts change state from the operated contact position to the normal contact position. Release torqueRelease torque is the value to which the torque on the actuator must be reduced to allow the contacts to change state from the operated position to the normal contact position.
l ve tra
Operating torque
531628
Actuator-leverAn actuator is the mechanism of the switch or enclosure which, when moved as intended, will operate the contacts. Maintained contact limit switchA maintained contact limit switch is a switch which remains in a given condition until actuated to another condition, which is also maintained until further actuation. Momentary contact limit switchA momentary contact limit switch is a switch which returns from the operated condition to its free or normal circuit condition when the actuating force is removed.
Limit Switches
590
Operating force
N.C.Normally closed contact, when the switch mechanism is at its free or normal position. N.O.Normally open contact, when the switch mechanism is at its free or normal position.
Operating torqueOperating torque (force) is the minimum torque (force) value which must be applied to the actuator to cause the contacts to change state. Overtravel limit positionOvertravel limit position is that position of the actuator beyond which further overtravel would cause damage to the switch or actuator. RepeatabilityRepeatability is the ability to consistently maintain the original operating characteristics. Measured by the difference between the operating position of a new switch and of the same after 1 million operations. Total travelTotal travel is the sum of the pre-travel and overtravel. TravelMovement of the actuator from its free or normal position when force is applied. (See pretravel and over travel.)
09/2007
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty Industrial
Technical Information
Glossary (continued)
Definition of limit switch terms There are many terms common to position switches that are not used with other control devices. Before proceeding further, definitions of the commonly used terms should be understood as these terms will be used throughout this document.
Cam (dog) Position switch Actuator level type shown
531629
Limit switchA device that converts a mechanical motion into an electrical control signal. ActuatorThe mechanism of a limit switch that operates the contacts, i.e., lever arm, plunger, wobble stick.
L1
Coil
L2
CamA machine part or component that applies force to the switch actuator causing it to move as intended. Also known as dog. Cam track dimensionThe distance from the switch mounting surface to some point on the roller or actuator.
DifferentialThe distance that the limit switch actuator moves, from the trip point to the reset point of the contacts. Direct-acting/positive opening contactsNormally closed contacts that are moved directly by the operating shaft. They are slow make-slow break contacts and have a shorter life than snap action contacts due to longer arcing times. In general, these should only be used where movement of actuator must break welded contacts, as in a crane safety limit switch. (Snap action positive opening contacts are available in the Telemecanique XCKJ limit switch.) Maintained contactsContacts that remain in the tripped position until the return travel of the cam moves the switch actuator back and resets the contacts.
531630
Cam track
Lever inverted
Neutral (free or normal) position limit switchA lever arm type switch with two sets of contacts. One set operates when the shaft is rotated clockwise; the other operates when the shaft is rotated counterclockwise.
Coil
Operating forceThe force required to move limit switch actuator to cause the contacts to change state.
531631
PoleThe number of moveable contacts in a switching mechanism. A single pole device may be 1 N.O., 1 N.C. or 1 N.O. and 1 N.C. with a single set of moveable contacts is used to bridge those stationary contacts. A double or two pole switch has two moveable contacts.
Pre travel Differential Contacts trip Over travel
Positive break contactsNormally closed contacts with a special mechanism to ensure opening. Can be snap acting positive break or direct acting slow make, slow break type. The slow break direct acting type is not recommended for high cycle applications due to shorter life. Pre-travelThe distance that the limit switch actuator must move to trip the contacts. Reed contactsA mechanism consists of a set of contacts hermetically sealed in a glass envelope and actuated by a magnet attached to the operator. This sealed construction keeps contaminants out of the contact area, making the reed switch ideal for low voltage, low current circuits such as programmable controllers. Reset pointThe position of the actuator at which the contacts return to the normal position. Snap action contactsContacts that move rapidly to open or closed position and are relatively independent of cam speed. Because of shorter arcing times, snap acting contacts have longer contact life than slow make and break contacts and should be used where fast moving cams are encountered or where good repeat accuracy is required. Spring returnContacts that return to their original position when the actuating force is removed.
Limit Switches
OvertravelThe distance that the position switch actuator may move beyond the trip point, (see figure 5) without damage to the switch.
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty Industrial
Technical Information
Definition
Slow break contactsThe speed of transfer of the moveable contacts depends on the speed of the operator. The amount of travel of the moveable contacts is also dependent on the amount of travel by the operator. Slow make and break contacts have the same trip and reset points, and do not have the differential travel common to snap switches. Snap action contactsThe speed of transfer of the moveable contacts is not dependent on the speed of the operator. The amount of travel of the moveable contacts is also not dependent on the amount of travel by the operator. The movement of the moveable contacts are determined by a preset travel, after this point is reached, the contacts will trip. Snap action contacts have different trip and reset points, the difference is identified as differential. Flexible operatorsFlexible resilient or elastic operators, i.e., wobble sticks, do not ensure direct opening/positive opening action. Isolated contactsSingle-pole double-throw (SPDT) contacts with four terminals which have two isolated contact bars mechanically linked. No polarity restrictions apply. Different (isolated) power supplies can also be applied. Same polaritySingle-pole double throw (SPDT) contacts with four terminals that require the supply to be applied with the same polarity (i.e., L1 or +) on the same side of the contact bar. Two different supplies are not allowed in this configuration. (The loads should always be on the same side of the contact bar.) Direct opening contact (also known as positive opening contacts)A normally closed contact element coupled with the switch actuator via a non-resilient (non-elastic) member so that full contact opening is obtained when the actuator is moved through the direct opening travel by applying a direct opening force. The contact element will shear open in the event of sticking contacts or broken springs. Proper fusing of the control circuit is required. Direct opening contacts meet IEC 60947-5-1 requirements. Direct opening travel (also known as positive opening travel)Minimum travel from the actuator free position to the position where the direct opening operation is completed. Usually longer than the normal pre-travel.
Limit Switches
592
Reed contactsContact mechanism consists of a set of contacts hermetically sealed in a glass envelope and actuated by a magnet attached to the operator. This sealed construction keeps contaminants out of the contact area, making the reed switch the ideal switch for low voltage, low current circuits such as programmable controllers.
NOTE: Because reed switches are operated by a magnet, they should not be installed in areas where strong magnetic fields may be present. The devices should always be checked for proper operation after installation. Polarity Power sources
Opposite polarities should not be connected to the contacts of one limit switch unless the limit switch is specifically designed for such service (isolated contactsno polarity). See page 593.
Incorrect
Power from different sources should not be connected to the contacts of one limit switch unless the switch is specifically designed for such service (isolated contactsno polarity).
Incorrect
CR AC
Correct
DC
IM
09/2007
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty Industrial
Technical Information
531632
Overriding Cams
The cam trailing edge on overriding cams must also be considered for maximum switch life (see figure 6). Lever arm snap back causes shock loads which reduce switch life. Also, with reversing cams the trailing edge becomes a leading edge on the return stroke. The overtravel of the limit switch should not be exceeded, but 5 minimum to 15 travel past the trip point is recommended. Additional travel should only be used for set up and emergencies. Cam design procedures for limit switches with other than lever arm actuators vary from switch type to switch type and are discussed along with other limit switch application design suggestions in additional literature Proper Application of Limit Switches (SM444).
30
60
30
Recommended 0.72 min. overtravel 18 5 min. to 15 use additional 0.75 overtravel available 19 for set up and emergency only
Figure 6
Contacts
Make sure the electrical load is within limit switch contact ratings. The single pole, double throw contacts of a snap switch used in a limit switch should not be used on opposite polarities. When load M1 is connected between the contact and line L2, and load M2 is connected between the other contact and line L1 (figure 7), a line-to-line short (bold line) can occur through the arc, which may be drawn as the contacts operate. When contacts are connected to the same polarity (figure 8), this line-to-line short cannot occur. The same result can occur if different power sources are connected to the single-pole, double-throw contacts of a snap switch. With limit switches having reed contacts, some form of transient protection should be used. This protects the small contacts from damaging surges and increases contact life.
531633
L1 M1
L2
M2
Incorrect
L1 M1
Arc
L2
Coolant
When possible, avoid mounting limit switches where they will be constantly exposed to coolant, chips, etc. Although designed for such applications, switches last longer when not exposed to these contaminants. Make sure cover screws are tightened to ensure a good oiltight seal. When possible, avoid using fire-resistant coolants of the phosphate ester type. Equipment exposed to these coolants requires special seals and gaskets. Viton fluoroelastomer, resistant to these types of coolants, is the standard shaft seal material on Type C lever arm types. If required, all gaskets, as well as boots on plunger types, can be furnished in Viton material.
M2
531634
L1 M1
L2
M2
Correct
L1
Often a junction box fills with coolant and/or condensation, which backs up into the position limit through the conduit. A simple solution is to drill a hole in the bottom of the junction box to allow the liquid to drain out. If conduit leakage is severe, pre-wired and potted position limit (Forms Y184 and Y185) should be used. The switches are pre-wired with either individual wires or multiconductor STOWA cord, and the receptacle is sealed with a potting material. The Square D limit switch is available with a pre-wired male plug receptacle. The connector provides an effective oiltight seal when used with the appropriate female connector cord.
M2
Figure 8Contacts connected to same polarity. Line to line short cannot occur when contacts operate
Limit Switches
Figure 7Contacts connected to opposite polarities. Line to line short (bold line) can occur through arc drawn when contacts operate
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty Industrial
Technical Information
Terminal Identification
European (IEC) contact terminals marking Single pole
11-12 13-14 11-12 13-14
2nd pole
21-22 23-24 21-22 23-24
Each terminal is marked with 2 digits: First digit indicates the pole (circuit). The second digit indicates the type of contact: _1_2 is N.C., _3_4 is N.O. i.e.: 1112, 2122 are N.C. 1314, 2324 are N.O. Example of European Terminal Markings: For switch elements without isolated contacts: 11-12 Is the N.C. contact of pole No. 1, 13-14 Is the N.O. contact of pole No. 2 For switch elements with isolated contacts: 13-14 Is the N.O. contact of pole No. 1, 21-22 Is the N.C. contact of pole No. 2
Each contact terminal is marked with one digit, i.e., 1-2, 3-4, 5-6,7-8.
2nd pole
5-6 7-8 5-6 7-8
Example of US Terminal Markings: For most snap switch elements (isolated contacts not usually on US manufactured switches): 1-2 is the N.C. contact of pole No. 1, 3-4 is the N.O. contact of pole No. 1 5-6 is the N.C. contact of pole No. 2, 7-8 is the N.O. contact of pole No. 2
Make-before-break (overlapping) SPDT: the normally open contact closes before the normally closed contact opens. Break-before-make (offset) SPDT: the normally closed contact opens before the normally open contact closes. Simultaneous make and break SPDT: the normally closed contact opens at the same time as the normally open contact closes.
A B P
Contact closed Tripping Resetting Contact open
21 - 22 13 - 14 21 - 22 13 - 14
A = Maximum travel of the operator in mm or degrees. B = Tripping travel of the contact. C = Resetting travel of contact. D = B-C = Differential travel. P = Point from which positive opening is assured.
NOTE: The arrows indicate direction of actuation clockwise (CW) and return for simplicity reasons. For counterclockwise (CCW) only direction of actuation is reversed.
Limit Switches
0C
Wiring diagrams
Form A SPST-NO Form B SPST-NC Form C SPDT Form AA DPST-NO Form BB DPST-NC
Form CC DPDT
Form X SPST-NO-DB
Form Y SPST-NC-DB
Form Z DPDT-DB
Form XX DPST-NO-DB
Form YY DPST-NC-DB
Form ZZ DPDT-DB
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty Industrial
Cam Design
Application information
531666
Position 1 Cam
45
Position 2 Cam
45 P
60 P
30
Excessive impact from improperly designed actuating systems is without question the leading cause of premature failure of the electromechanical limit switch. At slow speed, impact is rarely troublesome, but as speed increases, impact applied to the switch becomes a critical problem. In todays higher speed machines, therefore, it is important to give proper consideration to correctly designed actuating systems. These recommendations are designed to assist you in obtaining greater life from your limit switches. The black sector in the roller indicates the recommended design limits of the angle of pressure shown in the illustrations as P. Three main design and installation considerations are:
The pressure applied by the actuating mechanism to switch operating lever should approximate direction of lever rotation with a variation not to exceed 30. Since the angle of pressure changes drastically with rotation of the lever, the cam must be designed for proper pressure angles at all positions of the lever travel. The switch operating levers should be positioned as nearly parallel with the leading edges of the cams as possible.
Figure 1B cam design for speeds from 50 to 200 fpm (15.2 to 60.9 mpm).
3 in. min. (76.2 mm) Cam
The cam in Figure 1A is satisfactory for speeds up to 50 fpm (15.2 mpm) The cam in Figure 1B is suitable for speeds up to 200 fpm (60.9 mpm) (nonuniform acceleration of switch lever) The cam in Figure 1C is satisfactory for speeds up to 400 fpm (121.9 mpm) (uniform or other controlled acceleration) Designing proper pressure angles for overriding cams for electromechanical limit switches Dont underestimate the importance of adjusting the cams and operating levers in electromechanical limit switches to provide the proper pressure angles in every travel position. Without the means to control the angle of pressure or the limit of override, the operating lever may spring back with damaging results. Lever flyback usually causes double pulsing of the contacts, and places additional stresses on the mechanical system of the limit switch. The excessive impacts absorbed from inadequately designed actuating devices eventually leads to abnormal wear and premature failure of the limit switch. By looking closely at the actuating angles of the cam surface, designers and engineers can obtain the maximum operating life from electromechanical limit switches. The following recommendations help provide a workable knowledge of proper lever and cam anglesand how they are applied to secure optimum conditions:
531668
15 to 30
Figure 1C cam design for speeds from 200 to 400 fpm (60.9 to 121.9 mpm).
30
Cam 30 max.
.
531669
Figure 2
531670
Cam
Actuating cam on machinery or slide should provide a trailing edge so that upon overriding the operating lever will not snap back. During the approach phase, the pressure angle of the cam should not vary from the lever angle more than 30. On the override phase, the angle of the trailing edge of the cam to the lever should be no more than 60.
60 max.
If these guidelines are followed, the switch operating levers will always be approximately parallel with the leading edges of the actuating surfaces or cams. Figure 2 shows leading edge of cam about to depress and actuate the electromechanical limit switch. The black sector of the roller indicates the recommended design limits of the angle of pressure shown in drawings as P. Figure 3 shows operating lever roller following the trailing edge of the cam on the override cycle. Unless a one-way lever is used, the cam will operate the switch on the return cycle.
Figure 3
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty Industrial
Linear/Angular Lever Travel
Application information (continued)
531671
The table below can assist the designer of machine tools and conveyors, the plant engineer, or the maintenance personnel responsible for keeping this equipment in a satisfactory operating condition. The design engineer will find the table useful in making trouble-free cam layouts. For example, if the recommended operating travel for a switch is between 15 and 30, use the table to figure cam rise and travel. This aids in determining what type of cam to design, its dimensions, etc. The plant engineer can use the table to determine where to position levers on replacement switches or revamped circuitry to operate existing cams. The engineer can also use the table to position the lever in proper relationship to the cam, and to find out whether switches and cams are installed properly to obtain maximum switch life. All dimensions in the table are for 1 in. (25.4 mm) levers. If you use longer levers, multiply the figures by the increased lever length. For example, for a 2 in. (50.8 mm) lever, use the multiplier 2. All limit switches have a recommended operating travel and for best performance should be installed within these limits. (1)
A B
0.0002 (0.005 mm) 0.0006 (0.015 mm) 0.0014 (0.035 mm) 0.002 (0.05 mm) 0.004 (0.101 mm) 0.005 (0.127 mm) 0.007 (0.178 mm) 0.010 (0.254 mm) 0.012 (0.304 mm) 0.015 (0.381 mm) 0.018 (0.457 mm) 0.022 (0.559 mm) 0.026 (0.660 mm) 0.030 (0.762 mm) 0.034 (0.863 mm) 0.039 (0.990 mm) 0.044 (1.12 mm) 0.049 (1.24 mm) 0.054 (1.37 mm) 0.060 (1.52 mm) 0.066 (1.67 mm) 0.073 (1.85 mm) 0.079 (2.00 mm) 0.086 (2.2 mm) 0.094 (2.38 mm) 0.101 (2.56 mm) 0.109 (2.77 mm) 0.117 (2.9 mm) 0.125 (3.17 mm) 0.134 (3.40 mm) 0.143 (3.6 mm) 0.152 (3.9 mm) 0.161 (4.1 mm) 0.171 (4.3 mm) 0.181 (4.6 mm) 0.191 (4.8 mm) 0.201 (5.1 mm) 0.212 (5.4 mm) 0.223 (5.7 mm) 0.234 (6.0 mm) 0.245 (6.2 mm) 0.257 (6.5 mm) 0.269 (6.8 mm) 0.281 (7.1 mm) 0.293 (7.4 mm)
A R
C = R sine A B = R (1-cosine A)
Per inch R
C
0.017 (0.43 mm) 0.035 (0.89 mm) 0.052 (1.3 mm) 0.070 (1.8 mm) 0.087 (2.2 mm) 0.105 (2.6 mm) 0.122 (3.1 mm) 0.139 (3.5 mm) 0.156 (4.0 mm) 0.174 (4.4 mm) 0.191 (4.8 mm) 0.208 (5.3 mm) 0.225 (5.7 mm) 0.242 (6.1 mm) 0.259 (6.6 mm) 0.276 (7.2 mm) 0.292 (7.4 mm) 0.309 (7.8 mm) 0.326 (8.3 mm) 0.342 (8.7 mm) 0.358 (9.1 mm) 0.375 (9.5 mm) 0.391 (9.9 mm) 0.407 (10.3 mm) 0.423 (10.7 mm) 0.438 (11.1 mm) 0.454 (11.5 mm) 0.469 (12 mm) 0.485 (12.3 mm) 0.500 (12.7 mm) 0.515 (13.1 mm) 0.530 (13.4 mm) 0.545 (14.0 mm) 0.559 (14.2 mm) 0.574 (14.6 mm) 0.588 (15 mm) 0.602 (15.3 mm) 0.616 (15.6 mm) 0.629 (16.0 mm) 0.643 (16.3 mm) 0.656 (16.6 mm) 0.669 (17.0 mm) 0.682 (17.3 mm) 0.695 (17.6 mm) 0.707 (18 mm)
A
46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90
B
0.305 (7.7 mm) 0.318 (8.1 mm) 0.331 (8.4 mm) 0.344 (8.7 mm) 0.357 (9.0 mm) 0.371 (9.4 mm) 0.384 (9.7 mm) 0.398 (10.1 mm) 0.412 (10.4 mm) 0.426 (11.0 mm) 0.441 (11.2 mm) 0.455 (11.5 mm) 0.485 (12.3 mm) 0.485 (12.3 mm) 0.500 (12.7 mm) 0.515 (13.1 mm) 0.531 (13.5 mm) 0.546 (14.0 mm) 0.562 (14.3 mm) 0.577 (14.6 mm) 0.593 15.0( mm) 0.609 15.5( mm) 0.625 (16.0 mm) 0.642 (16.3 mm) 0.658 (16.7 mm) 0.674 (17.1 mm) 0.691 (17.5 mm) 0.708 (18.0 mm) 0.724 (18.4 mm) 0.741 (19.0 mm) 0.758 (19.2 mm) 0.775 (20.0 mm) 0.792 (20.1 mm) 0.809 (20.5 mm) 0.826 (21.0 mm) 0.844 (21.4 mm) 0.861 (21.8 mm) 0.878 (22.3 mm) 0.895 (22.7 mm) 0.913 (23.2 mm) 0.930 (23.6 mm) 0.948 (24.0 mm) 0.965 (24.5 mm) 0.983 (25.0 mm) 1.000 (25.4 mm)
C
0.719 (18.2 mm) 0.731 (18.6 mm) 0.743 (18.9 mm) 0.755 (19.2 mm) 0.766 (19.4 mm) 0.777 (19.7 mm) 0.788 (20.0 mm) 0.799 (20.3 mm) 0.809 (20.5 mm) 0.819 (20.8 mm) 0.829 (21.0 mm) 0.839 (21.3 mm) 0.857 (21.7 mm) 0.857 (21.7 mm) 0.866 (22 mm) 0.875 (22.2 mm) 0.883 (22.4 mm) 0.891 (22.6 mm) 0.899 (22.8 mm) 0.906 (23.0 mm) 0.914 (23.2 mm) 0.921 (23.4 mm) 0.927 (23.5 mm) 0.934 (23.7 mm) 0.940 (23.9 mm) 0.946 (24.0 mm) 0.951 (24.1 mm) 0.956 (24.3 mm) 0.961 (24.4 mm) 0.966 (24.5 mm) 0.970 (24.6 mm) 0.974 (24.7 mm) 0.978 (24.8 mm) 0.982 (24.9 mm) 0.985 (25.0 mm) 0.988 (25.1 mm) 0.990 (25.1 mm) 0.993 (25.2 mm) 0.995 (25.3 mm) 0.996 (25.3 mm) 0.9976 (25.3 mm) 0.9986 (25.4 mm) 0.9994 (25.4 mm) 0.9999 (25.4 mm) 1.000 (25.4 mm)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 1.
Limit Switches
596
Refer to document SM444R1 for additional information regarding Cam speed and angles.
09/2007
Limit Switches
9007C Heavy Duty Industrial
Installation Considerations
Lever Actuators
For limit switches with lever actuators, the actuating force should be applied as nearly perpendicular to the lever as practical and perpendicular to the shaft axis about which the lever rotates.
Lever Actuators
Correct Incorrect
Dwelling Requirements
Where relatively fast motions are involved, the cams should be so designed that the limit switch will be held operated long enough to operate relays, valves, etc.
Correct
Dwell
Overtravel limitations
Operating mechanisms for limit switches should be so designed that, under any operating or emergency conditions, the limit switch is not operated beyond its overtravel limit position. A limit switch should not be used as a mechanical stop.
Incorrect
Incorrect Incorrect Correct
Correct
Correct
Free position Stop Operated position Stop End of overtravel
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007T and FT Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Conforming to NEMA A600 and UL508
Description
9007T Mill Switches Use the 9007T Mill switches instead of other limit switches in the following applications: Where the current load exceeds the typical heavy duty limit switch contact rating of 10 A and falls within the range of up to 20 A continuous. Where an operating sequence is required that is not possible on other limit switches. Fifteen sequences are available. Universal type has twelve different operating sequences with CW only, CCW only and neutral position. Standard type has three operating sequences with CW and CCW operation. Where higher reset forces are required due to foreign material interfering with lever arm operation, or where long heavy arms must reset against gravity. 9007FT Foundry Switches The 9007FT Foundry switches are for use in foundries or mills where the applications described above are required, and where falling foundry sand or similar material could build up and jam the operating mechanism. The shaft has a dust boot and extends from the switch case, preventing sand build up around the shaft. The devices can withstand hot falling sand up to 300 F (149 C.).
Page 600
Page 602
Application Information
Type T Ideal for applications requiring extra heavy duty contact ratings, or higher operating and reset forces. Rugged mechanical construction with several different operating sequences in one basic switch. Type FT Designed specifically for rough foundry application. The shaft is entirely beyond the switch case to prevent jamming of the lever arm due to build up of sand. A dust boot is furnished as standard to further prevent sand packing and allow free movement of the lever arm. An extra long shaft bearing makes the switch extremely rugged and able to handle the rough applications encountered in foundries, mills, machine tool and similar industries. The switch will withstand hot falling sand up to 300 F (149 C).
Limit Switches
Interpretation of Catalog Numbers: page 623
Type T and FT
Enclosure Oil-tight, dust-tight, water-tight, drip-tight meets NEMA Types 2, 4, and 13 requirements. Die cast zinc construction. Operating Sequences Fifteen sequences available. Universal type has 12 different operating sequences with CW only, CCW only, and neutral position operation. Standard type has three operating sequences with CW and CCW operation. Various sequences will give quick make and break, spring return with maintained contact, or slow make and break. Most sequences are convertible by removing the base plate and adjusting the positioning plate and/or latches Ambient Temperature Range 10 F (-12.2 C) to 185 F (85 C) ambient at full rated load, up to 220 F (104 C) ambient with single coil load. Lever Arm Die cast zinc construction with hardened, oil-impregnated, sintered iron rollers. Conduit 0.5 in. standard / 20 mm optionalForm M11 Mounting Four baseplates provide end or side mounting holes and/or manifold mounting. All mounting holes are 0.25 in. (6.35 mm) diameter. Two tapped holes on each side of switch allows side mounting. Contacts SPDT1 double break and three point double throw single break. Silver contact tips. Phenolic contact block. Nylon liner. Polarity must be the same on double throw contacts.
1. Single pole, double throw.
Limit Switches
9007T and FT Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Conforming to NEMA A600 and UL508
Environmental characteristics
Conforming to standards Product certifications Protective treatment Ambient air temperature Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Cable entry or connector Materials
UL508 UL Listed, CSA Certified, CE Marked Corrosion resistant gray paint -10 to +185 F (-23 to +85 C) 10G (1055 Hz) 30G Class 0 NEMA Types 1, 2, 4, 12, 13, IP65, 66, 67 1/2" NPT (metric available) Cast zinc n
AC Voltage DC Voltage
NEMA A600 Ithe = 20 A 20 A Resistive and continuous NEMA P 600 Ithe = 20 A 20 A Resistive and continuous 600 V 2,500 Vac for 1 minute for CE, 2,200 Vac for 1 minute for UL, and 2,640 Vac for 1 minute for CSA No 20 A Bussmann Class CC KTK-R-20 fuse, non-time-delay 12 22 AWG (3.31 mm2 0.326 mm2) wire max. 15.2 mpm / 27.4 mpm (50 fpm / 90 fpm) with 45 Cam angle, levers only
Inductive and Resistive Volts Make and Break Amperes Single Throw
120 250 600 5.0 1.0 0.2
Break VA
18,000 18,000 18,000 18,000 7200 7200 7200 7200
Amperes
20 12.5 6.25 5 6 3 1.5 1.2
VA
2400 3000 3000 3000 720 720 720 720
Double Throw
f Many switches are available with higher or lower temperature limits by selecting special versions or special options. See page 621.
Limit Switches
20 20 20
Limit Switches
9007T Severe Duty Mill Switches
Universal Operating Sequences
Universal Catalog Numbers
Base Plate Surface Mounted A B C D
9007TUA1 9007TUB1 9007TUC1 9007TUD1 9007TUA2 9007TUB2 9007TUC2 9007TUD2 9007TUA3 9007TUB3 9007TUC3 9007TUD3 9007TUA4 9007TUB4 9007TUC4 9007TUD4 9007TUA5 9007TUB5 9007TUC5 9007TUD5 9007TUA6 9007TUB6 9007TUC6 9007TUD6
No. 1
SPDT Spring Return CW Only Initial position and CCW
A B
No. 2
SPDT Spring Return CW Only Initial position and CCW
A B
No. 3
SPDT Maintained Contact Spring return of arm to initial pos. Contact pos. maintained until operated in reverse direction CCW CW
A B A B
No. 4
SPDT Spring Return Neutral Position Initial position
A B
No. 5
SPDT Spring Return CCW Only Initial position and CW
A B
No. 6
SPDT Spring Return CCW Only Initial position and CW
A B
CW
A B
Middle CW
A B
Final CW
A B
CCW
A B
CW
A B
CCW
A B
Middle CCW
A B
Final CCW
A B
Characteristics
Nominal Operating Data
Pre-travel Total travel Differential Operating torque Repeat accuracy 14 88 12 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) Int. Pos. 9, Final 16 88 5 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 7 81 7 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 6 81 5 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 14 88 12 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) Int. Pos. 9, Final 16 88 5 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm)
To convert sequences, remove base plate, position plate and latches. Reassemble positioning plate and latches as shown.
A A
Weight lb (kg)
Limit Switches
No. 7
SPDT Maintained If high speed cam or snap-back present, use No. 12
A B
No. 8
SPDT Maintained Neutral Position Initial position If high speed cam or snap-back is present, use No. 12
A B
No. 9
No. 10
No. 11
No. 12
SPDT SPDT SPDT SPDT Spring Return Spring Return Spring Return Maintained Slow Make, Slow Break Slow Make, Slow Break Slow Make, Slow Break Initial position and CCW
A B
Initial position
A B
CCW
A B
CCW
A B
CW CCW
A B A
CW
B
CCW
A B
CW
A B
CCW
A B
CW
A B
Characteristics
Nominal Operating Data
Pre-travel Total travel Differential Operating torque Repeat accuracy 10 85 12 2.5 lb-in (0.28 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 6 81 10 2.5 lb-in (0.28 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 12 87 0 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 3 81 0 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 12 87 0 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 45 90 0 8 lb-in (0.9 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm)
To convert sequences, remove base plate, position plate and latches. Reassemble positioning plate and latches as shown.
Weight lb (kg) Footnotes: see page 601 2.35 lb (1.07 kg) 2.35 lb. (1.07 kg)
A
B
Limit Switches
9007T Severe Duty Mill Switches
Standard Operating Sequences
Standard Catalog Numbers
Base Plate Surface Mounted A B C D
9007TSA1 9007TSB1 9007TSC1 9007TSD1 9007TSA2 9007TSB2 9007TSC2 9007TSD2 9007TSA3 9007TSB3 9007TSC3 9007TSD3
No. 1
SPDT Spring Return CW & CCW Initial position
A B
No. 2
SPDT Spring Return CW & CCW Initial position
A B
No. 3
SPDT Spring Return CW & CCW Slow Make, Slow Break Initial position
A B
CW and CCW
A B
CW and CCW
A B
The pre-travel listed may vary up to 5 additional for universal switches or up to 2 additional for standard switches due to free travel of lever arm at initial position. Linear travel of cam on 1.5 in. (38.1mm) lever arm. Remove spring from the positioning plate. Sequence 3, 7, and 8 devices are available but are not recommended where high speed cams or lever arm snap-back is present. The application should be checked and No. 12 sequences substituted where possible. Note: For Type FT foundry switches, change the T at the beginning of the equivalent Type number above to FT (Example: FTUB1). See page 602.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007FT Severe Duty Foundry Switches
Universal Operating Sequences
Universal Catalog Numbers
Base Plate Surface Mounted A B C D
9007FTUA1 9007FTUB1 9007FTUC1 9007FTUD1 9007FTUA2 9007FTUB2 9007FTUC2 9007FTUD2 9007FTUA3 9007FTUB3 9007FTUC3 9007FTUD3 9007FTUA4 9007FTUB4 9007FTUC4 9007FTUD4 9007FTUA5 9007FTUB5 9007FTUC5 9007FTUD5 9007FTUA6 9007FTUB6 9007FTUC6 9007FTUD6
No. 1
SPDT Spring Return CW Only Initial position and CCW
A B
No. 2
SPDT Spring Return CW Only Initial position and CCW
A B
No. 3
SPDT Maintained Contact Spring return of arm to initial pos. Contact pos. maintained until operated in reverse direction CCW CW
A B A B
No. 4
SPDT Spring Return Neutral Position Initial position
A B
No. 5
SPDT Spring Return CCW Only Initial position and CW
A B
No. 6
SPDT Spring Return CCW Only Initial position and CW
A B
CW
A B
Middle CW
A B
Final CW
A B
CCW
A B
CW
A B
CCW
A B
Middle CCW
A B
Final CCW
A B
Characteristics
Nominal Operating Data 14 Int. Pos. 9, Final 16 7 6 14 Pre-travel 88 88 81 81 88 Total travel 12 5 7 5 12 Differential 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) Operating torque 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) Repeat accuracy To convert sequences, remove base plate, position plate and latches. Reassemble positioning plate and latches as shown.
A A
Int. Pos. 9, Final 16 88 5 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm)
Weight lb (kg)
Limit Switches
No. 7
SPDT Maintained If high speed cam or snap-back present, use No. 12
A B
No. 8
SPDT Maintained Neutral Position Initial position If high speed cam or snap-back present, use No. 12
A B
No. 9
No. 10
No. 11
No. 12
SPDT SPDT SPDT SPDT Spring Return Spring Return Spring Return Maintained Slow Make, Slow Break Slow Make, Slow Break Slow Make, Slow Break Initial position and CCW
A B
Initial position
A B
CCW
A B
CCW
A B
CW CCW
A B A
CCW
B
A B
CW
A B
CW CCW
A A B B
CW
A
B
Characteristics
Nominal Operating Data 10 6 12 3 12 Pre-travel 85 81 87 81 87 Total travel 12 10 0 0 0 Differential 2.5 lb-in (0.28 Nm) 2.5 lb-in (0.28 Nm) 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) 12 lb-in (1.35 Nm) Operating torque 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 0.004 in. (0.10 mm) Repeat accuracy To convert sequences, remove base plate, position plate and latches. Reassemble positioning plate and latches as shown.
A
B
Weight lb (kg)
Footnotes: see page 603
Limit Switches
9007FT Severe Duty Foundry Switches
Standard Operating Sequences
Standard Catalog Numbers
Base Plate Surface Mounted A B C D 9007FTSA1 9007FTSB1 9007FTSC1 9007FTSD1 No. 1
Single Pole Double Throw Spring Return CW & CCW
Initial position
A B
Initial position
A B
CW and CCW
A B
CW and CCW
A B
0.004 in. (0.10 mm) 1/2" NPT 2.57 lb. (1.17 kg)
The pre-travel listed may vary up to 5 additional for universal switches or up to 2 additional for standard switches due to free travel of lever arm at initial position.
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007T and FT Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Lever Arms and Renewal Parts
Standard Roller
Arm Length in. (mm)
1.5 (38.1) 1.5 (38.1) 1.5 (38.1) 2.5 (63.5) 2.5 (63.5) 2.5 (63.5) 1.5 (38.1) 1.5 (38.1) 1.5 (38.1) 5 (127) 2.88 (73.1) 2.5 (63.5) 2.5 (63.5) 2.5 (63.5) Adjustable (1)
Roller Position
Optional Optional Optional Optional Optional Optional Optional Optional Optional Optional No roller Optional Optional Optional
Catalog Number
9007B1 9007B2 9007B3 9007B7 9007B8 9007B9 9007B12 9007B13 9007B14 9007B19 9007B21 9007B22 9007B23 9007B24
Weight lb (kg)
0.17 (0.077) 0.19 (0.086) 0.23 (0.104) 0.25 (0.113) 0.25 (0.113) 0.27 (0.122) 0.34 (0.154) 0.34 (0.154) 0.42 (0.191) 1.00 (0.454) 0.20 (0.091) 0.22 (0.100) 0.28 (0.127) 0.36 (0.163)
Standard Roller
0.75 (19) Optional 0.25 (6.3) 9007R18 0.50 (0.227) Adjustable (1) 1.0 (25.4) Optional 0.25 (6.3) 9007R19 0.50 (0.227) Adjustable (1) 1.38 (35) Optional 0.25 (6.3) 9007R20 0.50 (0.227) 1. Does not include lever arm clamp or rod. If lever arm clamp is required, use 9007R16 or R17.
Roller Position
Inside offset Inside offset Inside offset Outside offset Outside offset Outside offset Outside offset Outside offset Outside offset Inside offset Inside offset Inside offset
Catalog Number
9007C1 9007C2 9007C3 9007D1 9007D2 9007D3 9007E4 9007E5 9007E6 9007F4 9007F5 9007F6
Weight lb (kg)
0.50 (0.227) 0.50 (0.227) 0.50 (0.227) 0.18 (0.082) 0.18 (0.082) 0.18 (0.082) 0.20 (0.091) 0.27 (0.122) 0.27 (0.122) 0.30 (0.136) 0.30 (0.136) 0.30 (0.136)
Offset Type
Limit Switches
120 Forked 90 Forked Dimensions: pages 606 to 609
Roller Position
Same side Same side LH on opp. side LH on opp. side RH on opp. side RH on opp. side
Catalog Number
9007J1 9007J2 9007K1 9007K2 9007N1 9007N2
Weight lb (kg)
0.31 (0.141) 0.40 (0.181) 0.50 (0.227) 0.50 (0.227) 0.66 (0.299) 0.70 (0.316)
Roller Position
Same side Same side RH on opp. side RH on opp. side LH on opp. side LH on opp. side
Catalog Number
9007X1 9007X2 9007Y1 9007Y2 9007Z1 9007Z2
Weight lb (kg)
0.30 (0.136) 0.40 (0.181) 0.50 (0.227) 0.50 (0.227) 0.66 (0.299) 0.70 (0.316)
Limit Switches
9007T and FT Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Lever Arms and Renewal Parts
Cable operated Arm Steel roller Length Diameter in. (mm) in. (mm)
Catalog Number
9007Y3 9007B27 9007 R16 9007R17
Weight lb (kg)
0.18 (0.081) 0.18 (0.081)
1.5 (38.1) 0.75 (19) None None 2.5 in. (63.5mm) long with eyebolt 0.25 (6.3mm) I.D. instead of roller.
Rod Type (used on conveyor systems or where unusual shapes are required) With Reset Cable Operated
Adjustable 0.75 (19) Adjustable 0.75 (19) 1. Rod not included 2. Key stock not included 1.5 (38.1) 3.5 (89) 0.75 (19) 0.75 (19) 0.75 (19) 0.19 (4.8) 0.25 (6.3) None None
Ball Bearing Type (for abrasive dust areas or with high speed cams)
Center None Outside offset 0.28 (7.1) None 0.25 (6.3) 9007B16 9007G10 9007D4 9007R21 9007R22 0.15 (0.068) 0.50 (0.227) 0.64 (0.290) 1.63 (0.739) 1.42 (0.644)
Weld-On Type (used where a special operator is required to weld to lever) Rod Type (rod not included) Ball Bearing Type One Way Roller Type (used with reversible cams for one way operations)
1.5 (38.1)
Mounting Holes
Catalog Number
Weight lb (kg)
Weld-On Type
None (1) 2934D32G1 End 2934D14G1 0.34 (0.154) Side 2934D33G1 0.42 (0.191) End 2934D34G1 0.36 (0.163) No mounting holes in base plate. Side mounting holes in switch case must be used. Acceptable wire sizes 1418 AWG (2.080.823 mm2); recommended terminal clamp torque 1316 lb-in. (1.461.80 Nm).
Weight lb (kg)
Style A
Style B
Style C
Style D
Base Plates
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
9007T and FT Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Dimensions
Surface Mounting
Type T
2.06 52.32
Type FT
3.0 76.2
0.75 19.05
0.75 19.05
0.56 14.22 2.63 66.80 0.56 14.22 0.38 0.25 20 Tap deep 9.53 6.35
Both Sides
0.91 23.11
Both Sides
Base Plates
Style A
2.06 52.3
Style B
Style C
Style D
0.22 5.59
0.75 19.0 0.56 14.2
2.25 57.15
2.81 71.37 1.81 35.81 2.44 61.98 129.29 1.25 31.75 5.09 129.29
1.75 44.45
.53 13.46
3.16 80.3
2.63 66.8
1.81 45.97
0.56 14.2
0.44 11.18
Limit Switches
606
2.25 57.15
Dual dimensions:
in. mm
09/2007
Limit Switches
9007T and FT Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Dimensions
CAM Track Dimensions
Type T
0.38 9.65 2.81 20.57 0.38 9.65 0.38 9.65 0.38 9.65 2.44 61.98 0.75 19.05 3.28 83.31 2.53 65.26 0.94 23.88 1.59 40.39 0.84 21.34 0.75 19.05
Type D Roller Arms Type C Roller Arms Type B Roller Arms 1.5
Type FT
3.75 95.25 3.38 85.85 3.00 76.2 2.63 66.80 2.25 57.15 0.75 19.05 4.22 107.19 4.06 103.12 0.94 23.88 2.53 64.36 1.78 45.21 0.75 19.05
Dual dimensions:
in. mm
Limit Switches
0.38 9.65
Limit Switches
9007T and FT Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Dimensions
Type T and FT Lever Arms
Standard Roller Offset Type Adjustable Length Rod Type Ball Bearing Roller Type B16
B B E D
0.75 19.05
1.50 38.1
Inside Offset
C
C D F 0.31 7.87
1.66 43.16
E 0.31 7.87
Outside Offset
C DF E 0.31 7.87
0.69 17.53
0.31 7.87
0.44 11.18 B 0.38 9.53 0.88 22.35 0.75 19.05 0.28 7.11
1.50 0 38.1
0.31 7.84
1.06 27 2.12 54
0.25 Dia. 6
0.25 6.35
0.38 9.65 0.75 19.05 0.38 0.31 9.65 7.87 1.50 38.10
1.50 38.10
90o
3.50 88.9
0.09 2.29
0.63 16.0
2.50 64
Limit Switches
0.59 15.06
1.13 28.7
0.31 7.87
0.75 19.05
in. mm
Dual dimensions:
NOTE: All levers on this page can be used on Type C limit switches by installing the 9007S9 hub.
Limit Switches
9007T and FT Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Dimensions
Type T and FT Lever Arms (continued)
90 Forked 120 Forked
90
2.13 54.10
1.06 26.92
50 1. .10 38
0.38 9.53
Arm Type X1, Y1, Z1 X2, Y2, Z2 0.25 6.35 1.31 33.27 Dim A 0.75 19.05 1.00 25.4
0 1.5 .10 98
X1 X2
0.38 9.53
Type J1 & J2 1.34 0.67 34.04 17.02 1.34 34.04 Type K1 & K2 0.25 6.35 0.38 9.53 0.67 17.02
0.38 9.65
0.25 6.35
0.38 9.53
0.38 9.65
0.25 6.35
Y1 Y2
1.31 33.27
Z1 Z2
0.38 9.65
0.25 6.35
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L100, L300 Mill and Foundry Switches, L140, L2153 Cable Pulls, L529 Belt Conveyor
Conforming to NEMA A600 and UL508 Description
L100W Switches f Use the L100W Mill switches instead of other limit switches in the following applications: Where the current load exceeds the typical heavy duty limit switch contact rating of 10 A and falls within the range of up to 20 A continuous. Where an operating sequence is required that is not possible on other limit switches (35 choices with the L switches). Where higher reset forces are required due to foreign material interfering with lever arm operation, or where long heavy arms must reset against gravity.
f L switches are not preceded by 9007. They are known as the R.B.Denison Loxswitch L, and include conveyor belt and slack cable pull switches in the product offering. L300W Switches The L300W Foundry switches are for use in foundries or mills where the applications described above are required, and where falling foundry sand or similar material could build up and jam the operating mechanism. The shaft has a dust boot and extends from the switch case, preventing sand buildup around the shaft. The devices can withstand hot falling sand up to 300 F (149 C).
Page 612
Page 614
Limit Switches
Page 616
Page 616
Belt Conveyors
L525 Mill and Foundry
Conveyor belt limit switches are ideal for policing the lateral movement of belt conveyors. When the conveyor belt shifts, it contacts the switch roller and a 12 movement of the lever transfers the first set of contacts. This set is usually wired to initiate a warning alarm system to alert the worker that the belt is moving off the rollers. Further lateral movement of the belt, causing the lever to move another 8, trips the second set of contacts. These contacts are normally wired to the conveyor drive system, and when actuated, stop the systemminimizing damage to the conveyor, or loss of material on the belt.
Page 617
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L100, L300 Mill and Foundry Switches, L140, L2153 Cable Pulls, L529 Belt Conveyor
Environmental characteristics
Conforming to standards Product certifications Protective treatment Ambient air temperature Vibration resistance Shock resistance Electric shock protection Degree of protection Cable entry or connector Materials
1. UL508 UL Listed, CSA Certified, CE Marked Corrosion resistant gray paint -10 to +185 F (-23 to +85 C) With H prefix: -10 to +350 F (-23 to +177 C). (1) 10G (1055 Hz) 30G Class 0 NEMA Types 1, 2, 4, 12, 13, IP65, 66, 67 1/2" NPT (metric available) Cast zinc n
For a switch with an ambient temperature rating up to 350 F (177 C), add an H to the beginning of the catalog number. For example, change catalog number L100WS2M2 to HL100WS2M2.
AC Voltage DC Voltage
NEMA A600 Ithe = 20 A 20 A Resistive and continuous NEMA P600 Ithe = 20 A 20 A Resistive and continuous 600 V 2,500 Vac for 1 minute for CE, 2,200 Vac for 1 minute for UL, and 2,640 Vac for 1 minute for CSA No 20 A Bussmann Class CC KTK-R-20 fuse, non-time-delay 12 22 AWG (3.31 mm2 0.326 mm2) wire max. 15.2 mpm / 27.4 mpm (50 fpm / 90 fpm) with 45 Cam angle, levers only
Break VA Amperes
20 12.5 6.25 5 6 3 1.5 1.2
VA
2400 3000 3000 3000 720 720 720 720
Volts
DC Inductive and Resistive Make and Break ConAmperes tinuous Carrying Single Double Amperes Throw Throw
5.0 1.0 0.2 20 20 20
Limit Switches
18,000
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L100 Mill Switches
L100 Mill Switches
Description
Snap-action CW spring return
Operating Torque
Contact Diagram
Catalog Number
Operating Data
A (see page 613)
Weight, lb (kg)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WS2M1
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WS2M2
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WS2M3
1.51 (0.68)
5 6
3 4
5 6
3 4
L100WDR2M4
1.51 (0.68)
5 6
3 4
5 6
3 4
L100WDR2M5
1.51 (0.68)
5 6
3 4
5 6
3 4
L100WDR2M6
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
1 2
5 6
L100WDL2M7
1.51 (0.68)
Snap action CW spring return Snap action CW 1 N.C./ 2 N.O. spring return Snap action CCW 1 N.O./ 2 N.C. spring return Maintained contact c CW and CCW snap action 3 poles Snap action CCW 2 N.O./ 1 N.C. spring return Snap action CW 1 N.O./ 2 N.C. spring return Maintained contact c CW and CCW snap action 3 poles Neutral position c spring return slow make and break 1 N.O. contact per direction Neutral position c spring return slow make and break 1 N.O. contact for both directions
1 2
5 6
1 2
5 6
L100WDL2M8
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTR2M10
Limit Switches
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTR2M11
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTR2M12
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTL2M13
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTL2M14
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTL2M15
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WN2M16
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WN2M17
1.51 (0.68)
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L100 Mill Switches
L100 Mill Switches (continued)
Description
Neutral position c spring return slow make and break 1 N.C.-CW, 1 N.C.-CCW Neutral position c spring return slow make and break 2 N.O.-CW, 1 N.O.-CCW Neutral position c spring return slow make and break N.O.-CW, 2 N.O.-CCW Slow make-before-break CW spring return
Operating Torque
95 oz-in (0.67 Nm)
Contact Diagram
Catalog Number
L100WNC2M18
Operating Data
B (see table below)
Weight, lb (kg)
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTRN2M20
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTLN2M21
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WS02M22
1.51 (0.68)
Slow make-before-break CCW spring return Neutral position c N.O.-CW, N.O.-CCW spring return snap action Neutral position c N.O.-CW, N.O.-CCW maintained in CCW only
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WS02M23
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WNS2M26
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WNSR2M28
1.51 (0.68)
Neutral position c N.O.-CW, N.O.-CCW maintained in CW only Neutral position c N.C.-CW, N.C.-CCW spring return snap action Neutral position c N.O.-CW, N.O./N.C.-CCW spring return slow make and break Neutral position c N.O./N.C.-CW, N.O.-CCW spring return slow make and break Neutral position c N.O./N.C.-CW, N.C.-CCW spring return slow make and break Neutral position c N.C.-CW, N.O./N.C.-CCW spring return slow make and break Neutral position c N.O./N.C.-CW, N.C.-CCW spring return snap action
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WNSL2M29
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WNCS2M34
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTRN1C2M38
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTLN1C2M39
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTRN2C2M40
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTLN2M41
1.51 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L100WTRN2CS2M48
1.51 (0.68)
A
17 nominal 11 nominal 80 2035 0.03 190 oz-in (1.34 Nm) 45 oz-in (0.317 Nm)
B
7 maximum 4 maximum 70 10 25 95 oz-in (0.67 Nm)
C
7 nominal 4 nominal 80 20 35 170 oz-in (1.2 Nm)
D
9 nominal 6 nominal 70 13 30 0.03 170 oz-in (1.2 Nm) 45 oz-in (0.317 Nm)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L300 Foundry Switches
L300 Foundry Switches
Description
Snap-action CW spring return
Operating Torque
Contact Diagram
Catalog Number
Operating Data
A (see page 615)
Weight, lb (kg)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WS2M1
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WS2M2
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WS2M3
1.54 (0.70)
5 6
3 4
5 6
3 4
L300WDR2M4
1.54 (0.70)
5 6
3 4
5 6
3 4
L300WDR2M5
1.54 (0.70)
5 6
3 4
5 6
3 4
L300WDR2M6
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
1 2
5 6
L300WDL2M7
1.54 (0.70)
Snap action CW spring return Snap action CW 1 N.C./2 N.O. spring return Snap action CCW 1 N.O./ 2 N.C. spring return Maintained contact c CW and CCW snap action 3 poles Snap action CCW 2 N.O./ 1 N.C. spring return Snap action CW 1 N.O./ 2 N.C. spring return Maintained contact c CW and CCW snap action 3 poles Neutral position c spring return slow make and break 1 N.O. contact per direction Neutral position c spring return slow make and break 1 N.O. contact for both directions
1 2
5 6
1 2
5 6
L300WDL2M8
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTR2M10
Limit Switches
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTR2M11
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTR2M12
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTL2M13
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTL2M14
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTL2M15
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WN2M16
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WN2M17
1.54 (0.70)
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L300 Foundry Switches
L300 Foundry Switches (continued)
Description
Neutral position c spring return slow make and break 1 N.C.-CW, 1 N.C.-CCW Neutral position c spring return slow make and break 2 N.O.-CW, 1 N.O.-CCW Neutral position c spring return slow make and break N.O.-CW, 2 N.O.-CCW Slow make-before-break CW spring return
Operating Torque
95 oz-in (0.67 Nm)
Contact Diagram
Catalog Number
L300WNC2M18
Operating Data
B (see table below)
Weight, lb (kg)
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTRN2M20
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTLN2M21
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WS02M22
1.54 (0.70)
Slow make-before-break CCW spring return Neutral position c N.O.-CW, N.O.-CCW spring return snap action Neutral position c N.O.-CW, N.O.-CCW maintained in CCW only
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WS02M23
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WNS2M26
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WNSR2M28
1.54 (0.70)
Neutral position c N.O.-CW, N.O.-CCW maintained in CW only Neutral position c N.C.-CW, N.C.-CCW spring return snap action Neutral position c N.O.-CW, N.O./N.C.-CCW spring return slow make and break Neutral position c N.O./N.C.-CW, N.O.-CCW Spring return slow make and break Neutral position c N.O./N.C.-CW, N.C.-CCW spring return slow make and break Neutral position c N.C.-CW, N.O./N.C.-CCW spring return slow make and break Neutral position c N.O./N.C.-CW, N.C.-CCW spring return snap action
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WNSL2M29
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L300WNCS2M34
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTRN1C2M38
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTLN1C2M39
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTRN2C2M40
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTLN2M41
1.54 (0.70)
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
1 2
5 6
3 4
L300WTRN2CS2M48
1.54 (0.70)
A
17 nominal 11 nominal 80 2035 0.03 190 oz-in (1.34 Nm) 45 oz-in (0.317 Nm)
B
7 maximum 4 maximum 70 10 25 95 oz-in (0.67 Nm)
C
7 nominal 4 nominal 80 20 35 170 oz-in (1.2 Nm)
D
9 nominal 6 nominal 70 13 30 0.03 170 oz-in (1.2 Nm) 45 oz-in (0.317 Nm)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L140 and L2153 Cable Pulls
L140 Series Cable Pulls (1)
Circuit Direction Catalog Number (2) Weight lb (kg)
1 N.C. CW right L142 1.54 (0.70) 1 N.O. and 1 N.C. CW right L143 1.54 (0.70) 1 N.O. and 1 N.C. CCW left L144 1.54 (0.70) 1 N.C. CCW left L145 1.54 (0.70) 2 N.O. and 1 N.C. CW right L146 1.54 (0.70) 2 N.C. and 1 N.O. CW right L147 1.54 (0.70) 2 N.O. and 1 N.C. CCW left L148 1.54 (0.70) 2 N.C. and 1 N.O. CCW left L149 1.54 (0.70) 1. Style K levers were designed specifically for this application; see page 619 (order separately). 2. To complete the catalog number, refer to page 623 and add the suffix for the mounting plate style and the front cover material.
Catalog Number
L2153
Weight lb (kg)
2.04 (0.93)
Characteristics
L2153 Dual Pull Stop
Pretravel Differential travel Overlapping travel Total travel Recommended installation travel Repetitive accuracy of switch Operating torque, max with return spring Reset torque Temperature range Maintained contact 17 2 11 2 80 0.03 1327 lb-in (1.473.05 Nm) 719 lb-in (0.79 2.14 Nm) -20 to 120 F (-6.6 to 48.8 C)
Limit Switches
616 19972007 Schneider Electric All Rights Reserved 09/2007
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L525 Belt Conveyor Switches
L525
Belt Conveyor Switches Description 2 step sequence CW spring return, snap action, 2 N.O. 2 step sequence CCW spring return, snap action, 2 N.O. 2 step sequence CW spring return, snap action, 2 N.C. 2 Step sequence CCW spring return, snap action, 2 N.C 2 Step sequence CW spring return, snap action, N.O./N.C c Operating Torque Contact Diagram Catalog Number Weight lb (kg)
5 6
3 4
5 6
3 4
5 6
3 4
L525WDR2M56
1.5 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
1 2
5 6
1 2
5 6
L525WDL2M57
1.5 (0.68)
1 2
5 6
1 2
5 6
1 2
5 6
L525WDL2M58
1.5 (0.68)
5 6
3 4
5 6
3 4
5 6
3 4
L525WDR2M59
1.5 (0.68)
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
1 2
3 4
L100WS0S2M60
1.5 (0.68)
c Two step snap action. One normally closed, one normally open; CW operation to first step to 2-C. Further CW operation to second step, 1-O, 1-C. Spring return. Pretravel 9 nominal. Additional travel 8 nominal. Differential second step 7 nominal. Differential first step 7 nominal.
Characteristics
Pretravel Additional travel Differential travel Total travel Operating torque, max with return spring
12 nominal 8 nominal 7 nominal 75 nominal 150 oz-in nominal (1.06 Nm)
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L100/L300 Lever Arms
Lever Arms Lever arms are constructed of machined aluminum. Style A Steel Roller Dual dimensions: in. (mm)
.75 19 .25 6.3
Arm Length
Width
Catalog Number i
AC AA AD AH AJ AO AK AB AL AM AN AP AQ AR
Weight lb (kg)
0.06 (0.027) 0.06 (0.027) 0.07 (0.031) 0.08 (0.036) 0.09 (0.041) 0.10 (0.045) 0.10 (0.045) 0.11 (0.050) 0.12 (0.054) 0.13 (0.059) 0.14 (0.064) 0.16 (0.073) 0.18 (0.082) 0.20 (0.091)
.25 6.3
.62 15
50 12
1.25 (31.7) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 1.50 (38.1) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 1.75 (44.4 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 2.00 (50.8) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 2.25 (57.1) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 2.50 (63.5) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 2.75 (69.8) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 3.00 (76.2) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 3.50 (88.9) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 4.00 (101.6) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 4.50 (114.3) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 5.00 (127.0) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 5.50 (139.7) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) 6.00 (152.4) 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) i Example: AC This is the complete catalog number to order.
Style A
Style A Options
Diameter
.50 12
1.00 (25.4) 1.25 (32) 1.50 38.1) 0.75 (19)
Description
Roller Roller Roller Nylon roller Ball bearing roller Stainless steel roller
.75 19
.37 9.5
Width
0.50 (12.7) 0.50 (12.7) 0.50 (12.7) 0.50 (12.7) 0.50 (12.7) 0.50 (12.7) 0.50 (12.7) 0.50 (12.7)
Catalog Number
BA BH BO BB BM BN BQ BR
Weight lb (kg)
0.06 (0.027) 0.08 (0.036) 0.10 (0.045) 0.12 (0.054) 0.13 (0.059) 0.14 (0.064) 0.18 (0.082) 0.20 (0.091)
Limit Switches
Style B
.75 19
Style B Options
Diameter
1.50 (38.1)
Description
Nylon roller Roller
Width
0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3) 0.25 (6.3)
Catalog Number
CC CA CD CH CO CB CL CM CR
Weight lb (kg)
0.06 (0.027) 0.06 (0.027) 0.07 (0.031) 0.08 (0.036) 0.10 (0.045) 0.11 (0.050) 0.12 (0.054) 0.13 (0.059) 0.20 (0.091)
Style C
1.25 (31.7) 1.50 (38.1 1.75 (44.4) 2.00 (50.8) 2.50 (63.5) 3.00 (76.2) 3.50 (88.9) 4.00 (101.6) 6.00 (152.4)
Style C Options
Diameter
1.0 (24.5) 1.25 (32) 1.50 (38.1)
Description
Roller Roller Roller Nylon roller
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L100/L300 Lever Arms
Dual dimensions: in. (mm)
.50 12.7 50
Width
0.50 (12.7) 0.50 (12.7) 0.50 (12.7)
Catalog Number
EA ED EB
Weight lb (kg)
0.30 (0.136) 0.40 (0.181) 0.50 (0.227)
.75 19
.25 6.3
.68 17.4 L
Style E Options
Diameter in. (mm)
Description
Nylon roller
.50 12.7
Arm Length
1.50 (38.1) 1.50 (38.1) 1.50 (38.1) 2.00 (50.8) 2.50 (63.5) 3.00 (76.2) 3.00 (76.2)
Width
0.15 (3.8) 0.15 (3.8) 0.15 (3.8) 0.15 (3.8) 0.15 (3.8) 0.15 (3.8) 0.15 (3.8)
Catalog Number
FB FA FC FE FG FI FJ
Weight lb (kg)
0.06 (0.027) 0.06 (0.027) 0.06 (0.027) 0.08 (0.036) 0.10 (0.045) 0.11 (0.050) 0.11 (0.050)
Style E
.75 19
.25 6.3
Style F Options
L
Diameter
1.00 (24.5)
Description
Roller Nylon roller
.62 15.8
.50 12.7
Style F
0.25 6.3 0.31 7.9
Weight lb (kg)
0.05 (0.023) 0.08 (0.036) 0.09 (0.041)
0.50 12.7
1.50 (38.1 2.50 (63.5) 3.00 (76.2) i Example: KA This is the complete catalog number to order.
Catalog Number
AL1746 AL1649
Weight lb (kg)
0.62 15.8
0.50 12.7
Style K
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Lever Arms
Dual dimensions: in. (mm) Style R Steel Rod
Description
1.00 25.4
Hub only Rod only
Catalog Number
R R9
Weight lb (kg)
0.10 (0.045) 0.09 (0.041)
Description
Yoke
Catalog Number
VA
Weight lb (kg)
0.50 (0.227)
Style V Options
Diameter Description
Roller Nylon roller Ball bearing roller
Style R
Adjustable from 75 to 180 in increments of 7.5
70 180
Catalog Number
LAA1 LAH1 LA01
Weight lb (kg)
0.12 (0.054) 0.12 (0.054) 0.12 (0.054)
3.12 79.3
1.56 39.8
Style LA Options
.50 12.7
Diameter
1.5 (38)
Description
Roller Nylon roller
Style V
1.00 25.4 1.00 25.4
Catalog Number
LCA1 LCH1 LCO1
Weight lb (kg)
0.12 (0.054) 0.12 (0.054) 0.13 (0.059)
Style LC Options
Diameter
.75 19 1.25 31.7
1.25 (32) 1.5 (38)
Description
Roller Roller Nylon roller
Style LA
1.00 25.4 1.37 34.9
Limit Switches
Rolling Pin (for use with 2 step switches for conveyor or belt applications)
Arm Length
2.25 (75.1) 2.25 (75.1) 3.0 (50.8) High temp. Teflon material
Catalog Number
AL1650 AL16501 AL1802
Weight lb (kg)
0.30 (0.136) 0.33 (0.150) 0.33 (0.150)
Arm Length
Width
Catalog Number
Weight lb (kg)
Style LC
1.25 31.8 2.23 56.64 5.73 145.54
2.00 (51) to 0.75 (19) 0.25 (6.3) AL1650 0.30 (0.136) 4.00 (102) i Example: KA This is the complete catalog number to order. Note: No hub component is needed for Type AL rolling pins. The arm mounts directly onto the shaft of the switch.
3.00 76.2
Rolling Pin
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
L100/L300 Options and Accessories
Housing Options k
Description
0.75 in. conduit opening Available on 2 circuit switches. Standard on 3 circuit switches High temperature 0 to +350 F (-17.7 to +176.6 C) c Metal front cover only Low temperature -20 to 200 F (-28.8 to +93.3 C) c High shock Available only on operating sequences 1, 2, 4, 5, 7-11, 13, 14
Weight lb (kg)
1.54 (0.70)
H T 526
Gold contacts
Wiring
Description
Straight male receptacle 4-pin q Factory prewired 90 Angle male receptacle 4-pin q Factory prewiredfacing right Ministyle male receptacle j 8 A max. 5-pin (double circuit) or 7 A max. 7-pin (triple circuit)
Weight lb (kg)
1.54 (0.70) 1.54 (0.70) 1.54 (0.70)
Add Suffix
P P12 P18
Weight lb (kg)
1.54 (0.70)
Description
Standard metal Transparent plastic cover with metal frame Transparent plastic cover with metal frame and Neon indicator light (not connected)
Weight lb (kg)
1.54 (0.70)
Accessories
Description 90 Angle Male Connector Sealed female plug and cable for P and AP connector
4 pin, #16 AWG STO cable 140 F (60 C) 4 ft. (1.21 m) 6 ft. (1.82 m) 10 ft. (3.04 m) 1010004 1010006 10100010 1.20 (0.54) 1.25 (0.57) 1.50 (0.68) 1.50 (0.68) 1.70 (0.77) 2.10 (0.95)
Catalog Number
Weight lb (kg)
Limit Switches
Front Covers
Limit Switches
R.B.Denison Lox-Switch L Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Dimensions
Switches
Type L100 Type L300
.28 7.1
.28 7.1
CA Lever
AA Lever 2.12 53.9 1.75 44.4 1.87 47.5 .89 .75 2.62 66.7 4.95 22.6 19 125.7
3.93 100
4.95 125.7
2.31 58.7
1.81 46
2.10 53.5
.95 24.2
3.93 100
4.22 107.2
2.31 58.7
1.81 46
2.10 53.5
.95 24.2
1/2 pipe tap - 2 circuit switches 3/4 pipe tap - 3 circuit switches
1/2 pipe tap - 2 circuit switches 3/4 pipe tap - 3 circuit switches
Base Plates
Style 1 Style 2 Style 3 Style 4
2.81 71.4
1.40 35.7
6.5 16.5
.21 5.5
.90 23
3.59 91.2
3.20 81.3
1.31 33.3
2.26 57.3
2.65 67.4
.95 24.2
2.87 73
1.09 27.7
1.48 37.7
Limit Switches
.62 15.8
mtg. hole
.26 6.7 4 mounting holes
3.25 82.5
2.25 57.1
Receptacles
PL APL
3.17 80.5
1.50 38.1
4.22 107.2
1.46 37.3
.72 18.2
Limit Switches
Interpretation of Catalog Numbers
Severe Duty Mill and Foundry Switches
Interpretation of Catalog Numbers
The interpretation of catalog numbers is intended to help you understand how the catalog number is laid out. It is to be used with existing numbers only. The table below should not be used to generate new catalog numbers. If the contact sequence required is not listed, contact your local field office.
L100 and L300
Base Plates: Select style 1, 2, 3 or 4 Front Covers: Select metal, transparent plastic, or transparent plastic with neon light. For special features see page 621.
9007T and FT
Limit Switches
Limit Switches
624 19972007 Schneider Electric All Rights Reserved 09/2007